Add Guile as an extension language.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / ada-lang.c
1 /* Ada language support routines for GDB, the GNU debugger.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1992-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20
21 #include "defs.h"
22 #include <stdio.h>
23 #include <string.h>
24 #include <ctype.h>
25 #include <stdarg.h>
26 #include "demangle.h"
27 #include "gdb_regex.h"
28 #include "frame.h"
29 #include "symtab.h"
30 #include "gdbtypes.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "expression.h"
33 #include "parser-defs.h"
34 #include "language.h"
35 #include "varobj.h"
36 #include "c-lang.h"
37 #include "inferior.h"
38 #include "symfile.h"
39 #include "objfiles.h"
40 #include "breakpoint.h"
41 #include "gdbcore.h"
42 #include "hashtab.h"
43 #include "gdb_obstack.h"
44 #include "ada-lang.h"
45 #include "completer.h"
46 #include <sys/stat.h>
47 #include "ui-out.h"
48 #include "block.h"
49 #include "infcall.h"
50 #include "dictionary.h"
51 #include "exceptions.h"
52 #include "annotate.h"
53 #include "valprint.h"
54 #include "source.h"
55 #include "observer.h"
56 #include "vec.h"
57 #include "stack.h"
58 #include "gdb_vecs.h"
59 #include "typeprint.h"
60
61 #include "psymtab.h"
62 #include "value.h"
63 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
64 #include "arch-utils.h"
65 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
66
67 /* Define whether or not the C operator '/' truncates towards zero for
68 differently signed operands (truncation direction is undefined in C).
69 Copied from valarith.c. */
70
71 #ifndef TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO
72 #define TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO ((-5 / 2) == -2)
73 #endif
74
75 static struct type *desc_base_type (struct type *);
76
77 static struct type *desc_bounds_type (struct type *);
78
79 static struct value *desc_bounds (struct value *);
80
81 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *);
82
83 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *);
84
85 static struct type *desc_data_target_type (struct type *);
86
87 static struct value *desc_data (struct value *);
88
89 static int fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *);
90
91 static int fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *);
92
93 static struct value *desc_one_bound (struct value *, int, int);
94
95 static int desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *, int, int);
96
97 static int desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *, int, int);
98
99 static struct type *desc_index_type (struct type *, int);
100
101 static int desc_arity (struct type *);
102
103 static int ada_type_match (struct type *, struct type *, int);
104
105 static int ada_args_match (struct symbol *, struct value **, int);
106
107 static int full_match (const char *, const char *);
108
109 static struct value *make_array_descriptor (struct type *, struct value *);
110
111 static void ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *,
112 struct block *, const char *,
113 domain_enum, struct objfile *, int);
114
115 static int is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info *, int);
116
117 static void add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *, struct symbol *,
118 struct block *);
119
120 static int num_defns_collected (struct obstack *);
121
122 static struct ada_symbol_info *defns_collected (struct obstack *, int);
123
124 static struct value *resolve_subexp (struct expression **, int *, int,
125 struct type *);
126
127 static void replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **, int, int, int,
128 struct symbol *, const struct block *);
129
130 static int possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode, struct value **);
131
132 static char *ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
133
134 static const char *ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
135
136 static int numeric_type_p (struct type *);
137
138 static int integer_type_p (struct type *);
139
140 static int scalar_type_p (struct type *);
141
142 static int discrete_type_p (struct type *);
143
144 static enum ada_renaming_category parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *,
145 const char **,
146 int *,
147 const char **);
148
149 static struct symbol *find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *,
150 const struct block *);
151
152 static struct type *ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *, char *,
153 int, int, int *);
154
155 static struct value *evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *, int *);
156
157 static struct type *ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *,
158 const char *);
159
160 static int is_dynamic_field (struct type *, int);
161
162 static struct type *to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *,
163 const gdb_byte *,
164 CORE_ADDR, struct value *);
165
166 static struct type *to_fixed_array_type (struct type *, struct value *, int);
167
168 static struct type *to_fixed_range_type (struct type *, struct value *);
169
170 static struct type *to_static_fixed_type (struct type *);
171 static struct type *static_unwrap_type (struct type *type);
172
173 static struct value *unwrap_value (struct value *);
174
175 static struct type *constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *, long *);
176
177 static struct type *decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
178
179 static long decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *);
180
181 static struct value *decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *);
182
183 static int ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *);
184
185 static int ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
186
187 static struct value *value_subscript_packed (struct value *, int,
188 struct value **);
189
190 static void move_bits (gdb_byte *, int, const gdb_byte *, int, int, int);
191
192 static struct value *coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *,
193 struct type *);
194
195 static struct value *get_var_value (char *, char *);
196
197 static int lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *, struct symbol *);
198
199 static int equiv_types (struct type *, struct type *);
200
201 static int is_name_suffix (const char *);
202
203 static int advance_wild_match (const char **, const char *, int);
204
205 static int wild_match (const char *, const char *);
206
207 static struct value *ada_coerce_ref (struct value *);
208
209 static LONGEST pos_atr (struct value *);
210
211 static struct value *value_pos_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
212
213 static struct value *value_val_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
214
215 static struct symbol *standard_lookup (const char *, const struct block *,
216 domain_enum);
217
218 static struct value *ada_search_struct_field (char *, struct value *, int,
219 struct type *);
220
221 static struct value *ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *, int, int,
222 struct type *);
223
224 static int find_struct_field (const char *, struct type *, int,
225 struct type **, int *, int *, int *, int *);
226
227 static struct value *ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *, CORE_ADDR,
228 struct value *);
229
230 static int ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info *, int,
231 struct value **, int, const char *,
232 struct type *);
233
234 static int ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *);
235
236 static void ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *,
237 struct language_arch_info *);
238
239 static void check_size (const struct type *);
240
241 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field (int, struct value *, int,
242 struct type *);
243
244 static struct value *assign_aggregate (struct value *, struct value *,
245 struct expression *,
246 int *, enum noside);
247
248 static void aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *, struct value *,
249 struct expression *,
250 int *, LONGEST *, int *,
251 int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
252
253 static void aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *, struct value *,
254 struct expression *,
255 int *, LONGEST *, int *, int,
256 LONGEST, LONGEST);
257
258
259 static void aggregate_assign_others (struct value *, struct value *,
260 struct expression *,
261 int *, LONGEST *, int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
262
263
264 static void add_component_interval (LONGEST, LONGEST, LONGEST *, int *, int);
265
266
267 static struct value *ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *,
268 int *, enum noside);
269
270 static void ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *, int, int *,
271 int *);
272
273 static struct type *ada_find_any_type (const char *name);
274 \f
275
276
277 /* Maximum-sized dynamic type. */
278 static unsigned int varsize_limit;
279
280 /* FIXME: brobecker/2003-09-17: No longer a const because it is
281 returned by a function that does not return a const char *. */
282 static char *ada_completer_word_break_characters =
283 #ifdef VMS
284 " \t\n!@#%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
285 #else
286 " \t\n!@#$%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
287 #endif
288
289 /* The name of the symbol to use to get the name of the main subprogram. */
290 static const char ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME[]
291 = "__gnat_ada_main_program_name";
292
293 /* Limit on the number of warnings to raise per expression evaluation. */
294 static int warning_limit = 2;
295
296 /* Number of warning messages issued; reset to 0 by cleanups after
297 expression evaluation. */
298 static int warnings_issued = 0;
299
300 static const char *known_runtime_file_name_patterns[] = {
301 ADA_KNOWN_RUNTIME_FILE_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
302 };
303
304 static const char *known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[] = {
305 ADA_KNOWN_AUXILIARY_FUNCTION_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
306 };
307
308 /* Space for allocating results of ada_lookup_symbol_list. */
309 static struct obstack symbol_list_obstack;
310
311 /* Maintenance-related settings for this module. */
312
313 static struct cmd_list_element *maint_set_ada_cmdlist;
314 static struct cmd_list_element *maint_show_ada_cmdlist;
315
316 /* Implement the "maintenance set ada" (prefix) command. */
317
318 static void
319 maint_set_ada_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
320 {
321 help_list (maint_set_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance set ada ", -1, gdb_stdout);
322 }
323
324 /* Implement the "maintenance show ada" (prefix) command. */
325
326 static void
327 maint_show_ada_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
328 {
329 cmd_show_list (maint_show_ada_cmdlist, from_tty, "");
330 }
331
332 /* The "maintenance ada set/show ignore-descriptive-type" value. */
333
334 static int ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p = 0;
335
336 /* Inferior-specific data. */
337
338 /* Per-inferior data for this module. */
339
340 struct ada_inferior_data
341 {
342 /* The ada__tags__type_specific_data type, which is used when decoding
343 tagged types. With older versions of GNAT, this type was directly
344 accessible through a component ("tsd") in the object tag. But this
345 is no longer the case, so we cache it for each inferior. */
346 struct type *tsd_type;
347
348 /* The exception_support_info data. This data is used to determine
349 how to implement support for Ada exception catchpoints in a given
350 inferior. */
351 const struct exception_support_info *exception_info;
352 };
353
354 /* Our key to this module's inferior data. */
355 static const struct inferior_data *ada_inferior_data;
356
357 /* A cleanup routine for our inferior data. */
358 static void
359 ada_inferior_data_cleanup (struct inferior *inf, void *arg)
360 {
361 struct ada_inferior_data *data;
362
363 data = inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data);
364 if (data != NULL)
365 xfree (data);
366 }
367
368 /* Return our inferior data for the given inferior (INF).
369
370 This function always returns a valid pointer to an allocated
371 ada_inferior_data structure. If INF's inferior data has not
372 been previously set, this functions creates a new one with all
373 fields set to zero, sets INF's inferior to it, and then returns
374 a pointer to that newly allocated ada_inferior_data. */
375
376 static struct ada_inferior_data *
377 get_ada_inferior_data (struct inferior *inf)
378 {
379 struct ada_inferior_data *data;
380
381 data = inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data);
382 if (data == NULL)
383 {
384 data = XCNEW (struct ada_inferior_data);
385 set_inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data, data);
386 }
387
388 return data;
389 }
390
391 /* Perform all necessary cleanups regarding our module's inferior data
392 that is required after the inferior INF just exited. */
393
394 static void
395 ada_inferior_exit (struct inferior *inf)
396 {
397 ada_inferior_data_cleanup (inf, NULL);
398 set_inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data, NULL);
399 }
400
401 /* Utilities */
402
403 /* If TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF type, return the target type after
404 all typedef layers have been peeled. Otherwise, return TYPE.
405
406 Normally, we really expect a typedef type to only have 1 typedef layer.
407 In other words, we really expect the target type of a typedef type to be
408 a non-typedef type. This is particularly true for Ada units, because
409 the language does not have a typedef vs not-typedef distinction.
410 In that respect, the Ada compiler has been trying to eliminate as many
411 typedef definitions in the debugging information, since they generally
412 do not bring any extra information (we still use typedef under certain
413 circumstances related mostly to the GNAT encoding).
414
415 Unfortunately, we have seen situations where the debugging information
416 generated by the compiler leads to such multiple typedef layers. For
417 instance, consider the following example with stabs:
418
419 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:Tt(0,46)=s16P_ARRAY:(0,47)=[...]"[...]
420 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:t(0,36)=(0,46)",128,0,6,0
421
422 This is an error in the debugging information which causes type
423 pck__float_array___XUP to be defined twice, and the second time,
424 it is defined as a typedef of a typedef.
425
426 This is on the fringe of legality as far as debugging information is
427 concerned, and certainly unexpected. But it is easy to handle these
428 situations correctly, so we can afford to be lenient in this case. */
429
430 static struct type *
431 ada_typedef_target_type (struct type *type)
432 {
433 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
434 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
435 return type;
436 }
437
438 /* Given DECODED_NAME a string holding a symbol name in its
439 decoded form (ie using the Ada dotted notation), returns
440 its unqualified name. */
441
442 static const char *
443 ada_unqualified_name (const char *decoded_name)
444 {
445 const char *result = strrchr (decoded_name, '.');
446
447 if (result != NULL)
448 result++; /* Skip the dot... */
449 else
450 result = decoded_name;
451
452 return result;
453 }
454
455 /* Return a string starting with '<', followed by STR, and '>'.
456 The result is good until the next call. */
457
458 static char *
459 add_angle_brackets (const char *str)
460 {
461 static char *result = NULL;
462
463 xfree (result);
464 result = xstrprintf ("<%s>", str);
465 return result;
466 }
467
468 static char *
469 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters (void)
470 {
471 return ada_completer_word_break_characters;
472 }
473
474 /* Print an array element index using the Ada syntax. */
475
476 static void
477 ada_print_array_index (struct value *index_value, struct ui_file *stream,
478 const struct value_print_options *options)
479 {
480 LA_VALUE_PRINT (index_value, stream, options);
481 fprintf_filtered (stream, " => ");
482 }
483
484 /* Assuming VECT points to an array of *SIZE objects of size
485 ELEMENT_SIZE, grow it to contain at least MIN_SIZE objects,
486 updating *SIZE as necessary and returning the (new) array. */
487
488 void *
489 grow_vect (void *vect, size_t *size, size_t min_size, int element_size)
490 {
491 if (*size < min_size)
492 {
493 *size *= 2;
494 if (*size < min_size)
495 *size = min_size;
496 vect = xrealloc (vect, *size * element_size);
497 }
498 return vect;
499 }
500
501 /* True (non-zero) iff TARGET matches FIELD_NAME up to any trailing
502 suffix of FIELD_NAME beginning "___". */
503
504 static int
505 field_name_match (const char *field_name, const char *target)
506 {
507 int len = strlen (target);
508
509 return
510 (strncmp (field_name, target, len) == 0
511 && (field_name[len] == '\0'
512 || (strncmp (field_name + len, "___", 3) == 0
513 && strcmp (field_name + strlen (field_name) - 6,
514 "___XVN") != 0)));
515 }
516
517
518 /* Assuming TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT or a TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF to
519 a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT, find the field whose name matches FIELD_NAME,
520 and return its index. This function also handles fields whose name
521 have ___ suffixes because the compiler sometimes alters their name
522 by adding such a suffix to represent fields with certain constraints.
523 If the field could not be found, return a negative number if
524 MAYBE_MISSING is set. Otherwise raise an error. */
525
526 int
527 ada_get_field_index (const struct type *type, const char *field_name,
528 int maybe_missing)
529 {
530 int fieldno;
531 struct type *struct_type = check_typedef ((struct type *) type);
532
533 for (fieldno = 0; fieldno < TYPE_NFIELDS (struct_type); fieldno++)
534 if (field_name_match (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (struct_type, fieldno), field_name))
535 return fieldno;
536
537 if (!maybe_missing)
538 error (_("Unable to find field %s in struct %s. Aborting"),
539 field_name, TYPE_NAME (struct_type));
540
541 return -1;
542 }
543
544 /* The length of the prefix of NAME prior to any "___" suffix. */
545
546 int
547 ada_name_prefix_len (const char *name)
548 {
549 if (name == NULL)
550 return 0;
551 else
552 {
553 const char *p = strstr (name, "___");
554
555 if (p == NULL)
556 return strlen (name);
557 else
558 return p - name;
559 }
560 }
561
562 /* Return non-zero if SUFFIX is a suffix of STR.
563 Return zero if STR is null. */
564
565 static int
566 is_suffix (const char *str, const char *suffix)
567 {
568 int len1, len2;
569
570 if (str == NULL)
571 return 0;
572 len1 = strlen (str);
573 len2 = strlen (suffix);
574 return (len1 >= len2 && strcmp (str + len1 - len2, suffix) == 0);
575 }
576
577 /* The contents of value VAL, treated as a value of type TYPE. The
578 result is an lval in memory if VAL is. */
579
580 static struct value *
581 coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *val, struct type *type)
582 {
583 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
584 if (value_type (val) == type)
585 return val;
586 else
587 {
588 struct value *result;
589
590 /* Make sure that the object size is not unreasonable before
591 trying to allocate some memory for it. */
592 check_size (type);
593
594 if (value_lazy (val)
595 || TYPE_LENGTH (type) > TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)))
596 result = allocate_value_lazy (type);
597 else
598 {
599 result = allocate_value (type);
600 memcpy (value_contents_raw (result), value_contents (val),
601 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
602 }
603 set_value_component_location (result, val);
604 set_value_bitsize (result, value_bitsize (val));
605 set_value_bitpos (result, value_bitpos (val));
606 set_value_address (result, value_address (val));
607 set_value_optimized_out (result, value_optimized_out_const (val));
608 return result;
609 }
610 }
611
612 static const gdb_byte *
613 cond_offset_host (const gdb_byte *valaddr, long offset)
614 {
615 if (valaddr == NULL)
616 return NULL;
617 else
618 return valaddr + offset;
619 }
620
621 static CORE_ADDR
622 cond_offset_target (CORE_ADDR address, long offset)
623 {
624 if (address == 0)
625 return 0;
626 else
627 return address + offset;
628 }
629
630 /* Issue a warning (as for the definition of warning in utils.c, but
631 with exactly one argument rather than ...), unless the limit on the
632 number of warnings has passed during the evaluation of the current
633 expression. */
634
635 /* FIXME: cagney/2004-10-10: This function is mimicking the behavior
636 provided by "complaint". */
637 static void lim_warning (const char *format, ...) ATTRIBUTE_PRINTF (1, 2);
638
639 static void
640 lim_warning (const char *format, ...)
641 {
642 va_list args;
643
644 va_start (args, format);
645 warnings_issued += 1;
646 if (warnings_issued <= warning_limit)
647 vwarning (format, args);
648
649 va_end (args);
650 }
651
652 /* Issue an error if the size of an object of type T is unreasonable,
653 i.e. if it would be a bad idea to allocate a value of this type in
654 GDB. */
655
656 static void
657 check_size (const struct type *type)
658 {
659 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > varsize_limit)
660 error (_("object size is larger than varsize-limit"));
661 }
662
663 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
664 static LONGEST
665 max_of_size (int size)
666 {
667 LONGEST top_bit = (LONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 2);
668
669 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
670 }
671
672 /* Minimum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
673 static LONGEST
674 min_of_size (int size)
675 {
676 return -max_of_size (size) - 1;
677 }
678
679 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte unsigned integer type. */
680 static ULONGEST
681 umax_of_size (int size)
682 {
683 ULONGEST top_bit = (ULONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 1);
684
685 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
686 }
687
688 /* Maximum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
689 static LONGEST
690 max_of_type (struct type *t)
691 {
692 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
693 return (LONGEST) umax_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
694 else
695 return max_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
696 }
697
698 /* Minimum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
699 static LONGEST
700 min_of_type (struct type *t)
701 {
702 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
703 return 0;
704 else
705 return min_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
706 }
707
708 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
709 LONGEST
710 ada_discrete_type_high_bound (struct type *type)
711 {
712 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
713 {
714 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
715 return TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type);
716 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
717 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, TYPE_NFIELDS (type) - 1);
718 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
719 return 1;
720 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
721 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
722 return max_of_type (type);
723 default:
724 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_high_bound."));
725 }
726 }
727
728 /* The smallest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
729 LONGEST
730 ada_discrete_type_low_bound (struct type *type)
731 {
732 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
733 {
734 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
735 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type);
736 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
737 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, 0);
738 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
739 return 0;
740 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
741 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
742 return min_of_type (type);
743 default:
744 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_low_bound."));
745 }
746 }
747
748 /* The identity on non-range types. For range types, the underlying
749 non-range scalar type. */
750
751 static struct type *
752 get_base_type (struct type *type)
753 {
754 while (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
755 {
756 if (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) || TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
757 return type;
758 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
759 }
760 return type;
761 }
762
763 /* Return a decoded version of the given VALUE. This means returning
764 a value whose type is obtained by applying all the GNAT-specific
765 encondings, making the resulting type a static but standard description
766 of the initial type. */
767
768 struct value *
769 ada_get_decoded_value (struct value *value)
770 {
771 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (value));
772
773 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type)
774 || (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type)
775 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR))
776 {
777 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF) /* array access type. */
778 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (value);
779 else
780 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (value);
781 }
782 else
783 value = ada_to_fixed_value (value);
784
785 return value;
786 }
787
788 /* Same as ada_get_decoded_value, but with the given TYPE.
789 Because there is no associated actual value for this type,
790 the resulting type might be a best-effort approximation in
791 the case of dynamic types. */
792
793 struct type *
794 ada_get_decoded_type (struct type *type)
795 {
796 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
797 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
798 type = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (type);
799 return type;
800 }
801
802 \f
803
804 /* Language Selection */
805
806 /* If the main program is in Ada, return language_ada, otherwise return LANG
807 (the main program is in Ada iif the adainit symbol is found). */
808
809 enum language
810 ada_update_initial_language (enum language lang)
811 {
812 if (lookup_minimal_symbol ("adainit", (const char *) NULL,
813 (struct objfile *) NULL) != NULL)
814 return language_ada;
815
816 return lang;
817 }
818
819 /* If the main procedure is written in Ada, then return its name.
820 The result is good until the next call. Return NULL if the main
821 procedure doesn't appear to be in Ada. */
822
823 char *
824 ada_main_name (void)
825 {
826 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
827 static char *main_program_name = NULL;
828
829 /* For Ada, the name of the main procedure is stored in a specific
830 string constant, generated by the binder. Look for that symbol,
831 extract its address, and then read that string. If we didn't find
832 that string, then most probably the main procedure is not written
833 in Ada. */
834 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol (ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME, NULL, NULL);
835
836 if (msym != NULL)
837 {
838 CORE_ADDR main_program_name_addr;
839 int err_code;
840
841 main_program_name_addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msym);
842 if (main_program_name_addr == 0)
843 error (_("Invalid address for Ada main program name."));
844
845 xfree (main_program_name);
846 target_read_string (main_program_name_addr, &main_program_name,
847 1024, &err_code);
848
849 if (err_code != 0)
850 return NULL;
851 return main_program_name;
852 }
853
854 /* The main procedure doesn't seem to be in Ada. */
855 return NULL;
856 }
857 \f
858 /* Symbols */
859
860 /* Table of Ada operators and their GNAT-encoded names. Last entry is pair
861 of NULLs. */
862
863 const struct ada_opname_map ada_opname_table[] = {
864 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", BINOP_ADD},
865 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", BINOP_SUB},
866 {"Omultiply", "\"*\"", BINOP_MUL},
867 {"Odivide", "\"/\"", BINOP_DIV},
868 {"Omod", "\"mod\"", BINOP_MOD},
869 {"Orem", "\"rem\"", BINOP_REM},
870 {"Oexpon", "\"**\"", BINOP_EXP},
871 {"Olt", "\"<\"", BINOP_LESS},
872 {"Ole", "\"<=\"", BINOP_LEQ},
873 {"Ogt", "\">\"", BINOP_GTR},
874 {"Oge", "\">=\"", BINOP_GEQ},
875 {"Oeq", "\"=\"", BINOP_EQUAL},
876 {"One", "\"/=\"", BINOP_NOTEQUAL},
877 {"Oand", "\"and\"", BINOP_BITWISE_AND},
878 {"Oor", "\"or\"", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR},
879 {"Oxor", "\"xor\"", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR},
880 {"Oconcat", "\"&\"", BINOP_CONCAT},
881 {"Oabs", "\"abs\"", UNOP_ABS},
882 {"Onot", "\"not\"", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT},
883 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", UNOP_PLUS},
884 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", UNOP_NEG},
885 {NULL, NULL}
886 };
887
888 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions.
889 The result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. */
890
891 char *
892 ada_encode (const char *decoded)
893 {
894 static char *encoding_buffer = NULL;
895 static size_t encoding_buffer_size = 0;
896 const char *p;
897 int k;
898
899 if (decoded == NULL)
900 return NULL;
901
902 GROW_VECT (encoding_buffer, encoding_buffer_size,
903 2 * strlen (decoded) + 10);
904
905 k = 0;
906 for (p = decoded; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
907 {
908 if (*p == '.')
909 {
910 encoding_buffer[k] = encoding_buffer[k + 1] = '_';
911 k += 2;
912 }
913 else if (*p == '"')
914 {
915 const struct ada_opname_map *mapping;
916
917 for (mapping = ada_opname_table;
918 mapping->encoded != NULL
919 && strncmp (mapping->decoded, p,
920 strlen (mapping->decoded)) != 0; mapping += 1)
921 ;
922 if (mapping->encoded == NULL)
923 error (_("invalid Ada operator name: %s"), p);
924 strcpy (encoding_buffer + k, mapping->encoded);
925 k += strlen (mapping->encoded);
926 break;
927 }
928 else
929 {
930 encoding_buffer[k] = *p;
931 k += 1;
932 }
933 }
934
935 encoding_buffer[k] = '\0';
936 return encoding_buffer;
937 }
938
939 /* Return NAME folded to lower case, or, if surrounded by single
940 quotes, unfolded, but with the quotes stripped away. Result good
941 to next call. */
942
943 char *
944 ada_fold_name (const char *name)
945 {
946 static char *fold_buffer = NULL;
947 static size_t fold_buffer_size = 0;
948
949 int len = strlen (name);
950 GROW_VECT (fold_buffer, fold_buffer_size, len + 1);
951
952 if (name[0] == '\'')
953 {
954 strncpy (fold_buffer, name + 1, len - 2);
955 fold_buffer[len - 2] = '\000';
956 }
957 else
958 {
959 int i;
960
961 for (i = 0; i <= len; i += 1)
962 fold_buffer[i] = tolower (name[i]);
963 }
964
965 return fold_buffer;
966 }
967
968 /* Return nonzero if C is either a digit or a lowercase alphabet character. */
969
970 static int
971 is_lower_alphanum (const char c)
972 {
973 return (isdigit (c) || (isalpha (c) && islower (c)));
974 }
975
976 /* ENCODED is the linkage name of a symbol and LEN contains its length.
977 This function saves in LEN the length of that same symbol name but
978 without either of these suffixes:
979 . .{DIGIT}+
980 . ${DIGIT}+
981 . ___{DIGIT}+
982 . __{DIGIT}+.
983
984 These are suffixes introduced by the compiler for entities such as
985 nested subprogram for instance, in order to avoid name clashes.
986 They do not serve any purpose for the debugger. */
987
988 static void
989 ada_remove_trailing_digits (const char *encoded, int *len)
990 {
991 if (*len > 1 && isdigit (encoded[*len - 1]))
992 {
993 int i = *len - 2;
994
995 while (i > 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
996 i--;
997 if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '.')
998 *len = i;
999 else if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '$')
1000 *len = i;
1001 else if (i >= 2 && strncmp (encoded + i - 2, "___", 3) == 0)
1002 *len = i - 2;
1003 else if (i >= 1 && strncmp (encoded + i - 1, "__", 2) == 0)
1004 *len = i - 1;
1005 }
1006 }
1007
1008 /* Remove the suffix introduced by the compiler for protected object
1009 subprograms. */
1010
1011 static void
1012 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
1013 {
1014 /* Remove trailing N. */
1015
1016 /* Protected entry subprograms are broken into two
1017 separate subprograms: The first one is unprotected, and has
1018 a 'N' suffix; the second is the protected version, and has
1019 the 'P' suffix. The second calls the first one after handling
1020 the protection. Since the P subprograms are internally generated,
1021 we leave these names undecoded, giving the user a clue that this
1022 entity is internal. */
1023
1024 if (*len > 1
1025 && encoded[*len - 1] == 'N'
1026 && (isdigit (encoded[*len - 2]) || islower (encoded[*len - 2])))
1027 *len = *len - 1;
1028 }
1029
1030 /* Remove trailing X[bn]* suffixes (indicating names in package bodies). */
1031
1032 static void
1033 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
1034 {
1035 int i = *len - 1;
1036
1037 while (i > 0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'))
1038 i--;
1039
1040 if (encoded[i] != 'X')
1041 return;
1042
1043 if (i == 0)
1044 return;
1045
1046 if (isalnum (encoded[i-1]))
1047 *len = i;
1048 }
1049
1050 /* If ENCODED follows the GNAT entity encoding conventions, then return
1051 the decoded form of ENCODED. Otherwise, return "<%s>" where "%s" is
1052 replaced by ENCODED.
1053
1054 The resulting string is valid until the next call of ada_decode.
1055 If the string is unchanged by decoding, the original string pointer
1056 is returned. */
1057
1058 const char *
1059 ada_decode (const char *encoded)
1060 {
1061 int i, j;
1062 int len0;
1063 const char *p;
1064 char *decoded;
1065 int at_start_name;
1066 static char *decoding_buffer = NULL;
1067 static size_t decoding_buffer_size = 0;
1068
1069 /* The name of the Ada main procedure starts with "_ada_".
1070 This prefix is not part of the decoded name, so skip this part
1071 if we see this prefix. */
1072 if (strncmp (encoded, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
1073 encoded += 5;
1074
1075 /* If the name starts with '_', then it is not a properly encoded
1076 name, so do not attempt to decode it. Similarly, if the name
1077 starts with '<', the name should not be decoded. */
1078 if (encoded[0] == '_' || encoded[0] == '<')
1079 goto Suppress;
1080
1081 len0 = strlen (encoded);
1082
1083 ada_remove_trailing_digits (encoded, &len0);
1084 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (encoded, &len0);
1085
1086 /* Remove the ___X.* suffix if present. Do not forget to verify that
1087 the suffix is located before the current "end" of ENCODED. We want
1088 to avoid re-matching parts of ENCODED that have previously been
1089 marked as discarded (by decrementing LEN0). */
1090 p = strstr (encoded, "___");
1091 if (p != NULL && p - encoded < len0 - 3)
1092 {
1093 if (p[3] == 'X')
1094 len0 = p - encoded;
1095 else
1096 goto Suppress;
1097 }
1098
1099 /* Remove any trailing TKB suffix. It tells us that this symbol
1100 is for the body of a task, but that information does not actually
1101 appear in the decoded name. */
1102
1103 if (len0 > 3 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 3, "TKB", 3) == 0)
1104 len0 -= 3;
1105
1106 /* Remove any trailing TB suffix. The TB suffix is slightly different
1107 from the TKB suffix because it is used for non-anonymous task
1108 bodies. */
1109
1110 if (len0 > 2 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 2, "TB", 2) == 0)
1111 len0 -= 2;
1112
1113 /* Remove trailing "B" suffixes. */
1114 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-04-19: Not sure what this are used for... */
1115
1116 if (len0 > 1 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 1, "B", 1) == 0)
1117 len0 -= 1;
1118
1119 /* Make decoded big enough for possible expansion by operator name. */
1120
1121 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, 2 * len0 + 1);
1122 decoded = decoding_buffer;
1123
1124 /* Remove trailing __{digit}+ or trailing ${digit}+. */
1125
1126 if (len0 > 1 && isdigit (encoded[len0 - 1]))
1127 {
1128 i = len0 - 2;
1129 while ((i >= 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
1130 || (i >= 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && isdigit (encoded[i - 1])))
1131 i -= 1;
1132 if (i > 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i - 1] == '_')
1133 len0 = i - 1;
1134 else if (encoded[i] == '$')
1135 len0 = i;
1136 }
1137
1138 /* The first few characters that are not alphabetic are not part
1139 of any encoding we use, so we can copy them over verbatim. */
1140
1141 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < len0 && !isalpha (encoded[i]); i += 1, j += 1)
1142 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1143
1144 at_start_name = 1;
1145 while (i < len0)
1146 {
1147 /* Is this a symbol function? */
1148 if (at_start_name && encoded[i] == 'O')
1149 {
1150 int k;
1151
1152 for (k = 0; ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL; k += 1)
1153 {
1154 int op_len = strlen (ada_opname_table[k].encoded);
1155 if ((strncmp (ada_opname_table[k].encoded + 1, encoded + i + 1,
1156 op_len - 1) == 0)
1157 && !isalnum (encoded[i + op_len]))
1158 {
1159 strcpy (decoded + j, ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1160 at_start_name = 0;
1161 i += op_len;
1162 j += strlen (ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1163 break;
1164 }
1165 }
1166 if (ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL)
1167 continue;
1168 }
1169 at_start_name = 0;
1170
1171 /* Replace "TK__" with "__", which will eventually be translated
1172 into "." (just below). */
1173
1174 if (i < len0 - 4 && strncmp (encoded + i, "TK__", 4) == 0)
1175 i += 2;
1176
1177 /* Replace "__B_{DIGITS}+__" sequences by "__", which will eventually
1178 be translated into "." (just below). These are internal names
1179 generated for anonymous blocks inside which our symbol is nested. */
1180
1181 if (len0 - i > 5 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded [i+1] == '_'
1182 && encoded [i+2] == 'B' && encoded [i+3] == '_'
1183 && isdigit (encoded [i+4]))
1184 {
1185 int k = i + 5;
1186
1187 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1188 k++; /* Skip any extra digit. */
1189
1190 /* Double-check that the "__B_{DIGITS}+" sequence we found
1191 is indeed followed by "__". */
1192 if (len0 - k > 2 && encoded [k] == '_' && encoded [k+1] == '_')
1193 i = k;
1194 }
1195
1196 /* Remove _E{DIGITS}+[sb] */
1197
1198 /* Just as for protected object subprograms, there are 2 categories
1199 of subprograms created by the compiler for each entry. The first
1200 one implements the actual entry code, and has a suffix following
1201 the convention above; the second one implements the barrier and
1202 uses the same convention as above, except that the 'E' is replaced
1203 by a 'B'.
1204
1205 Just as above, we do not decode the name of barrier functions
1206 to give the user a clue that the code he is debugging has been
1207 internally generated. */
1208
1209 if (len0 - i > 3 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded[i+1] == 'E'
1210 && isdigit (encoded[i+2]))
1211 {
1212 int k = i + 3;
1213
1214 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1215 k++;
1216
1217 if (k < len0
1218 && (encoded[k] == 'b' || encoded[k] == 's'))
1219 {
1220 k++;
1221 /* Just as an extra precaution, make sure that if this
1222 suffix is followed by anything else, it is a '_'.
1223 Otherwise, we matched this sequence by accident. */
1224 if (k == len0
1225 || (k < len0 && encoded[k] == '_'))
1226 i = k;
1227 }
1228 }
1229
1230 /* Remove trailing "N" in [a-z0-9]+N__. The N is added by
1231 the GNAT front-end in protected object subprograms. */
1232
1233 if (i < len0 + 3
1234 && encoded[i] == 'N' && encoded[i+1] == '_' && encoded[i+2] == '_')
1235 {
1236 /* Backtrack a bit up until we reach either the begining of
1237 the encoded name, or "__". Make sure that we only find
1238 digits or lowercase characters. */
1239 const char *ptr = encoded + i - 1;
1240
1241 while (ptr >= encoded && is_lower_alphanum (ptr[0]))
1242 ptr--;
1243 if (ptr < encoded
1244 || (ptr > encoded && ptr[0] == '_' && ptr[-1] == '_'))
1245 i++;
1246 }
1247
1248 if (encoded[i] == 'X' && i != 0 && isalnum (encoded[i - 1]))
1249 {
1250 /* This is a X[bn]* sequence not separated from the previous
1251 part of the name with a non-alpha-numeric character (in other
1252 words, immediately following an alpha-numeric character), then
1253 verify that it is placed at the end of the encoded name. If
1254 not, then the encoding is not valid and we should abort the
1255 decoding. Otherwise, just skip it, it is used in body-nested
1256 package names. */
1257 do
1258 i += 1;
1259 while (i < len0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'));
1260 if (i < len0)
1261 goto Suppress;
1262 }
1263 else if (i < len0 - 2 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i + 1] == '_')
1264 {
1265 /* Replace '__' by '.'. */
1266 decoded[j] = '.';
1267 at_start_name = 1;
1268 i += 2;
1269 j += 1;
1270 }
1271 else
1272 {
1273 /* It's a character part of the decoded name, so just copy it
1274 over. */
1275 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1276 i += 1;
1277 j += 1;
1278 }
1279 }
1280 decoded[j] = '\000';
1281
1282 /* Decoded names should never contain any uppercase character.
1283 Double-check this, and abort the decoding if we find one. */
1284
1285 for (i = 0; decoded[i] != '\0'; i += 1)
1286 if (isupper (decoded[i]) || decoded[i] == ' ')
1287 goto Suppress;
1288
1289 if (strcmp (decoded, encoded) == 0)
1290 return encoded;
1291 else
1292 return decoded;
1293
1294 Suppress:
1295 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, strlen (encoded) + 3);
1296 decoded = decoding_buffer;
1297 if (encoded[0] == '<')
1298 strcpy (decoded, encoded);
1299 else
1300 xsnprintf (decoded, decoding_buffer_size, "<%s>", encoded);
1301 return decoded;
1302
1303 }
1304
1305 /* Table for keeping permanent unique copies of decoded names. Once
1306 allocated, names in this table are never released. While this is a
1307 storage leak, it should not be significant unless there are massive
1308 changes in the set of decoded names in successive versions of a
1309 symbol table loaded during a single session. */
1310 static struct htab *decoded_names_store;
1311
1312 /* Returns the decoded name of GSYMBOL, as for ada_decode, caching it
1313 in the language-specific part of GSYMBOL, if it has not been
1314 previously computed. Tries to save the decoded name in the same
1315 obstack as GSYMBOL, if possible, and otherwise on the heap (so that,
1316 in any case, the decoded symbol has a lifetime at least that of
1317 GSYMBOL).
1318 The GSYMBOL parameter is "mutable" in the C++ sense: logically
1319 const, but nevertheless modified to a semantically equivalent form
1320 when a decoded name is cached in it. */
1321
1322 const char *
1323 ada_decode_symbol (const struct general_symbol_info *arg)
1324 {
1325 struct general_symbol_info *gsymbol = (struct general_symbol_info *) arg;
1326 const char **resultp =
1327 &gsymbol->language_specific.mangled_lang.demangled_name;
1328
1329 if (!gsymbol->ada_mangled)
1330 {
1331 const char *decoded = ada_decode (gsymbol->name);
1332 struct obstack *obstack = gsymbol->language_specific.obstack;
1333
1334 gsymbol->ada_mangled = 1;
1335
1336 if (obstack != NULL)
1337 *resultp = obstack_copy0 (obstack, decoded, strlen (decoded));
1338 else
1339 {
1340 /* Sometimes, we can't find a corresponding objfile, in
1341 which case, we put the result on the heap. Since we only
1342 decode when needed, we hope this usually does not cause a
1343 significant memory leak (FIXME). */
1344
1345 char **slot = (char **) htab_find_slot (decoded_names_store,
1346 decoded, INSERT);
1347
1348 if (*slot == NULL)
1349 *slot = xstrdup (decoded);
1350 *resultp = *slot;
1351 }
1352 }
1353
1354 return *resultp;
1355 }
1356
1357 static char *
1358 ada_la_decode (const char *encoded, int options)
1359 {
1360 return xstrdup (ada_decode (encoded));
1361 }
1362
1363 /* Returns non-zero iff SYM_NAME matches NAME, ignoring any trailing
1364 suffixes that encode debugging information or leading _ada_ on
1365 SYM_NAME (see is_name_suffix commentary for the debugging
1366 information that is ignored). If WILD, then NAME need only match a
1367 suffix of SYM_NAME minus the same suffixes. Also returns 0 if
1368 either argument is NULL. */
1369
1370 static int
1371 match_name (const char *sym_name, const char *name, int wild)
1372 {
1373 if (sym_name == NULL || name == NULL)
1374 return 0;
1375 else if (wild)
1376 return wild_match (sym_name, name) == 0;
1377 else
1378 {
1379 int len_name = strlen (name);
1380
1381 return (strncmp (sym_name, name, len_name) == 0
1382 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name))
1383 || (strncmp (sym_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0
1384 && strncmp (sym_name + 5, name, len_name) == 0
1385 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name + 5));
1386 }
1387 }
1388 \f
1389
1390 /* Arrays */
1391
1392 /* Assuming that INDEX_DESC_TYPE is an ___XA structure, a structure
1393 generated by the GNAT compiler to describe the index type used
1394 for each dimension of an array, check whether it follows the latest
1395 known encoding. If not, fix it up to conform to the latest encoding.
1396 Otherwise, do nothing. This function also does nothing if
1397 INDEX_DESC_TYPE is NULL.
1398
1399 The GNAT encoding used to describle the array index type evolved a bit.
1400 Initially, the information would be provided through the name of each
1401 field of the structure type only, while the type of these fields was
1402 described as unspecified and irrelevant. The debugger was then expected
1403 to perform a global type lookup using the name of that field in order
1404 to get access to the full index type description. Because these global
1405 lookups can be very expensive, the encoding was later enhanced to make
1406 the global lookup unnecessary by defining the field type as being
1407 the full index type description.
1408
1409 The purpose of this routine is to allow us to support older versions
1410 of the compiler by detecting the use of the older encoding, and by
1411 fixing up the INDEX_DESC_TYPE to follow the new one (at this point,
1412 we essentially replace each field's meaningless type by the associated
1413 index subtype). */
1414
1415 void
1416 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (struct type *index_desc_type)
1417 {
1418 int i;
1419
1420 if (index_desc_type == NULL)
1421 return;
1422 gdb_assert (TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type) > 0);
1423
1424 /* Check if INDEX_DESC_TYPE follows the older encoding (it is sufficient
1425 to check one field only, no need to check them all). If not, return
1426 now.
1427
1428 If our INDEX_DESC_TYPE was generated using the older encoding,
1429 the field type should be a meaningless integer type whose name
1430 is not equal to the field name. */
1431 if (TYPE_NAME (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)) != NULL
1432 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)),
1433 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, 0)) == 0)
1434 return;
1435
1436 /* Fixup each field of INDEX_DESC_TYPE. */
1437 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type); i++)
1438 {
1439 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, i);
1440 struct type *raw_type = ada_check_typedef (ada_find_any_type (name));
1441
1442 if (raw_type)
1443 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, i) = raw_type;
1444 }
1445 }
1446
1447 /* Names of MAX_ADA_DIMENS bounds in P_BOUNDS fields of array descriptors. */
1448
1449 static char *bound_name[] = {
1450 "LB0", "UB0", "LB1", "UB1", "LB2", "UB2", "LB3", "UB3",
1451 "LB4", "UB4", "LB5", "UB5", "LB6", "UB6", "LB7", "UB7"
1452 };
1453
1454 /* Maximum number of array dimensions we are prepared to handle. */
1455
1456 #define MAX_ADA_DIMENS (sizeof(bound_name) / (2*sizeof(char *)))
1457
1458
1459 /* The desc_* routines return primitive portions of array descriptors
1460 (fat pointers). */
1461
1462 /* The descriptor or array type, if any, indicated by TYPE; removes
1463 level of indirection, if needed. */
1464
1465 static struct type *
1466 desc_base_type (struct type *type)
1467 {
1468 if (type == NULL)
1469 return NULL;
1470 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1471 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
1472 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
1473
1474 if (type != NULL
1475 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1476 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1477 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
1478 else
1479 return type;
1480 }
1481
1482 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thin" array pointer type. */
1483
1484 static int
1485 is_thin_pntr (struct type *type)
1486 {
1487 return
1488 is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT")
1489 || is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT___XVE");
1490 }
1491
1492 /* The descriptor type for thin pointer type TYPE. */
1493
1494 static struct type *
1495 thin_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1496 {
1497 struct type *base_type = desc_base_type (type);
1498
1499 if (base_type == NULL)
1500 return NULL;
1501 if (is_suffix (ada_type_name (base_type), "___XVE"))
1502 return base_type;
1503 else
1504 {
1505 struct type *alt_type = ada_find_parallel_type (base_type, "___XVE");
1506
1507 if (alt_type == NULL)
1508 return base_type;
1509 else
1510 return alt_type;
1511 }
1512 }
1513
1514 /* A pointer to the array data for thin-pointer value VAL. */
1515
1516 static struct value *
1517 thin_data_pntr (struct value *val)
1518 {
1519 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
1520 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1521
1522 data_type = lookup_pointer_type (data_type);
1523
1524 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1525 return value_cast (data_type, value_copy (val));
1526 else
1527 return value_from_longest (data_type, value_address (val));
1528 }
1529
1530 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thick" array pointer type. */
1531
1532 static int
1533 is_thick_pntr (struct type *type)
1534 {
1535 type = desc_base_type (type);
1536 return (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1537 && lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL);
1538 }
1539
1540 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1541 pointer to one, the type of its bounds data; otherwise, NULL. */
1542
1543 static struct type *
1544 desc_bounds_type (struct type *type)
1545 {
1546 struct type *r;
1547
1548 type = desc_base_type (type);
1549
1550 if (type == NULL)
1551 return NULL;
1552 else if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1553 {
1554 type = thin_descriptor_type (type);
1555 if (type == NULL)
1556 return NULL;
1557 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "BOUNDS", 1);
1558 if (r != NULL)
1559 return ada_check_typedef (r);
1560 }
1561 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1562 {
1563 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1);
1564 if (r != NULL)
1565 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (r)));
1566 }
1567 return NULL;
1568 }
1569
1570 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), or pointer to
1571 one, a pointer to its bounds data. Otherwise NULL. */
1572
1573 static struct value *
1574 desc_bounds (struct value *arr)
1575 {
1576 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1577
1578 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1579 {
1580 struct type *bounds_type =
1581 desc_bounds_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1582 LONGEST addr;
1583
1584 if (bounds_type == NULL)
1585 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1586
1587 /* NOTE: The following calculation is not really kosher, but
1588 since desc_type is an XVE-encoded type (and shouldn't be),
1589 the correct calculation is a real pain. FIXME (and fix GCC). */
1590 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1591 addr = value_as_long (arr);
1592 else
1593 addr = value_address (arr);
1594
1595 return
1596 value_from_longest (lookup_pointer_type (bounds_type),
1597 addr - TYPE_LENGTH (bounds_type));
1598 }
1599
1600 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1601 {
1602 struct value *p_bounds = value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_BOUNDS", NULL,
1603 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1604 struct type *p_bounds_type = value_type (p_bounds);
1605
1606 if (p_bounds_type
1607 && TYPE_CODE (p_bounds_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1608 {
1609 struct type *target_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_bounds_type);
1610
1611 if (TYPE_STUB (target_type))
1612 p_bounds = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type
1613 (ada_check_typedef (target_type)),
1614 p_bounds);
1615 }
1616 else
1617 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1618
1619 return p_bounds;
1620 }
1621 else
1622 return NULL;
1623 }
1624
1625 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1626 position of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1627
1628 static int
1629 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *type)
1630 {
1631 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 1);
1632 }
1633
1634 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1635 size of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1636
1637 static int
1638 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *type)
1639 {
1640 type = desc_base_type (type);
1641
1642 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1) > 0)
1643 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1);
1644 else
1645 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 1)));
1646 }
1647
1648 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1649 pointer to one, the type of its array data (a array-with-no-bounds type);
1650 otherwise, NULL. Use ada_type_of_array to get an array type with bounds
1651 data. */
1652
1653 static struct type *
1654 desc_data_target_type (struct type *type)
1655 {
1656 type = desc_base_type (type);
1657
1658 /* NOTE: The following is bogus; see comment in desc_bounds. */
1659 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1660 return desc_base_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (thin_descriptor_type (type), 1));
1661 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1662 {
1663 struct type *data_type = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1);
1664
1665 if (data_type
1666 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (data_type)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1667 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type));
1668 }
1669
1670 return NULL;
1671 }
1672
1673 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), a pointer to
1674 its array data. */
1675
1676 static struct value *
1677 desc_data (struct value *arr)
1678 {
1679 struct type *type = value_type (arr);
1680
1681 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1682 return thin_data_pntr (arr);
1683 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1684 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_ARRAY", NULL,
1685 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1686 else
1687 return NULL;
1688 }
1689
1690
1691 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1692 position of the field containing the address of the data. */
1693
1694 static int
1695 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *type)
1696 {
1697 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 0);
1698 }
1699
1700 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1701 size of the field containing the address of the data. */
1702
1703 static int
1704 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *type)
1705 {
1706 type = desc_base_type (type);
1707
1708 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
1709 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0);
1710 else
1711 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
1712 }
1713
1714 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure (or pointer to one), return
1715 the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1716 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1717
1718 static struct value *
1719 desc_one_bound (struct value *bounds, int i, int which)
1720 {
1721 return value_struct_elt (&bounds, NULL, bound_name[2 * i + which - 2], NULL,
1722 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor bounds"));
1723 }
1724
1725 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit position
1726 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1727 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1728
1729 static int
1730 desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1731 {
1732 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 2 * i + which - 2);
1733 }
1734
1735 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit field size
1736 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1737 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1738
1739 static int
1740 desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1741 {
1742 type = desc_base_type (type);
1743
1744 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2) > 0)
1745 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2);
1746 else
1747 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 2 * i + which - 2));
1748 }
1749
1750 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-bounds structure, the type of its
1751 Ith bound (numbering from 1). Otherwise, NULL. */
1752
1753 static struct type *
1754 desc_index_type (struct type *type, int i)
1755 {
1756 type = desc_base_type (type);
1757
1758 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1759 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, bound_name[2 * i - 2], 1);
1760 else
1761 return NULL;
1762 }
1763
1764 /* The number of index positions in the array-bounds type TYPE.
1765 Return 0 if TYPE is NULL. */
1766
1767 static int
1768 desc_arity (struct type *type)
1769 {
1770 type = desc_base_type (type);
1771
1772 if (type != NULL)
1773 return TYPE_NFIELDS (type) / 2;
1774 return 0;
1775 }
1776
1777 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type (not a pointer to one) or
1778 an array descriptor type (representing an unconstrained array
1779 type). */
1780
1781 static int
1782 ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *type)
1783 {
1784 if (type == NULL)
1785 return 0;
1786 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1787 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1788 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type));
1789 }
1790
1791 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents any kind of array in Ada, or a pointer
1792 * to one. */
1793
1794 static int
1795 ada_is_array_type (struct type *type)
1796 {
1797 while (type != NULL
1798 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1799 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1800 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
1801 return ada_is_direct_array_type (type);
1802 }
1803
1804 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type or pointer to one. */
1805
1806 int
1807 ada_is_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1808 {
1809 if (type == NULL)
1810 return 0;
1811 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1812 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1813 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1814 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
1815 == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY));
1816 }
1817
1818 /* Non-zero iff TYPE belongs to a GNAT array descriptor. */
1819
1820 int
1821 ada_is_array_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1822 {
1823 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
1824
1825 if (type == NULL)
1826 return 0;
1827 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1828 return (data_type != NULL
1829 && TYPE_CODE (data_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1830 && desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type)) > 0);
1831 }
1832
1833 /* Non-zero iff type is a partially mal-formed GNAT array
1834 descriptor. FIXME: This is to compensate for some problems with
1835 debugging output from GNAT. Re-examine periodically to see if it
1836 is still needed. */
1837
1838 int
1839 ada_is_bogus_array_descriptor (struct type *type)
1840 {
1841 return
1842 type != NULL
1843 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1844 && (lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL
1845 || lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1) != NULL)
1846 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1847 }
1848
1849
1850 /* If ARR has a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array descriptor,
1851 (fat pointer) returns the type of the array data described---specifically,
1852 a pointer-to-array type. If BOUNDS is non-zero, the bounds data are filled
1853 in from the descriptor; otherwise, they are left unspecified. If
1854 the ARR denotes a null array descriptor and BOUNDS is non-zero,
1855 returns NULL. The result is simply the type of ARR if ARR is not
1856 a descriptor. */
1857 struct type *
1858 ada_type_of_array (struct value *arr, int bounds)
1859 {
1860 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1861 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1862
1863 if (!ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1864 return value_type (arr);
1865
1866 if (!bounds)
1867 {
1868 struct type *array_type =
1869 ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (value_type (arr)));
1870
1871 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1872 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (array_type, 0) =
1873 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1874
1875 return array_type;
1876 }
1877 else
1878 {
1879 struct type *elt_type;
1880 int arity;
1881 struct value *descriptor;
1882
1883 elt_type = ada_array_element_type (value_type (arr), -1);
1884 arity = ada_array_arity (value_type (arr));
1885
1886 if (elt_type == NULL || arity == 0)
1887 return ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1888
1889 descriptor = desc_bounds (arr);
1890 if (value_as_long (descriptor) == 0)
1891 return NULL;
1892 while (arity > 0)
1893 {
1894 struct type *range_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1895 struct type *array_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1896 struct value *low = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 0);
1897 struct value *high = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 1);
1898
1899 arity -= 1;
1900 create_range_type (range_type, value_type (low),
1901 longest_to_int (value_as_long (low)),
1902 longest_to_int (value_as_long (high)));
1903 elt_type = create_array_type (array_type, elt_type, range_type);
1904
1905 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1906 {
1907 /* We need to store the element packed bitsize, as well as
1908 recompute the array size, because it was previously
1909 computed based on the unpacked element size. */
1910 LONGEST lo = value_as_long (low);
1911 LONGEST hi = value_as_long (high);
1912
1913 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) =
1914 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1915 /* If the array has no element, then the size is already
1916 zero, and does not need to be recomputed. */
1917 if (lo < hi)
1918 {
1919 int array_bitsize =
1920 (hi - lo + 1) * TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
1921
1922 TYPE_LENGTH (array_type) = (array_bitsize + 7) / 8;
1923 }
1924 }
1925 }
1926
1927 return lookup_pointer_type (elt_type);
1928 }
1929 }
1930
1931 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1932 Otherwise, returns either a standard GDB array with bounds set
1933 appropriately or, if ARR is a non-null fat pointer, a pointer to a standard
1934 GDB array. Returns NULL if ARR is a null fat pointer. */
1935
1936 struct value *
1937 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (struct value *arr)
1938 {
1939 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1940 {
1941 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arr, 1);
1942
1943 if (arrType == NULL)
1944 return NULL;
1945 return value_cast (arrType, value_copy (desc_data (arr)));
1946 }
1947 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1948 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1949 else
1950 return arr;
1951 }
1952
1953 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1954 Otherwise, returns a standard GDB array describing ARR (which may
1955 be ARR itself if it already is in the proper form). */
1956
1957 struct value *
1958 ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *arr)
1959 {
1960 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1961 {
1962 struct value *arrVal = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (arr);
1963
1964 if (arrVal == NULL)
1965 error (_("Bounds unavailable for null array pointer."));
1966 check_size (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (arrVal)));
1967 return value_ind (arrVal);
1968 }
1969 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1970 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1971 else
1972 return arr;
1973 }
1974
1975 /* If TYPE represents a GNAT array type, return it translated to an
1976 ordinary GDB array type (possibly with BITSIZE fields indicating
1977 packing). For other types, is the identity. */
1978
1979 struct type *
1980 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1981 {
1982 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
1983 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type);
1984
1985 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
1986 return ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (type));
1987
1988 return type;
1989 }
1990
1991 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT packed-array type. */
1992
1993 static int
1994 ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1995 {
1996 if (type == NULL)
1997 return 0;
1998 type = desc_base_type (type);
1999 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2000 return
2001 ada_type_name (type) != NULL
2002 && strstr (ada_type_name (type), "___XP") != NULL;
2003 }
2004
2005 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT constrained
2006 packed-array type. */
2007
2008 int
2009 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2010 {
2011 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
2012 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
2013 }
2014
2015 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents an array descriptor for a
2016 unconstrained packed-array type. */
2017
2018 static int
2019 ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2020 {
2021 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
2022 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
2023 }
2024
2025 /* Given that TYPE encodes a packed array type (constrained or unconstrained),
2026 return the size of its elements in bits. */
2027
2028 static long
2029 decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *type)
2030 {
2031 const char *raw_name;
2032 const char *tail;
2033 long bits;
2034
2035 /* Access to arrays implemented as fat pointers are encoded as a typedef
2036 of the fat pointer type. We need the name of the fat pointer type
2037 to do the decoding, so strip the typedef layer. */
2038 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
2039 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
2040
2041 raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
2042 if (!raw_name)
2043 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
2044
2045 if (!raw_name)
2046 return 0;
2047
2048 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
2049 gdb_assert (tail != NULL);
2050
2051 if (sscanf (tail + sizeof ("___XP") - 1, "%ld", &bits) != 1)
2052 {
2053 lim_warning
2054 (_("could not understand bit size information on packed array"));
2055 return 0;
2056 }
2057
2058 return bits;
2059 }
2060
2061 /* Given that TYPE is a standard GDB array type with all bounds filled
2062 in, and that the element size of its ultimate scalar constituents
2063 (that is, either its elements, or, if it is an array of arrays, its
2064 elements' elements, etc.) is *ELT_BITS, return an identical type,
2065 but with the bit sizes of its elements (and those of any
2066 constituent arrays) recorded in the BITSIZE components of its
2067 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE values, and with *ELT_BITS set to its total size
2068 in bits. */
2069
2070 static struct type *
2071 constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type, long *elt_bits)
2072 {
2073 struct type *new_elt_type;
2074 struct type *new_type;
2075 struct type *index_type_desc;
2076 struct type *index_type;
2077 LONGEST low_bound, high_bound;
2078
2079 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2080 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2081 return type;
2082
2083 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2084 if (index_type_desc)
2085 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, 0),
2086 NULL);
2087 else
2088 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type);
2089
2090 new_type = alloc_type_copy (type);
2091 new_elt_type =
2092 constrained_packed_array_type (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2093 elt_bits);
2094 create_array_type (new_type, new_elt_type, index_type);
2095 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (new_type, 0) = *elt_bits;
2096 TYPE_NAME (new_type) = ada_type_name (type);
2097
2098 if (get_discrete_bounds (index_type, &low_bound, &high_bound) < 0)
2099 low_bound = high_bound = 0;
2100 if (high_bound < low_bound)
2101 *elt_bits = TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) = 0;
2102 else
2103 {
2104 *elt_bits *= (high_bound - low_bound + 1);
2105 TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) =
2106 (*elt_bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2107 }
2108
2109 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (new_type) = 1;
2110 return new_type;
2111 }
2112
2113 /* The array type encoded by TYPE, where
2114 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (TYPE). */
2115
2116 static struct type *
2117 decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2118 {
2119 const char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
2120 char *name;
2121 const char *tail;
2122 struct type *shadow_type;
2123 long bits;
2124
2125 if (!raw_name)
2126 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
2127
2128 if (!raw_name)
2129 return NULL;
2130
2131 name = (char *) alloca (strlen (raw_name) + 1);
2132 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
2133 type = desc_base_type (type);
2134
2135 memcpy (name, raw_name, tail - raw_name);
2136 name[tail - raw_name] = '\000';
2137
2138 shadow_type = ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
2139
2140 if (shadow_type == NULL)
2141 {
2142 lim_warning (_("could not find bounds information on packed array"));
2143 return NULL;
2144 }
2145 CHECK_TYPEDEF (shadow_type);
2146
2147 if (TYPE_CODE (shadow_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2148 {
2149 lim_warning (_("could not understand bounds "
2150 "information on packed array"));
2151 return NULL;
2152 }
2153
2154 bits = decode_packed_array_bitsize (type);
2155 return constrained_packed_array_type (shadow_type, &bits);
2156 }
2157
2158 /* Given that ARR is a struct value *indicating a GNAT constrained packed
2159 array, returns a simple array that denotes that array. Its type is a
2160 standard GDB array type except that the BITSIZEs of the array
2161 target types are set to the number of bits in each element, and the
2162 type length is set appropriately. */
2163
2164 static struct value *
2165 decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *arr)
2166 {
2167 struct type *type;
2168
2169 arr = ada_coerce_ref (arr);
2170
2171 /* If our value is a pointer, then dererence it. Make sure that
2172 this operation does not cause the target type to be fixed, as
2173 this would indirectly cause this array to be decoded. The rest
2174 of the routine assumes that the array hasn't been decoded yet,
2175 so we use the basic "value_ind" routine to perform the dereferencing,
2176 as opposed to using "ada_value_ind". */
2177 if (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr))) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2178 arr = value_ind (arr);
2179
2180 type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
2181 if (type == NULL)
2182 {
2183 error (_("can't unpack array"));
2184 return NULL;
2185 }
2186
2187 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (arr)))
2188 && ada_is_modular_type (value_type (arr)))
2189 {
2190 /* This is a (right-justified) modular type representing a packed
2191 array with no wrapper. In order to interpret the value through
2192 the (left-justified) packed array type we just built, we must
2193 first left-justify it. */
2194 int bit_size, bit_pos;
2195 ULONGEST mod;
2196
2197 mod = ada_modulus (value_type (arr)) - 1;
2198 bit_size = 0;
2199 while (mod > 0)
2200 {
2201 bit_size += 1;
2202 mod >>= 1;
2203 }
2204 bit_pos = HOST_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arr)) - bit_size;
2205 arr = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL,
2206 bit_pos / HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2207 bit_pos % HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2208 bit_size,
2209 type);
2210 }
2211
2212 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (arr, type);
2213 }
2214
2215
2216 /* The value of the element of packed array ARR at the ARITY indices
2217 given in IND. ARR must be a simple array. */
2218
2219 static struct value *
2220 value_subscript_packed (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2221 {
2222 int i;
2223 int bits, elt_off, bit_off;
2224 long elt_total_bit_offset;
2225 struct type *elt_type;
2226 struct value *v;
2227
2228 bits = 0;
2229 elt_total_bit_offset = 0;
2230 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2231 for (i = 0; i < arity; i += 1)
2232 {
2233 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2234 || TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) == 0)
2235 error
2236 (_("attempt to do packed indexing of "
2237 "something other than a packed array"));
2238 else
2239 {
2240 struct type *range_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
2241 LONGEST lowerbound, upperbound;
2242 LONGEST idx;
2243
2244 if (get_discrete_bounds (range_type, &lowerbound, &upperbound) < 0)
2245 {
2246 lim_warning (_("don't know bounds of array"));
2247 lowerbound = upperbound = 0;
2248 }
2249
2250 idx = pos_atr (ind[i]);
2251 if (idx < lowerbound || idx > upperbound)
2252 lim_warning (_("packed array index %ld out of bounds"),
2253 (long) idx);
2254 bits = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
2255 elt_total_bit_offset += (idx - lowerbound) * bits;
2256 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
2257 }
2258 }
2259 elt_off = elt_total_bit_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2260 bit_off = elt_total_bit_offset % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2261
2262 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL, elt_off, bit_off,
2263 bits, elt_type);
2264 return v;
2265 }
2266
2267 /* Non-zero iff TYPE includes negative integer values. */
2268
2269 static int
2270 has_negatives (struct type *type)
2271 {
2272 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2273 {
2274 default:
2275 return 0;
2276 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
2277 return !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
2278 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
2279 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type) < 0;
2280 }
2281 }
2282
2283
2284 /* Create a new value of type TYPE from the contents of OBJ starting
2285 at byte OFFSET, and bit offset BIT_OFFSET within that byte,
2286 proceeding for BIT_SIZE bits. If OBJ is an lval in memory, then
2287 assigning through the result will set the field fetched from.
2288 VALADDR is ignored unless OBJ is NULL, in which case,
2289 VALADDR+OFFSET must address the start of storage containing the
2290 packed value. The value returned in this case is never an lval.
2291 Assumes 0 <= BIT_OFFSET < HOST_CHAR_BIT. */
2292
2293 struct value *
2294 ada_value_primitive_packed_val (struct value *obj, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
2295 long offset, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
2296 struct type *type)
2297 {
2298 struct value *v;
2299 int src, /* Index into the source area */
2300 targ, /* Index into the target area */
2301 srcBitsLeft, /* Number of source bits left to move */
2302 nsrc, ntarg, /* Number of source and target bytes */
2303 unusedLS, /* Number of bits in next significant
2304 byte of source that are unused */
2305 accumSize; /* Number of meaningful bits in accum */
2306 unsigned char *bytes; /* First byte containing data to unpack */
2307 unsigned char *unpacked;
2308 unsigned long accum; /* Staging area for bits being transferred */
2309 unsigned char sign;
2310 int len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2311 /* Transmit bytes from least to most significant; delta is the direction
2312 the indices move. */
2313 int delta = gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)) ? -1 : 1;
2314
2315 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2316
2317 if (obj == NULL)
2318 {
2319 v = allocate_value (type);
2320 bytes = (unsigned char *) (valaddr + offset);
2321 }
2322 else if (VALUE_LVAL (obj) == lval_memory && value_lazy (obj))
2323 {
2324 v = value_at (type, value_address (obj));
2325 bytes = (unsigned char *) alloca (len);
2326 read_memory (value_address (v) + offset, bytes, len);
2327 }
2328 else
2329 {
2330 v = allocate_value (type);
2331 bytes = (unsigned char *) value_contents (obj) + offset;
2332 }
2333
2334 if (obj != NULL)
2335 {
2336 long new_offset = offset;
2337
2338 set_value_component_location (v, obj);
2339 set_value_bitpos (v, bit_offset + value_bitpos (obj));
2340 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2341 if (value_bitpos (v) >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2342 {
2343 ++new_offset;
2344 set_value_bitpos (v, value_bitpos (v) - HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2345 }
2346 set_value_offset (v, new_offset);
2347
2348 /* Also set the parent value. This is needed when trying to
2349 assign a new value (in inferior memory). */
2350 set_value_parent (v, obj);
2351 }
2352 else
2353 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2354 unpacked = (unsigned char *) value_contents (v);
2355
2356 srcBitsLeft = bit_size;
2357 nsrc = len;
2358 ntarg = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
2359 sign = 0;
2360 if (bit_size == 0)
2361 {
2362 memset (unpacked, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2363 return v;
2364 }
2365 else if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)))
2366 {
2367 src = len - 1;
2368 if (has_negatives (type)
2369 && ((bytes[0] << bit_offset) & (1 << (HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1))))
2370 sign = ~0;
2371
2372 unusedLS =
2373 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - (bit_size + bit_offset) % HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2374 % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2375
2376 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2377 {
2378 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
2379 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
2380 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
2381 /* Non-scalar values must be aligned at a byte boundary... */
2382 accumSize =
2383 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - bit_size % HOST_CHAR_BIT) % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2384 /* ... And are placed at the beginning (most-significant) bytes
2385 of the target. */
2386 targ = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1;
2387 ntarg = targ + 1;
2388 break;
2389 default:
2390 accumSize = 0;
2391 targ = TYPE_LENGTH (type) - 1;
2392 break;
2393 }
2394 }
2395 else
2396 {
2397 int sign_bit_offset = (bit_size + bit_offset - 1) % 8;
2398
2399 src = targ = 0;
2400 unusedLS = bit_offset;
2401 accumSize = 0;
2402
2403 if (has_negatives (type) && (bytes[len - 1] & (1 << sign_bit_offset)))
2404 sign = ~0;
2405 }
2406
2407 accum = 0;
2408 while (nsrc > 0)
2409 {
2410 /* Mask for removing bits of the next source byte that are not
2411 part of the value. */
2412 unsigned int unusedMSMask =
2413 (1 << (srcBitsLeft >= HOST_CHAR_BIT ? HOST_CHAR_BIT : srcBitsLeft)) -
2414 1;
2415 /* Sign-extend bits for this byte. */
2416 unsigned int signMask = sign & ~unusedMSMask;
2417
2418 accum |=
2419 (((bytes[src] >> unusedLS) & unusedMSMask) | signMask) << accumSize;
2420 accumSize += HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2421 if (accumSize >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2422 {
2423 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2424 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2425 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2426 ntarg -= 1;
2427 targ += delta;
2428 }
2429 srcBitsLeft -= HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2430 unusedLS = 0;
2431 nsrc -= 1;
2432 src += delta;
2433 }
2434 while (ntarg > 0)
2435 {
2436 accum |= sign << accumSize;
2437 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2438 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2439 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2440 ntarg -= 1;
2441 targ += delta;
2442 }
2443
2444 return v;
2445 }
2446
2447 /* Move N bits from SOURCE, starting at bit offset SRC_OFFSET to
2448 TARGET, starting at bit offset TARG_OFFSET. SOURCE and TARGET must
2449 not overlap. */
2450 static void
2451 move_bits (gdb_byte *target, int targ_offset, const gdb_byte *source,
2452 int src_offset, int n, int bits_big_endian_p)
2453 {
2454 unsigned int accum, mask;
2455 int accum_bits, chunk_size;
2456
2457 target += targ_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2458 targ_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2459 source += src_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2460 src_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2461 if (bits_big_endian_p)
2462 {
2463 accum = (unsigned char) *source;
2464 source += 1;
2465 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2466
2467 while (n > 0)
2468 {
2469 int unused_right;
2470
2471 accum = (accum << HOST_CHAR_BIT) + (unsigned char) *source;
2472 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2473 source += 1;
2474 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2475 if (chunk_size > n)
2476 chunk_size = n;
2477 unused_right = HOST_CHAR_BIT - (chunk_size + targ_offset);
2478 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << unused_right;
2479 *target =
2480 (*target & ~mask)
2481 | ((accum >> (accum_bits - chunk_size - unused_right)) & mask);
2482 n -= chunk_size;
2483 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2484 target += 1;
2485 targ_offset = 0;
2486 }
2487 }
2488 else
2489 {
2490 accum = (unsigned char) *source >> src_offset;
2491 source += 1;
2492 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2493
2494 while (n > 0)
2495 {
2496 accum = accum + ((unsigned char) *source << accum_bits);
2497 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2498 source += 1;
2499 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2500 if (chunk_size > n)
2501 chunk_size = n;
2502 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << targ_offset;
2503 *target = (*target & ~mask) | ((accum << targ_offset) & mask);
2504 n -= chunk_size;
2505 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2506 accum >>= chunk_size;
2507 target += 1;
2508 targ_offset = 0;
2509 }
2510 }
2511 }
2512
2513 /* Store the contents of FROMVAL into the location of TOVAL.
2514 Return a new value with the location of TOVAL and contents of
2515 FROMVAL. Handles assignment into packed fields that have
2516 floating-point or non-scalar types. */
2517
2518 static struct value *
2519 ada_value_assign (struct value *toval, struct value *fromval)
2520 {
2521 struct type *type = value_type (toval);
2522 int bits = value_bitsize (toval);
2523
2524 toval = ada_coerce_ref (toval);
2525 fromval = ada_coerce_ref (fromval);
2526
2527 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (toval)))
2528 toval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (toval);
2529 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (fromval)))
2530 fromval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (fromval);
2531
2532 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (toval))
2533 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
2534
2535 if (VALUE_LVAL (toval) == lval_memory
2536 && bits > 0
2537 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT
2538 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT))
2539 {
2540 int len = (value_bitpos (toval)
2541 + bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2542 int from_size;
2543 gdb_byte *buffer = alloca (len);
2544 struct value *val;
2545 CORE_ADDR to_addr = value_address (toval);
2546
2547 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
2548 fromval = value_cast (type, fromval);
2549
2550 read_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2551 from_size = value_bitsize (fromval);
2552 if (from_size == 0)
2553 from_size = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (fromval)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
2554 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)))
2555 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2556 value_contents (fromval), from_size - bits, bits, 1);
2557 else
2558 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2559 value_contents (fromval), 0, bits, 0);
2560 write_memory_with_notification (to_addr, buffer, len);
2561
2562 val = value_copy (toval);
2563 memcpy (value_contents_raw (val), value_contents (fromval),
2564 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2565 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
2566
2567 return val;
2568 }
2569
2570 return value_assign (toval, fromval);
2571 }
2572
2573
2574 /* Given that COMPONENT is a memory lvalue that is part of the lvalue
2575 * CONTAINER, assign the contents of VAL to COMPONENTS's place in
2576 * CONTAINER. Modifies the VALUE_CONTENTS of CONTAINER only, not
2577 * COMPONENT, and not the inferior's memory. The current contents
2578 * of COMPONENT are ignored. */
2579 static void
2580 value_assign_to_component (struct value *container, struct value *component,
2581 struct value *val)
2582 {
2583 LONGEST offset_in_container =
2584 (LONGEST) (value_address (component) - value_address (container));
2585 int bit_offset_in_container =
2586 value_bitpos (component) - value_bitpos (container);
2587 int bits;
2588
2589 val = value_cast (value_type (component), val);
2590
2591 if (value_bitsize (component) == 0)
2592 bits = TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component));
2593 else
2594 bits = value_bitsize (component);
2595
2596 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (container))))
2597 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2598 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2599 value_contents (val),
2600 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT - bits,
2601 bits, 1);
2602 else
2603 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2604 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2605 value_contents (val), 0, bits, 0);
2606 }
2607
2608 /* The value of the element of array ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2609 ARR may be either a simple array, GNAT array descriptor, or pointer
2610 thereto. */
2611
2612 struct value *
2613 ada_value_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2614 {
2615 int k;
2616 struct value *elt;
2617 struct type *elt_type;
2618
2619 elt = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arr);
2620
2621 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2622 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2623 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) > 0)
2624 return value_subscript_packed (elt, arity, ind);
2625
2626 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2627 {
2628 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2629 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2630 elt = value_subscript (elt, pos_atr (ind[k]));
2631 }
2632 return elt;
2633 }
2634
2635 /* Assuming ARR is a pointer to a standard GDB array of type TYPE, the
2636 value of the element of *ARR at the ARITY indices given in
2637 IND. Does not read the entire array into memory. */
2638
2639 static struct value *
2640 ada_value_ptr_subscript (struct value *arr, struct type *type, int arity,
2641 struct value **ind)
2642 {
2643 int k;
2644
2645 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2646 {
2647 LONGEST lwb, upb;
2648
2649 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2650 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2651 arr = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2652 value_copy (arr));
2653 get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), &lwb, &upb);
2654 arr = value_ptradd (arr, pos_atr (ind[k]) - lwb);
2655 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2656 }
2657
2658 return value_ind (arr);
2659 }
2660
2661 /* Given that ARRAY_PTR is a pointer or reference to an array of type TYPE (the
2662 actual type of ARRAY_PTR is ignored), returns the Ada slice of HIGH-LOW+1
2663 elements starting at index LOW. The lower bound of this array is LOW, as
2664 per Ada rules. */
2665 static struct value *
2666 ada_value_slice_from_ptr (struct value *array_ptr, struct type *type,
2667 int low, int high)
2668 {
2669 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (type);
2670 CORE_ADDR base = value_as_address (array_ptr)
2671 + ((low - ada_discrete_type_low_bound (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0)))
2672 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0)));
2673 struct type *index_type =
2674 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0)),
2675 low, high);
2676 struct type *slice_type =
2677 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), index_type);
2678
2679 return value_at_lazy (slice_type, base);
2680 }
2681
2682
2683 static struct value *
2684 ada_value_slice (struct value *array, int low, int high)
2685 {
2686 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
2687 struct type *index_type =
2688 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), low, high);
2689 struct type *slice_type =
2690 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type);
2691
2692 return value_cast (slice_type, value_slice (array, low, high - low + 1));
2693 }
2694
2695 /* If type is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2696 descriptor, returns the number of dimensions for type. If arr is a
2697 simple array, returns the number of "array of"s that prefix its
2698 type designation. Otherwise, returns 0. */
2699
2700 int
2701 ada_array_arity (struct type *type)
2702 {
2703 int arity;
2704
2705 if (type == NULL)
2706 return 0;
2707
2708 type = desc_base_type (type);
2709
2710 arity = 0;
2711 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2712 return desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type));
2713 else
2714 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2715 {
2716 arity += 1;
2717 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
2718 }
2719
2720 return arity;
2721 }
2722
2723 /* If TYPE is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2724 descriptor or a simple array type, returns the element type for
2725 TYPE after indexing by NINDICES indices, or by all indices if
2726 NINDICES is -1. Otherwise, returns NULL. */
2727
2728 struct type *
2729 ada_array_element_type (struct type *type, int nindices)
2730 {
2731 type = desc_base_type (type);
2732
2733 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2734 {
2735 int k;
2736 struct type *p_array_type;
2737
2738 p_array_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
2739
2740 k = ada_array_arity (type);
2741 if (k == 0)
2742 return NULL;
2743
2744 /* Initially p_array_type = elt_type(*)[]...(k times)...[]. */
2745 if (nindices >= 0 && k > nindices)
2746 k = nindices;
2747 while (k > 0 && p_array_type != NULL)
2748 {
2749 p_array_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type));
2750 k -= 1;
2751 }
2752 return p_array_type;
2753 }
2754 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2755 {
2756 while (nindices != 0 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2757 {
2758 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2759 nindices -= 1;
2760 }
2761 return type;
2762 }
2763
2764 return NULL;
2765 }
2766
2767 /* The type of nth index in arrays of given type (n numbering from 1).
2768 Does not examine memory. Throws an error if N is invalid or TYPE
2769 is not an array type. NAME is the name of the Ada attribute being
2770 evaluated ('range, 'first, 'last, or 'length); it is used in building
2771 the error message. */
2772
2773 static struct type *
2774 ada_index_type (struct type *type, int n, const char *name)
2775 {
2776 struct type *result_type;
2777
2778 type = desc_base_type (type);
2779
2780 if (n < 0 || n > ada_array_arity (type))
2781 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"), name);
2782
2783 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (type))
2784 {
2785 int i;
2786
2787 for (i = 1; i < n; i += 1)
2788 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2789 result_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2790 /* FIXME: The stabs type r(0,0);bound;bound in an array type
2791 has a target type of TYPE_CODE_UNDEF. We compensate here, but
2792 perhaps stabsread.c would make more sense. */
2793 if (result_type && TYPE_CODE (result_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF)
2794 result_type = NULL;
2795 }
2796 else
2797 {
2798 result_type = desc_index_type (desc_bounds_type (type), n);
2799 if (result_type == NULL)
2800 error (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array"));
2801 }
2802
2803 return result_type;
2804 }
2805
2806 /* Given that arr is an array type, returns the lower bound of the
2807 Nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2808 WHICH is 1. This returns bounds 0 .. -1 if ARR_TYPE is an
2809 array-descriptor type. It works for other arrays with bounds supplied
2810 by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2811
2812 static LONGEST
2813 ada_array_bound_from_type (struct type *arr_type, int n, int which)
2814 {
2815 struct type *type, *index_type_desc, *index_type;
2816 int i;
2817
2818 gdb_assert (which == 0 || which == 1);
2819
2820 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2821 arr_type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type);
2822
2823 if (arr_type == NULL || !ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2824 return (LONGEST) - which;
2825
2826 if (TYPE_CODE (arr_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2827 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (arr_type);
2828 else
2829 type = arr_type;
2830
2831 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2832 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
2833 if (index_type_desc != NULL)
2834 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, n - 1),
2835 NULL);
2836 else
2837 {
2838 struct type *elt_type = check_typedef (type);
2839
2840 for (i = 1; i < n; i++)
2841 elt_type = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
2842
2843 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
2844 }
2845
2846 return
2847 (LONGEST) (which == 0
2848 ? ada_discrete_type_low_bound (index_type)
2849 : ada_discrete_type_high_bound (index_type));
2850 }
2851
2852 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the lower bound of the
2853 nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2854 WHICH is 1. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2855 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2856
2857 static LONGEST
2858 ada_array_bound (struct value *arr, int n, int which)
2859 {
2860 struct type *arr_type = value_type (arr);
2861
2862 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2863 return ada_array_bound (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n, which);
2864 else if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2865 return ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, which);
2866 else
2867 return value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, which));
2868 }
2869
2870 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the length of the
2871 nth index. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2872 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants.
2873 Does not work for arrays indexed by enumeration types with representation
2874 clauses at the moment. */
2875
2876 static LONGEST
2877 ada_array_length (struct value *arr, int n)
2878 {
2879 struct type *arr_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2880
2881 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2882 return ada_array_length (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n);
2883
2884 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2885 return (ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 1)
2886 - ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 0) + 1);
2887 else
2888 return (value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 1))
2889 - value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 0)) + 1);
2890 }
2891
2892 /* An empty array whose type is that of ARR_TYPE (an array type),
2893 with bounds LOW to LOW-1. */
2894
2895 static struct value *
2896 empty_array (struct type *arr_type, int low)
2897 {
2898 struct type *arr_type0 = ada_check_typedef (arr_type);
2899 struct type *index_type =
2900 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type0)),
2901 low, low - 1);
2902 struct type *elt_type = ada_array_element_type (arr_type0, 1);
2903
2904 return allocate_value (create_array_type (NULL, elt_type, index_type));
2905 }
2906 \f
2907
2908 /* Name resolution */
2909
2910 /* The "decoded" name for the user-definable Ada operator corresponding
2911 to OP. */
2912
2913 static const char *
2914 ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode op)
2915 {
2916 int i;
2917
2918 for (i = 0; ada_opname_table[i].encoded != NULL; i += 1)
2919 {
2920 if (ada_opname_table[i].op == op)
2921 return ada_opname_table[i].decoded;
2922 }
2923 error (_("Could not find operator name for opcode"));
2924 }
2925
2926
2927 /* Same as evaluate_type (*EXP), but resolves ambiguous symbol
2928 references (marked by OP_VAR_VALUE nodes in which the symbol has an
2929 undefined namespace) and converts operators that are
2930 user-defined into appropriate function calls. If CONTEXT_TYPE is
2931 non-null, it provides a preferred result type [at the moment, only
2932 type void has any effect---causing procedures to be preferred over
2933 functions in calls]. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates that a non-void
2934 return type is preferred. May change (expand) *EXP. */
2935
2936 static void
2937 resolve (struct expression **expp, int void_context_p)
2938 {
2939 struct type *context_type = NULL;
2940 int pc = 0;
2941
2942 if (void_context_p)
2943 context_type = builtin_type ((*expp)->gdbarch)->builtin_void;
2944
2945 resolve_subexp (expp, &pc, 1, context_type);
2946 }
2947
2948 /* Resolve the operator of the subexpression beginning at
2949 position *POS of *EXPP. "Resolving" consists of replacing
2950 the symbols that have undefined namespaces in OP_VAR_VALUE nodes
2951 with their resolutions, replacing built-in operators with
2952 function calls to user-defined operators, where appropriate, and,
2953 when DEPROCEDURE_P is non-zero, converting function-valued variables
2954 into parameterless calls. May expand *EXPP. The CONTEXT_TYPE functions
2955 are as in ada_resolve, above. */
2956
2957 static struct value *
2958 resolve_subexp (struct expression **expp, int *pos, int deprocedure_p,
2959 struct type *context_type)
2960 {
2961 int pc = *pos;
2962 int i;
2963 struct expression *exp; /* Convenience: == *expp. */
2964 enum exp_opcode op = (*expp)->elts[pc].opcode;
2965 struct value **argvec; /* Vector of operand types (alloca'ed). */
2966 int nargs; /* Number of operands. */
2967 int oplen;
2968
2969 argvec = NULL;
2970 nargs = 0;
2971 exp = *expp;
2972
2973 /* Pass one: resolve operands, saving their types and updating *pos,
2974 if needed. */
2975 switch (op)
2976 {
2977 case OP_FUNCALL:
2978 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
2979 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2980 *pos += 7;
2981 else
2982 {
2983 *pos += 3;
2984 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2985 }
2986 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
2987 break;
2988
2989 case UNOP_ADDR:
2990 *pos += 1;
2991 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2992 break;
2993
2994 case UNOP_QUAL:
2995 *pos += 3;
2996 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type));
2997 break;
2998
2999 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
3000 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
3001 case OP_ATR_TAG:
3002 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
3003 case OP_ATR_LAST:
3004 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
3005 case OP_ATR_POS:
3006 case OP_ATR_VAL:
3007 case OP_ATR_MIN:
3008 case OP_ATR_MAX:
3009 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
3010 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
3011 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
3012 case OP_AGGREGATE:
3013 case OP_OTHERS:
3014 case OP_CHOICES:
3015 case OP_POSITIONAL:
3016 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
3017 case OP_NAME:
3018 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
3019 *pos += oplen;
3020 break;
3021
3022 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
3023 {
3024 struct value *arg1;
3025
3026 *pos += 1;
3027 arg1 = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
3028 if (arg1 == NULL)
3029 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
3030 else
3031 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, value_type (arg1));
3032 break;
3033 }
3034
3035 case UNOP_CAST:
3036 *pos += 3;
3037 nargs = 1;
3038 break;
3039
3040 case BINOP_ADD:
3041 case BINOP_SUB:
3042 case BINOP_MUL:
3043 case BINOP_DIV:
3044 case BINOP_REM:
3045 case BINOP_MOD:
3046 case BINOP_EXP:
3047 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3048 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
3049 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
3050 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3051 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3052 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3053
3054 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3055 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3056 case BINOP_LESS:
3057 case BINOP_GTR:
3058 case BINOP_LEQ:
3059 case BINOP_GEQ:
3060
3061 case BINOP_REPEAT:
3062 case BINOP_SUBSCRIPT:
3063 case BINOP_COMMA:
3064 *pos += 1;
3065 nargs = 2;
3066 break;
3067
3068 case UNOP_NEG:
3069 case UNOP_PLUS:
3070 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3071 case UNOP_ABS:
3072 case UNOP_IND:
3073 *pos += 1;
3074 nargs = 1;
3075 break;
3076
3077 case OP_LONG:
3078 case OP_DOUBLE:
3079 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
3080 *pos += 4;
3081 break;
3082
3083 case OP_TYPE:
3084 case OP_BOOL:
3085 case OP_LAST:
3086 case OP_INTERNALVAR:
3087 *pos += 3;
3088 break;
3089
3090 case UNOP_MEMVAL:
3091 *pos += 3;
3092 nargs = 1;
3093 break;
3094
3095 case OP_REGISTER:
3096 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3097 break;
3098
3099 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
3100 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3101 nargs = 1;
3102 break;
3103
3104 case TERNOP_SLICE:
3105 *pos += 1;
3106 nargs = 3;
3107 break;
3108
3109 case OP_STRING:
3110 break;
3111
3112 default:
3113 error (_("Unexpected operator during name resolution"));
3114 }
3115
3116 argvec = (struct value * *) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 1));
3117 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
3118 argvec[i] = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
3119 argvec[i] = NULL;
3120 exp = *expp;
3121
3122 /* Pass two: perform any resolution on principal operator. */
3123 switch (op)
3124 {
3125 default:
3126 break;
3127
3128 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
3129 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3130 {
3131 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3132 int n_candidates;
3133
3134 n_candidates =
3135 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
3136 (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
3137 exp->elts[pc + 1].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3138 &candidates);
3139
3140 if (n_candidates > 1)
3141 {
3142 /* Types tend to get re-introduced locally, so if there
3143 are any local symbols that are not types, first filter
3144 out all types. */
3145 int j;
3146 for (j = 0; j < n_candidates; j += 1)
3147 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym))
3148 {
3149 case LOC_REGISTER:
3150 case LOC_ARG:
3151 case LOC_REF_ARG:
3152 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR:
3153 case LOC_LOCAL:
3154 case LOC_COMPUTED:
3155 goto FoundNonType;
3156 default:
3157 break;
3158 }
3159 FoundNonType:
3160 if (j < n_candidates)
3161 {
3162 j = 0;
3163 while (j < n_candidates)
3164 {
3165 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
3166 {
3167 candidates[j] = candidates[n_candidates - 1];
3168 n_candidates -= 1;
3169 }
3170 else
3171 j += 1;
3172 }
3173 }
3174 }
3175
3176 if (n_candidates == 0)
3177 error (_("No definition found for %s"),
3178 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
3179 else if (n_candidates == 1)
3180 i = 0;
3181 else if (deprocedure_p
3182 && !is_nonfunction (candidates, n_candidates))
3183 {
3184 i = ada_resolve_function
3185 (candidates, n_candidates, NULL, 0,
3186 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
3187 context_type);
3188 if (i < 0)
3189 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3190 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
3191 }
3192 else
3193 {
3194 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"),
3195 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
3196 user_select_syms (candidates, n_candidates, 1);
3197 i = 0;
3198 }
3199
3200 exp->elts[pc + 1].block = candidates[i].block;
3201 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
3202 if (innermost_block == NULL
3203 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
3204 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
3205 }
3206
3207 if (deprocedure_p
3208 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))
3209 == TYPE_CODE_FUNC))
3210 {
3211 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, 0, 0,
3212 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol,
3213 exp->elts[pc + 1].block);
3214 exp = *expp;
3215 }
3216 break;
3217
3218 case OP_FUNCALL:
3219 {
3220 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
3221 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3222 {
3223 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3224 int n_candidates;
3225
3226 n_candidates =
3227 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
3228 (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
3229 exp->elts[pc + 4].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3230 &candidates);
3231 if (n_candidates == 1)
3232 i = 0;
3233 else
3234 {
3235 i = ada_resolve_function
3236 (candidates, n_candidates,
3237 argvec, nargs,
3238 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
3239 context_type);
3240 if (i < 0)
3241 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3242 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
3243 }
3244
3245 exp->elts[pc + 4].block = candidates[i].block;
3246 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
3247 if (innermost_block == NULL
3248 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
3249 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
3250 }
3251 }
3252 break;
3253 case BINOP_ADD:
3254 case BINOP_SUB:
3255 case BINOP_MUL:
3256 case BINOP_DIV:
3257 case BINOP_REM:
3258 case BINOP_MOD:
3259 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3260 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3261 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3262 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3263 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3264 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3265 case BINOP_LESS:
3266 case BINOP_GTR:
3267 case BINOP_LEQ:
3268 case BINOP_GEQ:
3269 case BINOP_EXP:
3270 case UNOP_NEG:
3271 case UNOP_PLUS:
3272 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3273 case UNOP_ABS:
3274 if (possible_user_operator_p (op, argvec))
3275 {
3276 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3277 int n_candidates;
3278
3279 n_candidates =
3280 ada_lookup_symbol_list (ada_encode (ada_decoded_op_name (op)),
3281 (struct block *) NULL, VAR_DOMAIN,
3282 &candidates);
3283 i = ada_resolve_function (candidates, n_candidates, argvec, nargs,
3284 ada_decoded_op_name (op), NULL);
3285 if (i < 0)
3286 break;
3287
3288 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, nargs, 1,
3289 candidates[i].sym, candidates[i].block);
3290 exp = *expp;
3291 }
3292 break;
3293
3294 case OP_TYPE:
3295 case OP_REGISTER:
3296 return NULL;
3297 }
3298
3299 *pos = pc;
3300 return evaluate_subexp_type (exp, pos);
3301 }
3302
3303 /* Return non-zero if formal type FTYPE matches actual type ATYPE. If
3304 MAY_DEREF is non-zero, the formal may be a pointer and the actual
3305 a non-pointer. */
3306 /* The term "match" here is rather loose. The match is heuristic and
3307 liberal. */
3308
3309 static int
3310 ada_type_match (struct type *ftype, struct type *atype, int may_deref)
3311 {
3312 ftype = ada_check_typedef (ftype);
3313 atype = ada_check_typedef (atype);
3314
3315 if (TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3316 ftype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype);
3317 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3318 atype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype);
3319
3320 switch (TYPE_CODE (ftype))
3321 {
3322 default:
3323 return TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE (atype);
3324 case TYPE_CODE_PTR:
3325 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3326 return ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype),
3327 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype), 0);
3328 else
3329 return (may_deref
3330 && ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype), atype, 0));
3331 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3332 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3333 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3334 switch (TYPE_CODE (atype))
3335 {
3336 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3337 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3338 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3339 return 1;
3340 default:
3341 return 0;
3342 }
3343
3344 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
3345 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3346 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3347
3348 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
3349 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ftype))
3350 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3351 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3352 else
3353 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
3354 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3355
3356 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
3357 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3358 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE (ftype));
3359 }
3360 }
3361
3362 /* Return non-zero if the formals of FUNC "sufficiently match" the
3363 vector of actual argument types ACTUALS of size N_ACTUALS. FUNC
3364 may also be an enumeral, in which case it is treated as a 0-
3365 argument function. */
3366
3367 static int
3368 ada_args_match (struct symbol *func, struct value **actuals, int n_actuals)
3369 {
3370 int i;
3371 struct type *func_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (func);
3372
3373 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (func) == LOC_CONST
3374 && TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3375 return (n_actuals == 0);
3376 else if (func_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (func_type) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3377 return 0;
3378
3379 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (func_type) != n_actuals)
3380 return 0;
3381
3382 for (i = 0; i < n_actuals; i += 1)
3383 {
3384 if (actuals[i] == NULL)
3385 return 0;
3386 else
3387 {
3388 struct type *ftype = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (func_type,
3389 i));
3390 struct type *atype = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actuals[i]));
3391
3392 if (!ada_type_match (ftype, atype, 1))
3393 return 0;
3394 }
3395 }
3396 return 1;
3397 }
3398
3399 /* False iff function type FUNC_TYPE definitely does not produce a value
3400 compatible with type CONTEXT_TYPE. Conservatively returns 1 if
3401 FUNC_TYPE is not a valid function type with a non-null return type
3402 or an enumerated type. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates any non-void type. */
3403
3404 static int
3405 return_match (struct type *func_type, struct type *context_type)
3406 {
3407 struct type *return_type;
3408
3409 if (func_type == NULL)
3410 return 1;
3411
3412 if (TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3413 return_type = get_base_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (func_type));
3414 else
3415 return_type = get_base_type (func_type);
3416 if (return_type == NULL)
3417 return 1;
3418
3419 context_type = get_base_type (context_type);
3420
3421 if (TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3422 return context_type == NULL || return_type == context_type;
3423 else if (context_type == NULL)
3424 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID;
3425 else
3426 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE (context_type);
3427 }
3428
3429
3430 /* Returns the index in SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] that contains the symbol for the
3431 function (if any) that matches the types of the NARGS arguments in
3432 ARGS. If CONTEXT_TYPE is non-null and there is at least one match
3433 that returns that type, then eliminate matches that don't. If
3434 CONTEXT_TYPE is void and there is at least one match that does not
3435 return void, eliminate all matches that do.
3436
3437 Asks the user if there is more than one match remaining. Returns -1
3438 if there is no such symbol or none is selected. NAME is used
3439 solely for messages. May re-arrange and modify SYMS in
3440 the process; the index returned is for the modified vector. */
3441
3442 static int
3443 ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info syms[],
3444 int nsyms, struct value **args, int nargs,
3445 const char *name, struct type *context_type)
3446 {
3447 int fallback;
3448 int k;
3449 int m; /* Number of hits */
3450
3451 m = 0;
3452 /* In the first pass of the loop, we only accept functions matching
3453 context_type. If none are found, we add a second pass of the loop
3454 where every function is accepted. */
3455 for (fallback = 0; m == 0 && fallback < 2; fallback++)
3456 {
3457 for (k = 0; k < nsyms; k += 1)
3458 {
3459 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[k].sym));
3460
3461 if (ada_args_match (syms[k].sym, args, nargs)
3462 && (fallback || return_match (type, context_type)))
3463 {
3464 syms[m] = syms[k];
3465 m += 1;
3466 }
3467 }
3468 }
3469
3470 if (m == 0)
3471 return -1;
3472 else if (m > 1)
3473 {
3474 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"), name);
3475 user_select_syms (syms, m, 1);
3476 return 0;
3477 }
3478 return 0;
3479 }
3480
3481 /* Returns true (non-zero) iff decoded name N0 should appear before N1
3482 in a listing of choices during disambiguation (see sort_choices, below).
3483 The idea is that overloadings of a subprogram name from the
3484 same package should sort in their source order. We settle for ordering
3485 such symbols by their trailing number (__N or $N). */
3486
3487 static int
3488 encoded_ordered_before (const char *N0, const char *N1)
3489 {
3490 if (N1 == NULL)
3491 return 0;
3492 else if (N0 == NULL)
3493 return 1;
3494 else
3495 {
3496 int k0, k1;
3497
3498 for (k0 = strlen (N0) - 1; k0 > 0 && isdigit (N0[k0]); k0 -= 1)
3499 ;
3500 for (k1 = strlen (N1) - 1; k1 > 0 && isdigit (N1[k1]); k1 -= 1)
3501 ;
3502 if ((N0[k0] == '_' || N0[k0] == '$') && N0[k0 + 1] != '\000'
3503 && (N1[k1] == '_' || N1[k1] == '$') && N1[k1 + 1] != '\000')
3504 {
3505 int n0, n1;
3506
3507 n0 = k0;
3508 while (N0[n0] == '_' && n0 > 0 && N0[n0 - 1] == '_')
3509 n0 -= 1;
3510 n1 = k1;
3511 while (N1[n1] == '_' && n1 > 0 && N1[n1 - 1] == '_')
3512 n1 -= 1;
3513 if (n0 == n1 && strncmp (N0, N1, n0) == 0)
3514 return (atoi (N0 + k0 + 1) < atoi (N1 + k1 + 1));
3515 }
3516 return (strcmp (N0, N1) < 0);
3517 }
3518 }
3519
3520 /* Sort SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] to put the choices in a canonical order by the
3521 encoded names. */
3522
3523 static void
3524 sort_choices (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int nsyms)
3525 {
3526 int i;
3527
3528 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3529 {
3530 struct ada_symbol_info sym = syms[i];
3531 int j;
3532
3533 for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
3534 {
3535 if (encoded_ordered_before (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
3536 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym.sym)))
3537 break;
3538 syms[j + 1] = syms[j];
3539 }
3540 syms[j + 1] = sym;
3541 }
3542 }
3543
3544 /* Given a list of NSYMS symbols in SYMS, select up to MAX_RESULTS>0
3545 by asking the user (if necessary), returning the number selected,
3546 and setting the first elements of SYMS items. Error if no symbols
3547 selected. */
3548
3549 /* NOTE: Adapted from decode_line_2 in symtab.c, with which it ought
3550 to be re-integrated one of these days. */
3551
3552 int
3553 user_select_syms (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms, int max_results)
3554 {
3555 int i;
3556 int *chosen = (int *) alloca (sizeof (int) * nsyms);
3557 int n_chosen;
3558 int first_choice = (max_results == 1) ? 1 : 2;
3559 const char *select_mode = multiple_symbols_select_mode ();
3560
3561 if (max_results < 1)
3562 error (_("Request to select 0 symbols!"));
3563 if (nsyms <= 1)
3564 return nsyms;
3565
3566 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_cancel)
3567 error (_("\
3568 canceled because the command is ambiguous\n\
3569 See set/show multiple-symbol."));
3570
3571 /* If select_mode is "all", then return all possible symbols.
3572 Only do that if more than one symbol can be selected, of course.
3573 Otherwise, display the menu as usual. */
3574 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_all && max_results > 1)
3575 return nsyms;
3576
3577 printf_unfiltered (_("[0] cancel\n"));
3578 if (max_results > 1)
3579 printf_unfiltered (_("[1] all\n"));
3580
3581 sort_choices (syms, nsyms);
3582
3583 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3584 {
3585 if (syms[i].sym == NULL)
3586 continue;
3587
3588 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_BLOCK)
3589 {
3590 struct symtab_and_line sal =
3591 find_function_start_sal (syms[i].sym, 1);
3592
3593 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
3594 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at <no source file available>:%d\n"),
3595 i + first_choice,
3596 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3597 sal.line);
3598 else
3599 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"), i + first_choice,
3600 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3601 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal.symtab),
3602 sal.line);
3603 continue;
3604 }
3605 else
3606 {
3607 int is_enumeral =
3608 (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_CONST
3609 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym) != NULL
3610 && TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM);
3611 struct symtab *symtab = SYMBOL_SYMTAB (syms[i].sym);
3612
3613 if (SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym) != 0 && symtab != NULL)
3614 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"),
3615 i + first_choice,
3616 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3617 symtab_to_filename_for_display (symtab),
3618 SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym));
3619 else if (is_enumeral
3620 && TYPE_NAME (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != NULL)
3621 {
3622 printf_unfiltered (("[%d] "), i + first_choice);
3623 ada_print_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym), NULL,
3624 gdb_stdout, -1, 0, &type_print_raw_options);
3625 printf_unfiltered (_("'(%s) (enumeral)\n"),
3626 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3627 }
3628 else if (symtab != NULL)
3629 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3630 ? _("[%d] %s in %s (enumeral)\n")
3631 : _("[%d] %s at %s:?\n"),
3632 i + first_choice,
3633 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3634 symtab_to_filename_for_display (symtab));
3635 else
3636 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3637 ? _("[%d] %s (enumeral)\n")
3638 : _("[%d] %s at ?\n"),
3639 i + first_choice,
3640 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3641 }
3642 }
3643
3644 n_chosen = get_selections (chosen, nsyms, max_results, max_results > 1,
3645 "overload-choice");
3646
3647 for (i = 0; i < n_chosen; i += 1)
3648 syms[i] = syms[chosen[i]];
3649
3650 return n_chosen;
3651 }
3652
3653 /* Read and validate a set of numeric choices from the user in the
3654 range 0 .. N_CHOICES-1. Place the results in increasing
3655 order in CHOICES[0 .. N-1], and return N.
3656
3657 The user types choices as a sequence of numbers on one line
3658 separated by blanks, encoding them as follows:
3659
3660 + A choice of 0 means to cancel the selection, throwing an error.
3661 + If IS_ALL_CHOICE, a choice of 1 selects the entire set 0 .. N_CHOICES-1.
3662 + The user chooses k by typing k+IS_ALL_CHOICE+1.
3663
3664 The user is not allowed to choose more than MAX_RESULTS values.
3665
3666 ANNOTATION_SUFFIX, if present, is used to annotate the input
3667 prompts (for use with the -f switch). */
3668
3669 int
3670 get_selections (int *choices, int n_choices, int max_results,
3671 int is_all_choice, char *annotation_suffix)
3672 {
3673 char *args;
3674 char *prompt;
3675 int n_chosen;
3676 int first_choice = is_all_choice ? 2 : 1;
3677
3678 prompt = getenv ("PS2");
3679 if (prompt == NULL)
3680 prompt = "> ";
3681
3682 args = command_line_input (prompt, 0, annotation_suffix);
3683
3684 if (args == NULL)
3685 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3686
3687 n_chosen = 0;
3688
3689 /* Set choices[0 .. n_chosen-1] to the users' choices in ascending
3690 order, as given in args. Choices are validated. */
3691 while (1)
3692 {
3693 char *args2;
3694 int choice, j;
3695
3696 args = skip_spaces (args);
3697 if (*args == '\0' && n_chosen == 0)
3698 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3699 else if (*args == '\0')
3700 break;
3701
3702 choice = strtol (args, &args2, 10);
3703 if (args == args2 || choice < 0
3704 || choice > n_choices + first_choice - 1)
3705 error (_("Argument must be choice number"));
3706 args = args2;
3707
3708 if (choice == 0)
3709 error (_("cancelled"));
3710
3711 if (choice < first_choice)
3712 {
3713 n_chosen = n_choices;
3714 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
3715 choices[j] = j;
3716 break;
3717 }
3718 choice -= first_choice;
3719
3720 for (j = n_chosen - 1; j >= 0 && choice < choices[j]; j -= 1)
3721 {
3722 }
3723
3724 if (j < 0 || choice != choices[j])
3725 {
3726 int k;
3727
3728 for (k = n_chosen - 1; k > j; k -= 1)
3729 choices[k + 1] = choices[k];
3730 choices[j + 1] = choice;
3731 n_chosen += 1;
3732 }
3733 }
3734
3735 if (n_chosen > max_results)
3736 error (_("Select no more than %d of the above"), max_results);
3737
3738 return n_chosen;
3739 }
3740
3741 /* Replace the operator of length OPLEN at position PC in *EXPP with a call
3742 on the function identified by SYM and BLOCK, and taking NARGS
3743 arguments. Update *EXPP as needed to hold more space. */
3744
3745 static void
3746 replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **expp, int pc, int nargs,
3747 int oplen, struct symbol *sym,
3748 const struct block *block)
3749 {
3750 /* A new expression, with 6 more elements (3 for funcall, 4 for function
3751 symbol, -oplen for operator being replaced). */
3752 struct expression *newexp = (struct expression *)
3753 xzalloc (sizeof (struct expression)
3754 + EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES ((*expp)->nelts + 7 - oplen));
3755 struct expression *exp = *expp;
3756
3757 newexp->nelts = exp->nelts + 7 - oplen;
3758 newexp->language_defn = exp->language_defn;
3759 newexp->gdbarch = exp->gdbarch;
3760 memcpy (newexp->elts, exp->elts, EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (pc));
3761 memcpy (newexp->elts + pc + 7, exp->elts + pc + oplen,
3762 EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (exp->nelts - pc - oplen));
3763
3764 newexp->elts[pc].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 2].opcode = OP_FUNCALL;
3765 newexp->elts[pc + 1].longconst = (LONGEST) nargs;
3766
3767 newexp->elts[pc + 3].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 6].opcode = OP_VAR_VALUE;
3768 newexp->elts[pc + 4].block = block;
3769 newexp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = sym;
3770
3771 *expp = newexp;
3772 xfree (exp);
3773 }
3774
3775 /* Type-class predicates */
3776
3777 /* True iff TYPE is numeric (i.e., an INT, RANGE (of numeric type),
3778 or FLOAT). */
3779
3780 static int
3781 numeric_type_p (struct type *type)
3782 {
3783 if (type == NULL)
3784 return 0;
3785 else
3786 {
3787 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3788 {
3789 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3790 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3791 return 1;
3792 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3793 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3794 || numeric_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3795 default:
3796 return 0;
3797 }
3798 }
3799 }
3800
3801 /* True iff TYPE is integral (an INT or RANGE of INTs). */
3802
3803 static int
3804 integer_type_p (struct type *type)
3805 {
3806 if (type == NULL)
3807 return 0;
3808 else
3809 {
3810 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3811 {
3812 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3813 return 1;
3814 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3815 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3816 || integer_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3817 default:
3818 return 0;
3819 }
3820 }
3821 }
3822
3823 /* True iff TYPE is scalar (INT, RANGE, FLOAT, ENUM). */
3824
3825 static int
3826 scalar_type_p (struct type *type)
3827 {
3828 if (type == NULL)
3829 return 0;
3830 else
3831 {
3832 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3833 {
3834 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3835 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3836 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3837 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3838 return 1;
3839 default:
3840 return 0;
3841 }
3842 }
3843 }
3844
3845 /* True iff TYPE is discrete (INT, RANGE, ENUM). */
3846
3847 static int
3848 discrete_type_p (struct type *type)
3849 {
3850 if (type == NULL)
3851 return 0;
3852 else
3853 {
3854 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3855 {
3856 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3857 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3858 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3859 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
3860 return 1;
3861 default:
3862 return 0;
3863 }
3864 }
3865 }
3866
3867 /* Returns non-zero if OP with operands in the vector ARGS could be
3868 a user-defined function. Errs on the side of pre-defined operators
3869 (i.e., result 0). */
3870
3871 static int
3872 possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode op, struct value *args[])
3873 {
3874 struct type *type0 =
3875 (args[0] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[0]));
3876 struct type *type1 =
3877 (args[1] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[1]));
3878
3879 if (type0 == NULL)
3880 return 0;
3881
3882 switch (op)
3883 {
3884 default:
3885 return 0;
3886
3887 case BINOP_ADD:
3888 case BINOP_SUB:
3889 case BINOP_MUL:
3890 case BINOP_DIV:
3891 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && numeric_type_p (type1)));
3892
3893 case BINOP_REM:
3894 case BINOP_MOD:
3895 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3896 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3897 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3898 return (!(integer_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3899
3900 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3901 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3902 case BINOP_LESS:
3903 case BINOP_GTR:
3904 case BINOP_LEQ:
3905 case BINOP_GEQ:
3906 return (!(scalar_type_p (type0) && scalar_type_p (type1)));
3907
3908 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3909 return !ada_is_array_type (type0) || !ada_is_array_type (type1);
3910
3911 case BINOP_EXP:
3912 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3913
3914 case UNOP_NEG:
3915 case UNOP_PLUS:
3916 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3917 case UNOP_ABS:
3918 return (!numeric_type_p (type0));
3919
3920 }
3921 }
3922 \f
3923 /* Renaming */
3924
3925 /* NOTES:
3926
3927 1. In the following, we assume that a renaming type's name may
3928 have an ___XD suffix. It would be nice if this went away at some
3929 point.
3930 2. We handle both the (old) purely type-based representation of
3931 renamings and the (new) variable-based encoding. At some point,
3932 it is devoutly to be hoped that the former goes away
3933 (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09).
3934 3. Subprogram renamings are not implemented, although the XRS
3935 suffix is recognized (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09). */
3936
3937 /* If SYM encodes a renaming,
3938
3939 <renaming> renames <renamed entity>,
3940
3941 sets *LEN to the length of the renamed entity's name,
3942 *RENAMED_ENTITY to that name (not null-terminated), and *RENAMING_EXPR to
3943 the string describing the subcomponent selected from the renamed
3944 entity. Returns ADA_NOT_RENAMING if SYM does not encode a renaming
3945 (in which case, the values of *RENAMED_ENTITY, *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR
3946 are undefined). Otherwise, returns a value indicating the category
3947 of entity renamed: an object (ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING), exception
3948 (ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING), package (ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING), or
3949 subprogram (ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING). Does no allocation; the
3950 strings returned in *RENAMED_ENTITY and *RENAMING_EXPR should not be
3951 deallocated. The values of RENAMED_ENTITY, LEN, or RENAMING_EXPR
3952 may be NULL, in which case they are not assigned.
3953
3954 [Currently, however, GCC does not generate subprogram renamings.] */
3955
3956 enum ada_renaming_category
3957 ada_parse_renaming (struct symbol *sym,
3958 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
3959 const char **renaming_expr)
3960 {
3961 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
3962 const char *info;
3963 const char *suffix;
3964
3965 if (sym == NULL)
3966 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3967 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
3968 {
3969 default:
3970 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3971 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
3972 return parse_old_style_renaming (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym),
3973 renamed_entity, len, renaming_expr);
3974 case LOC_LOCAL:
3975 case LOC_STATIC:
3976 case LOC_COMPUTED:
3977 case LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT:
3978 info = strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR");
3979 if (info == NULL)
3980 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3981 switch (info[5])
3982 {
3983 case '_':
3984 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
3985 info += 6;
3986 break;
3987 case 'E':
3988 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
3989 info += 7;
3990 break;
3991 case 'P':
3992 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
3993 info += 7;
3994 break;
3995 case 'S':
3996 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
3997 info += 7;
3998 break;
3999 default:
4000 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4001 }
4002 }
4003
4004 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
4005 *renamed_entity = info;
4006 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
4007 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
4008 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4009 if (len != NULL)
4010 *len = strlen (info) - strlen (suffix);
4011 suffix += 5;
4012 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
4013 *renaming_expr = suffix;
4014 return kind;
4015 }
4016
4017 /* Assuming TYPE encodes a renaming according to the old encoding in
4018 exp_dbug.ads, returns details of that renaming in *RENAMED_ENTITY,
4019 *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR, as for ada_parse_renaming, above. Returns
4020 ADA_NOT_RENAMING otherwise. */
4021 static enum ada_renaming_category
4022 parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *type,
4023 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
4024 const char **renaming_expr)
4025 {
4026 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
4027 const char *name;
4028 const char *info;
4029 const char *suffix;
4030
4031 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4032 || TYPE_NFIELDS (type) != 1)
4033 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4034
4035 name = type_name_no_tag (type);
4036 if (name == NULL)
4037 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4038
4039 name = strstr (name, "___XR");
4040 if (name == NULL)
4041 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4042 switch (name[5])
4043 {
4044 case '\0':
4045 case '_':
4046 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
4047 break;
4048 case 'E':
4049 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
4050 break;
4051 case 'P':
4052 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
4053 break;
4054 case 'S':
4055 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
4056 break;
4057 default:
4058 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4059 }
4060
4061 info = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0);
4062 if (info == NULL)
4063 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4064 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
4065 *renamed_entity = info;
4066 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
4067 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
4068 *renaming_expr = suffix + 5;
4069 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
4070 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4071 if (len != NULL)
4072 *len = suffix - info;
4073 return kind;
4074 }
4075
4076 /* Compute the value of the given RENAMING_SYM, which is expected to
4077 be a symbol encoding a renaming expression. BLOCK is the block
4078 used to evaluate the renaming. */
4079
4080 static struct value *
4081 ada_read_renaming_var_value (struct symbol *renaming_sym,
4082 struct block *block)
4083 {
4084 const char *sym_name;
4085 struct expression *expr;
4086 struct value *value;
4087 struct cleanup *old_chain = NULL;
4088
4089 sym_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (renaming_sym);
4090 expr = parse_exp_1 (&sym_name, 0, block, 0);
4091 old_chain = make_cleanup (free_current_contents, &expr);
4092 value = evaluate_expression (expr);
4093
4094 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4095 return value;
4096 }
4097 \f
4098
4099 /* Evaluation: Function Calls */
4100
4101 /* Return an lvalue containing the value VAL. This is the identity on
4102 lvalues, and otherwise has the side-effect of allocating memory
4103 in the inferior where a copy of the value contents is copied. */
4104
4105 static struct value *
4106 ensure_lval (struct value *val)
4107 {
4108 if (VALUE_LVAL (val) == not_lval
4109 || VALUE_LVAL (val) == lval_internalvar)
4110 {
4111 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (value_type (val)));
4112 const CORE_ADDR addr =
4113 value_as_long (value_allocate_space_in_inferior (len));
4114
4115 set_value_address (val, addr);
4116 VALUE_LVAL (val) = lval_memory;
4117 write_memory (addr, value_contents (val), len);
4118 }
4119
4120 return val;
4121 }
4122
4123 /* Return the value ACTUAL, converted to be an appropriate value for a
4124 formal of type FORMAL_TYPE. Use *SP as a stack pointer for
4125 allocating any necessary descriptors (fat pointers), or copies of
4126 values not residing in memory, updating it as needed. */
4127
4128 struct value *
4129 ada_convert_actual (struct value *actual, struct type *formal_type0)
4130 {
4131 struct type *actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4132 struct type *formal_type = ada_check_typedef (formal_type0);
4133 struct type *formal_target =
4134 TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4135 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (formal_type)) : formal_type;
4136 struct type *actual_target =
4137 TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4138 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (actual_type)) : actual_type;
4139
4140 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (formal_target)
4141 && TYPE_CODE (actual_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
4142 return make_array_descriptor (formal_type, actual);
4143 else if (TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4144 || TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
4145 {
4146 struct value *result;
4147
4148 if (TYPE_CODE (formal_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
4149 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (actual_target))
4150 result = desc_data (actual);
4151 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4152 {
4153 if (VALUE_LVAL (actual) != lval_memory)
4154 {
4155 struct value *val;
4156
4157 actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4158 val = allocate_value (actual_type);
4159 memcpy ((char *) value_contents_raw (val),
4160 (char *) value_contents (actual),
4161 TYPE_LENGTH (actual_type));
4162 actual = ensure_lval (val);
4163 }
4164 result = value_addr (actual);
4165 }
4166 else
4167 return actual;
4168 return value_cast_pointers (formal_type, result, 0);
4169 }
4170 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4171 return ada_value_ind (actual);
4172
4173 return actual;
4174 }
4175
4176 /* Convert VALUE (which must be an address) to a CORE_ADDR that is a pointer of
4177 type TYPE. This is usually an inefficient no-op except on some targets
4178 (such as AVR) where the representation of a pointer and an address
4179 differs. */
4180
4181 static CORE_ADDR
4182 value_pointer (struct value *value, struct type *type)
4183 {
4184 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_type_arch (type);
4185 unsigned len = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
4186 gdb_byte *buf = alloca (len);
4187 CORE_ADDR addr;
4188
4189 addr = value_address (value);
4190 gdbarch_address_to_pointer (gdbarch, type, buf, addr);
4191 addr = extract_unsigned_integer (buf, len, gdbarch_byte_order (gdbarch));
4192 return addr;
4193 }
4194
4195
4196 /* Push a descriptor of type TYPE for array value ARR on the stack at
4197 *SP, updating *SP to reflect the new descriptor. Return either
4198 an lvalue representing the new descriptor, or (if TYPE is a pointer-
4199 to-descriptor type rather than a descriptor type), a struct value *
4200 representing a pointer to this descriptor. */
4201
4202 static struct value *
4203 make_array_descriptor (struct type *type, struct value *arr)
4204 {
4205 struct type *bounds_type = desc_bounds_type (type);
4206 struct type *desc_type = desc_base_type (type);
4207 struct value *descriptor = allocate_value (desc_type);
4208 struct value *bounds = allocate_value (bounds_type);
4209 int i;
4210
4211 for (i = ada_array_arity (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr)));
4212 i > 0; i -= 1)
4213 {
4214 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4215 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 0),
4216 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 0),
4217 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 0));
4218 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4219 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 1),
4220 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 1),
4221 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 1));
4222 }
4223
4224 bounds = ensure_lval (bounds);
4225
4226 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4227 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4228 value_pointer (ensure_lval (arr),
4229 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 0)),
4230 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (desc_type),
4231 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (desc_type));
4232
4233 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4234 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4235 value_pointer (bounds,
4236 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 1)),
4237 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (desc_type),
4238 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (desc_type));
4239
4240 descriptor = ensure_lval (descriptor);
4241
4242 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4243 return value_addr (descriptor);
4244 else
4245 return descriptor;
4246 }
4247 \f
4248 /* Dummy definitions for an experimental caching module that is not
4249 * used in the public sources. */
4250
4251 static int
4252 lookup_cached_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
4253 struct symbol **sym, struct block **block)
4254 {
4255 return 0;
4256 }
4257
4258 static void
4259 cache_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace, struct symbol *sym,
4260 const struct block *block)
4261 {
4262 }
4263 \f
4264 /* Symbol Lookup */
4265
4266 /* Return nonzero if wild matching should be used when searching for
4267 all symbols matching LOOKUP_NAME.
4268
4269 LOOKUP_NAME is expected to be a symbol name after transformation
4270 for Ada lookups (see ada_name_for_lookup). */
4271
4272 static int
4273 should_use_wild_match (const char *lookup_name)
4274 {
4275 return (strstr (lookup_name, "__") == NULL);
4276 }
4277
4278 /* Return the result of a standard (literal, C-like) lookup of NAME in
4279 given DOMAIN, visible from lexical block BLOCK. */
4280
4281 static struct symbol *
4282 standard_lookup (const char *name, const struct block *block,
4283 domain_enum domain)
4284 {
4285 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
4286 struct symbol *sym = NULL;
4287
4288 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name, domain, &sym, NULL))
4289 return sym;
4290 sym = lookup_symbol_in_language (name, block, domain, language_c, 0);
4291 cache_symbol (name, domain, sym, block_found);
4292 return sym;
4293 }
4294
4295
4296 /* Non-zero iff there is at least one non-function/non-enumeral symbol
4297 in the symbol fields of SYMS[0..N-1]. We treat enumerals as functions,
4298 since they contend in overloading in the same way. */
4299 static int
4300 is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int n)
4301 {
4302 int i;
4303
4304 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
4305 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC
4306 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4307 || SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) != LOC_CONST))
4308 return 1;
4309
4310 return 0;
4311 }
4312
4313 /* If true (non-zero), then TYPE0 and TYPE1 represent equivalent
4314 struct types. Otherwise, they may not. */
4315
4316 static int
4317 equiv_types (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
4318 {
4319 if (type0 == type1)
4320 return 1;
4321 if (type0 == NULL || type1 == NULL
4322 || TYPE_CODE (type0) != TYPE_CODE (type1))
4323 return 0;
4324 if ((TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
4325 || TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4326 && ada_type_name (type0) != NULL && ada_type_name (type1) != NULL
4327 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type0), ada_type_name (type1)) == 0)
4328 return 1;
4329
4330 return 0;
4331 }
4332
4333 /* True iff SYM0 represents the same entity as SYM1, or one that is
4334 no more defined than that of SYM1. */
4335
4336 static int
4337 lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *sym0, struct symbol *sym1)
4338 {
4339 if (sym0 == sym1)
4340 return 1;
4341 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym0) != SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym1)
4342 || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0) != SYMBOL_CLASS (sym1))
4343 return 0;
4344
4345 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0))
4346 {
4347 case LOC_UNDEF:
4348 return 1;
4349 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4350 {
4351 struct type *type0 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0);
4352 struct type *type1 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1);
4353 const char *name0 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym0);
4354 const char *name1 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym1);
4355 int len0 = strlen (name0);
4356
4357 return
4358 TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE (type1)
4359 && (equiv_types (type0, type1)
4360 || (len0 < strlen (name1) && strncmp (name0, name1, len0) == 0
4361 && strncmp (name1 + len0, "___XV", 5) == 0));
4362 }
4363 case LOC_CONST:
4364 return SYMBOL_VALUE (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE (sym1)
4365 && equiv_types (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0), SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1));
4366 default:
4367 return 0;
4368 }
4369 }
4370
4371 /* Append (SYM,BLOCK,SYMTAB) to the end of the array of struct ada_symbol_info
4372 records in OBSTACKP. Do nothing if SYM is a duplicate. */
4373
4374 static void
4375 add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *obstackp,
4376 struct symbol *sym,
4377 struct block *block)
4378 {
4379 int i;
4380 struct ada_symbol_info *prevDefns = defns_collected (obstackp, 0);
4381
4382 /* Do not try to complete stub types, as the debugger is probably
4383 already scanning all symbols matching a certain name at the
4384 time when this function is called. Trying to replace the stub
4385 type by its associated full type will cause us to restart a scan
4386 which may lead to an infinite recursion. Instead, the client
4387 collecting the matching symbols will end up collecting several
4388 matches, with at least one of them complete. It can then filter
4389 out the stub ones if needed. */
4390
4391 for (i = num_defns_collected (obstackp) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
4392 {
4393 if (lesseq_defined_than (sym, prevDefns[i].sym))
4394 return;
4395 else if (lesseq_defined_than (prevDefns[i].sym, sym))
4396 {
4397 prevDefns[i].sym = sym;
4398 prevDefns[i].block = block;
4399 return;
4400 }
4401 }
4402
4403 {
4404 struct ada_symbol_info info;
4405
4406 info.sym = sym;
4407 info.block = block;
4408 obstack_grow (obstackp, &info, sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info));
4409 }
4410 }
4411
4412 /* Number of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in
4413 current vector in *OBSTACKP. */
4414
4415 static int
4416 num_defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp)
4417 {
4418 return obstack_object_size (obstackp) / sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info);
4419 }
4420
4421 /* Vector of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in current
4422 vector in *OBSTACKP. If FINISH, close off the vector and return
4423 its final address. */
4424
4425 static struct ada_symbol_info *
4426 defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp, int finish)
4427 {
4428 if (finish)
4429 return obstack_finish (obstackp);
4430 else
4431 return (struct ada_symbol_info *) obstack_base (obstackp);
4432 }
4433
4434 /* Return a bound minimal symbol matching NAME according to Ada
4435 decoding rules. Returns an invalid symbol if there is no such
4436 minimal symbol. Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled
4437 specially: "standard__" is first stripped off, and only static and
4438 global symbols are searched. */
4439
4440 struct bound_minimal_symbol
4441 ada_lookup_simple_minsym (const char *name)
4442 {
4443 struct bound_minimal_symbol result;
4444 struct objfile *objfile;
4445 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
4446 const int wild_match_p = should_use_wild_match (name);
4447
4448 memset (&result, 0, sizeof (result));
4449
4450 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
4451 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
4452 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
4453 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
4454 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
4455 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
4456 entity inside its program). */
4457 if (strncmp (name, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
4458 name += sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
4459
4460 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
4461 {
4462 if (match_name (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol), name, wild_match_p)
4463 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msymbol) != mst_solib_trampoline)
4464 {
4465 result.minsym = msymbol;
4466 result.objfile = objfile;
4467 break;
4468 }
4469 }
4470
4471 return result;
4472 }
4473
4474 /* For all subprograms that statically enclose the subprogram of the
4475 selected frame, add symbols matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN
4476 and their blocks to the list of data in OBSTACKP, as for
4477 ada_add_block_symbols (q.v.). If WILD_MATCH_P, treat as NAME
4478 with a wildcard prefix. */
4479
4480 static void
4481 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (struct obstack *obstackp,
4482 const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
4483 int wild_match_p)
4484 {
4485 }
4486
4487 /* True if TYPE is definitely an artificial type supplied to a symbol
4488 for which no debugging information was given in the symbol file. */
4489
4490 static int
4491 is_nondebugging_type (struct type *type)
4492 {
4493 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
4494
4495 return (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "<variable, no debug info>") == 0);
4496 }
4497
4498 /* Return nonzero if TYPE1 and TYPE2 are two enumeration types
4499 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes.
4500
4501 This function assumes that TYPE1 and TYPE2 are both TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4502 types and that their number of enumerals is identical (in other
4503 words, TYPE_NFIELDS (type1) == TYPE_NFIELDS (type2)). */
4504
4505 static int
4506 ada_identical_enum_types_p (struct type *type1, struct type *type2)
4507 {
4508 int i;
4509
4510 /* The heuristic we use here is fairly conservative. We consider
4511 that 2 enumerate types are identical if they have the same
4512 number of enumerals and that all enumerals have the same
4513 underlying value and name. */
4514
4515 /* All enums in the type should have an identical underlying value. */
4516 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++)
4517 if (TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type1, i) != TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type2, i))
4518 return 0;
4519
4520 /* All enumerals should also have the same name (modulo any numerical
4521 suffix). */
4522 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++)
4523 {
4524 const char *name_1 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i);
4525 const char *name_2 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i);
4526 int len_1 = strlen (name_1);
4527 int len_2 = strlen (name_2);
4528
4529 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i), &len_1);
4530 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i), &len_2);
4531 if (len_1 != len_2
4532 || strncmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i),
4533 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i),
4534 len_1) != 0)
4535 return 0;
4536 }
4537
4538 return 1;
4539 }
4540
4541 /* Return nonzero if all the symbols in SYMS are all enumeral symbols
4542 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes. Sometimes,
4543 enumerals are not strictly identical, but their types are so similar
4544 that they can be considered identical.
4545
4546 For instance, consider the following code:
4547
4548 type Color is (Black, Red, Green, Blue, White);
4549 type RGB_Color is new Color range Red .. Blue;
4550
4551 Type RGB_Color is a subrange of an implicit type which is a copy
4552 of type Color. If we call that implicit type RGB_ColorB ("B" is
4553 for "Base Type"), then type RGB_ColorB is a copy of type Color.
4554 As a result, when an expression references any of the enumeral
4555 by name (Eg. "print green"), the expression is technically
4556 ambiguous and the user should be asked to disambiguate. But
4557 doing so would only hinder the user, since it wouldn't matter
4558 what choice he makes, the outcome would always be the same.
4559 So, for practical purposes, we consider them as the same. */
4560
4561 static int
4562 symbols_are_identical_enums (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms)
4563 {
4564 int i;
4565
4566 /* Before performing a thorough comparison check of each type,
4567 we perform a series of inexpensive checks. We expect that these
4568 checks will quickly fail in the vast majority of cases, and thus
4569 help prevent the unnecessary use of a more expensive comparison.
4570 Said comparison also expects us to make some of these checks
4571 (see ada_identical_enum_types_p). */
4572
4573 /* Quick check: All symbols should have an enum type. */
4574 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i++)
4575 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4576 return 0;
4577
4578 /* Quick check: They should all have the same value. */
4579 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++)
4580 if (SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[i].sym) != SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[0].sym))
4581 return 0;
4582
4583 /* Quick check: They should all have the same number of enumerals. */
4584 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++)
4585 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym))
4586 != TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].sym)))
4587 return 0;
4588
4589 /* All the sanity checks passed, so we might have a set of
4590 identical enumeration types. Perform a more complete
4591 comparison of the type of each symbol. */
4592 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++)
4593 if (!ada_identical_enum_types_p (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym),
4594 SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].sym)))
4595 return 0;
4596
4597 return 1;
4598 }
4599
4600 /* Remove any non-debugging symbols in SYMS[0 .. NSYMS-1] that definitely
4601 duplicate other symbols in the list (The only case I know of where
4602 this happens is when object files containing stabs-in-ecoff are
4603 linked with files containing ordinary ecoff debugging symbols (or no
4604 debugging symbols)). Modifies SYMS to squeeze out deleted entries.
4605 Returns the number of items in the modified list. */
4606
4607 static int
4608 remove_extra_symbols (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms)
4609 {
4610 int i, j;
4611
4612 /* We should never be called with less than 2 symbols, as there
4613 cannot be any extra symbol in that case. But it's easy to
4614 handle, since we have nothing to do in that case. */
4615 if (nsyms < 2)
4616 return nsyms;
4617
4618 i = 0;
4619 while (i < nsyms)
4620 {
4621 int remove_p = 0;
4622
4623 /* If two symbols have the same name and one of them is a stub type,
4624 the get rid of the stub. */
4625
4626 if (TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym))
4627 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL)
4628 {
4629 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j++)
4630 {
4631 if (j != i
4632 && !TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[j].sym))
4633 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4634 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4635 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0)
4636 remove_p = 1;
4637 }
4638 }
4639
4640 /* Two symbols with the same name, same class and same address
4641 should be identical. */
4642
4643 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL
4644 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_STATIC
4645 && is_nondebugging_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)))
4646 {
4647 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4648 {
4649 if (i != j
4650 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4651 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4652 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0
4653 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[j].sym)
4654 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[i].sym)
4655 == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[j].sym))
4656 remove_p = 1;
4657 }
4658 }
4659
4660 if (remove_p)
4661 {
4662 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4663 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4664 nsyms -= 1;
4665 }
4666
4667 i += 1;
4668 }
4669
4670 /* If all the remaining symbols are identical enumerals, then
4671 just keep the first one and discard the rest.
4672
4673 Unlike what we did previously, we do not discard any entry
4674 unless they are ALL identical. This is because the symbol
4675 comparison is not a strict comparison, but rather a practical
4676 comparison. If all symbols are considered identical, then
4677 we can just go ahead and use the first one and discard the rest.
4678 But if we cannot reduce the list to a single element, we have
4679 to ask the user to disambiguate anyways. And if we have to
4680 present a multiple-choice menu, it's less confusing if the list
4681 isn't missing some choices that were identical and yet distinct. */
4682 if (symbols_are_identical_enums (syms, nsyms))
4683 nsyms = 1;
4684
4685 return nsyms;
4686 }
4687
4688 /* Given a type that corresponds to a renaming entity, use the type name
4689 to extract the scope (package name or function name, fully qualified,
4690 and following the GNAT encoding convention) where this renaming has been
4691 defined. The string returned needs to be deallocated after use. */
4692
4693 static char *
4694 xget_renaming_scope (struct type *renaming_type)
4695 {
4696 /* The renaming types adhere to the following convention:
4697 <scope>__<rename>___<XR extension>.
4698 So, to extract the scope, we search for the "___XR" extension,
4699 and then backtrack until we find the first "__". */
4700
4701 const char *name = type_name_no_tag (renaming_type);
4702 char *suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4703 char *last;
4704 int scope_len;
4705 char *scope;
4706
4707 /* Now, backtrack a bit until we find the first "__". Start looking
4708 at suffix - 3, as the <rename> part is at least one character long. */
4709
4710 for (last = suffix - 3; last > name; last--)
4711 if (last[0] == '_' && last[1] == '_')
4712 break;
4713
4714 /* Make a copy of scope and return it. */
4715
4716 scope_len = last - name;
4717 scope = (char *) xmalloc ((scope_len + 1) * sizeof (char));
4718
4719 strncpy (scope, name, scope_len);
4720 scope[scope_len] = '\0';
4721
4722 return scope;
4723 }
4724
4725 /* Return nonzero if NAME corresponds to a package name. */
4726
4727 static int
4728 is_package_name (const char *name)
4729 {
4730 /* Here, We take advantage of the fact that no symbols are generated
4731 for packages, while symbols are generated for each function.
4732 So the condition for NAME represent a package becomes equivalent
4733 to NAME not existing in our list of symbols. There is only one
4734 small complication with library-level functions (see below). */
4735
4736 char *fun_name;
4737
4738 /* If it is a function that has not been defined at library level,
4739 then we should be able to look it up in the symbols. */
4740 if (standard_lookup (name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) != NULL)
4741 return 0;
4742
4743 /* Library-level function names start with "_ada_". See if function
4744 "_ada_" followed by NAME can be found. */
4745
4746 /* Do a quick check that NAME does not contain "__", since library-level
4747 functions names cannot contain "__" in them. */
4748 if (strstr (name, "__") != NULL)
4749 return 0;
4750
4751 fun_name = xstrprintf ("_ada_%s", name);
4752
4753 return (standard_lookup (fun_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) == NULL);
4754 }
4755
4756 /* Return nonzero if SYM corresponds to a renaming entity that is
4757 not visible from FUNCTION_NAME. */
4758
4759 static int
4760 old_renaming_is_invisible (const struct symbol *sym, const char *function_name)
4761 {
4762 char *scope;
4763 struct cleanup *old_chain;
4764
4765 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF)
4766 return 0;
4767
4768 scope = xget_renaming_scope (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
4769 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, scope);
4770
4771 /* If the rename has been defined in a package, then it is visible. */
4772 if (is_package_name (scope))
4773 {
4774 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4775 return 0;
4776 }
4777
4778 /* Check that the rename is in the current function scope by checking
4779 that its name starts with SCOPE. */
4780
4781 /* If the function name starts with "_ada_", it means that it is
4782 a library-level function. Strip this prefix before doing the
4783 comparison, as the encoding for the renaming does not contain
4784 this prefix. */
4785 if (strncmp (function_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
4786 function_name += 5;
4787
4788 {
4789 int is_invisible = strncmp (function_name, scope, strlen (scope)) != 0;
4790
4791 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4792 return is_invisible;
4793 }
4794 }
4795
4796 /* Remove entries from SYMS that corresponds to a renaming entity that
4797 is not visible from the function associated with CURRENT_BLOCK or
4798 that is superfluous due to the presence of more specific renaming
4799 information. Places surviving symbols in the initial entries of
4800 SYMS and returns the number of surviving symbols.
4801
4802 Rationale:
4803 First, in cases where an object renaming is implemented as a
4804 reference variable, GNAT may produce both the actual reference
4805 variable and the renaming encoding. In this case, we discard the
4806 latter.
4807
4808 Second, GNAT emits a type following a specified encoding for each renaming
4809 entity. Unfortunately, STABS currently does not support the definition
4810 of types that are local to a given lexical block, so all renamings types
4811 are emitted at library level. As a consequence, if an application
4812 contains two renaming entities using the same name, and a user tries to
4813 print the value of one of these entities, the result of the ada symbol
4814 lookup will also contain the wrong renaming type.
4815
4816 This function partially covers for this limitation by attempting to
4817 remove from the SYMS list renaming symbols that should be visible
4818 from CURRENT_BLOCK. However, there does not seem be a 100% reliable
4819 method with the current information available. The implementation
4820 below has a couple of limitations (FIXME: brobecker-2003-05-12):
4821
4822 - When the user tries to print a rename in a function while there
4823 is another rename entity defined in a package: Normally, the
4824 rename in the function has precedence over the rename in the
4825 package, so the latter should be removed from the list. This is
4826 currently not the case.
4827
4828 - This function will incorrectly remove valid renames if
4829 the CURRENT_BLOCK corresponds to a function which symbol name
4830 has been changed by an "Export" pragma. As a consequence,
4831 the user will be unable to print such rename entities. */
4832
4833 static int
4834 remove_irrelevant_renamings (struct ada_symbol_info *syms,
4835 int nsyms, const struct block *current_block)
4836 {
4837 struct symbol *current_function;
4838 const char *current_function_name;
4839 int i;
4840 int is_new_style_renaming;
4841
4842 /* If there is both a renaming foo___XR... encoded as a variable and
4843 a simple variable foo in the same block, discard the latter.
4844 First, zero out such symbols, then compress. */
4845 is_new_style_renaming = 0;
4846 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
4847 {
4848 struct symbol *sym = syms[i].sym;
4849 const struct block *block = syms[i].block;
4850 const char *name;
4851 const char *suffix;
4852
4853 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
4854 continue;
4855 name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym);
4856 suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4857
4858 if (suffix != NULL)
4859 {
4860 int name_len = suffix - name;
4861 int j;
4862
4863 is_new_style_renaming = 1;
4864 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4865 if (i != j && syms[j].sym != NULL
4866 && strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
4867 name_len) == 0
4868 && block == syms[j].block)
4869 syms[j].sym = NULL;
4870 }
4871 }
4872 if (is_new_style_renaming)
4873 {
4874 int j, k;
4875
4876 for (j = k = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4877 if (syms[j].sym != NULL)
4878 {
4879 syms[k] = syms[j];
4880 k += 1;
4881 }
4882 return k;
4883 }
4884
4885 /* Extract the function name associated to CURRENT_BLOCK.
4886 Abort if unable to do so. */
4887
4888 if (current_block == NULL)
4889 return nsyms;
4890
4891 current_function = block_linkage_function (current_block);
4892 if (current_function == NULL)
4893 return nsyms;
4894
4895 current_function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (current_function);
4896 if (current_function_name == NULL)
4897 return nsyms;
4898
4899 /* Check each of the symbols, and remove it from the list if it is
4900 a type corresponding to a renaming that is out of the scope of
4901 the current block. */
4902
4903 i = 0;
4904 while (i < nsyms)
4905 {
4906 if (ada_parse_renaming (syms[i].sym, NULL, NULL, NULL)
4907 == ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING
4908 && old_renaming_is_invisible (syms[i].sym, current_function_name))
4909 {
4910 int j;
4911
4912 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4913 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4914 nsyms -= 1;
4915 }
4916 else
4917 i += 1;
4918 }
4919
4920 return nsyms;
4921 }
4922
4923 /* Add to OBSTACKP all symbols from BLOCK (and its super-blocks)
4924 whose name and domain match NAME and DOMAIN respectively.
4925 If no match was found, then extend the search to "enclosing"
4926 routines (in other words, if we're inside a nested function,
4927 search the symbols defined inside the enclosing functions).
4928 If WILD_MATCH_P is nonzero, perform the naming matching in
4929 "wild" mode (see function "wild_match" for more info).
4930
4931 Note: This function assumes that OBSTACKP has 0 (zero) element in it. */
4932
4933 static void
4934 ada_add_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
4935 struct block *block, domain_enum domain,
4936 int wild_match_p)
4937 {
4938 int block_depth = 0;
4939
4940 while (block != NULL)
4941 {
4942 block_depth += 1;
4943 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, name, domain, NULL,
4944 wild_match_p);
4945
4946 /* If we found a non-function match, assume that's the one. */
4947 if (is_nonfunction (defns_collected (obstackp, 0),
4948 num_defns_collected (obstackp)))
4949 return;
4950
4951 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
4952 }
4953
4954 /* If no luck so far, try to find NAME as a local symbol in some lexically
4955 enclosing subprogram. */
4956 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && block_depth > 2)
4957 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (obstackp, name, domain, wild_match_p);
4958 }
4959
4960 /* An object of this type is used as the user_data argument when
4961 calling the map_matching_symbols method. */
4962
4963 struct match_data
4964 {
4965 struct objfile *objfile;
4966 struct obstack *obstackp;
4967 struct symbol *arg_sym;
4968 int found_sym;
4969 };
4970
4971 /* A callback for add_matching_symbols that adds SYM, found in BLOCK,
4972 to a list of symbols. DATA0 is a pointer to a struct match_data *
4973 containing the obstack that collects the symbol list, the file that SYM
4974 must come from, a flag indicating whether a non-argument symbol has
4975 been found in the current block, and the last argument symbol
4976 passed in SYM within the current block (if any). When SYM is null,
4977 marking the end of a block, the argument symbol is added if no
4978 other has been found. */
4979
4980 static int
4981 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols (struct block *block, struct symbol *sym, void *data0)
4982 {
4983 struct match_data *data = (struct match_data *) data0;
4984
4985 if (sym == NULL)
4986 {
4987 if (!data->found_sym && data->arg_sym != NULL)
4988 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
4989 fixup_symbol_section (data->arg_sym, data->objfile),
4990 block);
4991 data->found_sym = 0;
4992 data->arg_sym = NULL;
4993 }
4994 else
4995 {
4996 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
4997 return 0;
4998 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
4999 data->arg_sym = sym;
5000 else
5001 {
5002 data->found_sym = 1;
5003 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
5004 fixup_symbol_section (sym, data->objfile),
5005 block);
5006 }
5007 }
5008 return 0;
5009 }
5010
5011 /* Implements compare_names, but only applying the comparision using
5012 the given CASING. */
5013
5014 static int
5015 compare_names_with_case (const char *string1, const char *string2,
5016 enum case_sensitivity casing)
5017 {
5018 while (*string1 != '\0' && *string2 != '\0')
5019 {
5020 char c1, c2;
5021
5022 if (isspace (*string1) || isspace (*string2))
5023 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5024
5025 if (casing == case_sensitive_off)
5026 {
5027 c1 = tolower (*string1);
5028 c2 = tolower (*string2);
5029 }
5030 else
5031 {
5032 c1 = *string1;
5033 c2 = *string2;
5034 }
5035 if (c1 != c2)
5036 break;
5037
5038 string1 += 1;
5039 string2 += 1;
5040 }
5041
5042 switch (*string1)
5043 {
5044 case '(':
5045 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5046 case '_':
5047 if (*string2 == '\0')
5048 {
5049 if (is_name_suffix (string1))
5050 return 0;
5051 else
5052 return 1;
5053 }
5054 /* FALLTHROUGH */
5055 default:
5056 if (*string2 == '(')
5057 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5058 else
5059 {
5060 if (casing == case_sensitive_off)
5061 return tolower (*string1) - tolower (*string2);
5062 else
5063 return *string1 - *string2;
5064 }
5065 }
5066 }
5067
5068 /* Compare STRING1 to STRING2, with results as for strcmp.
5069 Compatible with strcmp_iw_ordered in that...
5070
5071 strcmp_iw_ordered (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0
5072
5073 ... implies...
5074
5075 compare_names (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0
5076
5077 (they may differ as to what symbols compare equal). */
5078
5079 static int
5080 compare_names (const char *string1, const char *string2)
5081 {
5082 int result;
5083
5084 /* Similar to what strcmp_iw_ordered does, we need to perform
5085 a case-insensitive comparison first, and only resort to
5086 a second, case-sensitive, comparison if the first one was
5087 not sufficient to differentiate the two strings. */
5088
5089 result = compare_names_with_case (string1, string2, case_sensitive_off);
5090 if (result == 0)
5091 result = compare_names_with_case (string1, string2, case_sensitive_on);
5092
5093 return result;
5094 }
5095
5096 /* Add to OBSTACKP all non-local symbols whose name and domain match
5097 NAME and DOMAIN respectively. The search is performed on GLOBAL_BLOCK
5098 symbols if GLOBAL is non-zero, or on STATIC_BLOCK symbols otherwise. */
5099
5100 static void
5101 add_nonlocal_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
5102 domain_enum domain, int global,
5103 int is_wild_match)
5104 {
5105 struct objfile *objfile;
5106 struct match_data data;
5107
5108 memset (&data, 0, sizeof data);
5109 data.obstackp = obstackp;
5110
5111 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
5112 {
5113 data.objfile = objfile;
5114
5115 if (is_wild_match)
5116 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, name, domain, global,
5117 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols, &data,
5118 wild_match, NULL);
5119 else
5120 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, name, domain, global,
5121 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols, &data,
5122 full_match, compare_names);
5123 }
5124
5125 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && global && !is_wild_match)
5126 {
5127 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
5128 {
5129 char *name1 = alloca (strlen (name) + sizeof ("_ada_"));
5130 strcpy (name1, "_ada_");
5131 strcpy (name1 + sizeof ("_ada_") - 1, name);
5132 data.objfile = objfile;
5133 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, name1, domain,
5134 global,
5135 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols,
5136 &data,
5137 full_match, compare_names);
5138 }
5139 }
5140 }
5141
5142 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME0, in BLOCK0 and, if full_search is
5143 non-zero, enclosing scope and in global scopes, returning the number of
5144 matches.
5145 Sets *RESULTS to point to a vector of (SYM,BLOCK) tuples,
5146 indicating the symbols found and the blocks and symbol tables (if
5147 any) in which they were found. This vector is transient---good only to
5148 the next call of ada_lookup_symbol_list.
5149
5150 When full_search is non-zero, any non-function/non-enumeral
5151 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK0,
5152 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
5153 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
5154 surrounding BLOCK0, then these alone are returned.
5155
5156 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__"
5157 is first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
5158
5159 static int
5160 ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (const char *name0, const struct block *block0,
5161 domain_enum namespace,
5162 struct ada_symbol_info **results,
5163 int full_search)
5164 {
5165 struct symbol *sym;
5166 struct block *block;
5167 const char *name;
5168 const int wild_match_p = should_use_wild_match (name0);
5169 int cacheIfUnique;
5170 int ndefns;
5171
5172 obstack_free (&symbol_list_obstack, NULL);
5173 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
5174
5175 cacheIfUnique = 0;
5176
5177 /* Search specified block and its superiors. */
5178
5179 name = name0;
5180 block = (struct block *) block0; /* FIXME: No cast ought to be
5181 needed, but adding const will
5182 have a cascade effect. */
5183
5184 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
5185 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
5186 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
5187 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
5188 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
5189 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
5190 entity inside its program). */
5191 if (strncmp (name0, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
5192 {
5193 block = NULL;
5194 name = name0 + sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
5195 }
5196
5197 /* Check the non-global symbols. If we have ANY match, then we're done. */
5198
5199 if (block != NULL)
5200 {
5201 if (full_search)
5202 {
5203 ada_add_local_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, block,
5204 namespace, wild_match_p);
5205 }
5206 else
5207 {
5208 /* In the !full_search case we're are being called by
5209 ada_iterate_over_symbols, and we don't want to search
5210 superblocks. */
5211 ada_add_block_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, block, name,
5212 namespace, NULL, wild_match_p);
5213 }
5214 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) > 0 || !full_search)
5215 goto done;
5216 }
5217
5218 /* No non-global symbols found. Check our cache to see if we have
5219 already performed this search before. If we have, then return
5220 the same result. */
5221
5222 cacheIfUnique = 1;
5223 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name0, namespace, &sym, &block))
5224 {
5225 if (sym != NULL)
5226 add_defn_to_vec (&symbol_list_obstack, sym, block);
5227 goto done;
5228 }
5229
5230 /* Search symbols from all global blocks. */
5231
5232 add_nonlocal_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, namespace, 1,
5233 wild_match_p);
5234
5235 /* Now add symbols from all per-file blocks if we've gotten no hits
5236 (not strictly correct, but perhaps better than an error). */
5237
5238 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) == 0)
5239 add_nonlocal_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, namespace, 0,
5240 wild_match_p);
5241
5242 done:
5243 ndefns = num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack);
5244 *results = defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack, 1);
5245
5246 ndefns = remove_extra_symbols (*results, ndefns);
5247
5248 if (ndefns == 0 && full_search)
5249 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, NULL, NULL);
5250
5251 if (ndefns == 1 && full_search && cacheIfUnique)
5252 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, (*results)[0].sym, (*results)[0].block);
5253
5254 ndefns = remove_irrelevant_renamings (*results, ndefns, block0);
5255
5256 return ndefns;
5257 }
5258
5259 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME0, in BLOCK0 and enclosing scope and
5260 in global scopes, returning the number of matches, and setting *RESULTS
5261 to a vector of (SYM,BLOCK) tuples.
5262 See ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker for further details. */
5263
5264 int
5265 ada_lookup_symbol_list (const char *name0, const struct block *block0,
5266 domain_enum domain, struct ada_symbol_info **results)
5267 {
5268 return ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (name0, block0, domain, results, 1);
5269 }
5270
5271 /* Implementation of the la_iterate_over_symbols method. */
5272
5273 static void
5274 ada_iterate_over_symbols (const struct block *block,
5275 const char *name, domain_enum domain,
5276 symbol_found_callback_ftype *callback,
5277 void *data)
5278 {
5279 int ndefs, i;
5280 struct ada_symbol_info *results;
5281
5282 ndefs = ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (name, block, domain, &results, 0);
5283 for (i = 0; i < ndefs; ++i)
5284 {
5285 if (! (*callback) (results[i].sym, data))
5286 break;
5287 }
5288 }
5289
5290 /* If NAME is the name of an entity, return a string that should
5291 be used to look that entity up in Ada units. This string should
5292 be deallocated after use using xfree.
5293
5294 NAME can have any form that the "break" or "print" commands might
5295 recognize. In other words, it does not have to be the "natural"
5296 name, or the "encoded" name. */
5297
5298 char *
5299 ada_name_for_lookup (const char *name)
5300 {
5301 char *canon;
5302 int nlen = strlen (name);
5303
5304 if (name[0] == '<' && name[nlen - 1] == '>')
5305 {
5306 canon = xmalloc (nlen - 1);
5307 memcpy (canon, name + 1, nlen - 2);
5308 canon[nlen - 2] = '\0';
5309 }
5310 else
5311 canon = xstrdup (ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)));
5312 return canon;
5313 }
5314
5315 /* The result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list with FULL_SEARCH set
5316 to 1, but choosing the first symbol found if there are multiple
5317 choices.
5318
5319 The result is stored in *INFO, which must be non-NULL.
5320 If no match is found, INFO->SYM is set to NULL. */
5321
5322 void
5323 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block,
5324 domain_enum namespace,
5325 struct ada_symbol_info *info)
5326 {
5327 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
5328 int n_candidates;
5329
5330 gdb_assert (info != NULL);
5331 memset (info, 0, sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info));
5332
5333 n_candidates = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block, namespace, &candidates);
5334 if (n_candidates == 0)
5335 return;
5336
5337 *info = candidates[0];
5338 info->sym = fixup_symbol_section (info->sym, NULL);
5339 }
5340
5341 /* Return a symbol in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
5342 scope and in global scopes, or NULL if none. NAME is folded and
5343 encoded first. Otherwise, the result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list,
5344 choosing the first symbol if there are multiple choices.
5345 If IS_A_FIELD_OF_THIS is not NULL, it is set to zero. */
5346
5347 struct symbol *
5348 ada_lookup_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
5349 domain_enum namespace, int *is_a_field_of_this)
5350 {
5351 struct ada_symbol_info info;
5352
5353 if (is_a_field_of_this != NULL)
5354 *is_a_field_of_this = 0;
5355
5356 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)),
5357 block0, namespace, &info);
5358 return info.sym;
5359 }
5360
5361 static struct symbol *
5362 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal (const char *name,
5363 const struct block *block,
5364 const domain_enum domain)
5365 {
5366 return ada_lookup_symbol (name, block_static_block (block), domain, NULL);
5367 }
5368
5369
5370 /* True iff STR is a possible encoded suffix of a normal Ada name
5371 that is to be ignored for matching purposes. Suffixes of parallel
5372 names (e.g., XVE) are not included here. Currently, the possible suffixes
5373 are given by any of the regular expressions:
5374
5375 [.$][0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as GNU/Linux]
5376 ___[0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as HP/UX]
5377 TKB [subprogram suffix for task bodies]
5378 _E[0-9]+[bs]$ [protected object entry suffixes]
5379 (X[nb]*)?((\$|__)[0-9](_?[0-9]+)|___(JM|LJM|X([FDBUP].*|R[^T]?)))?$
5380
5381 Also, any leading "__[0-9]+" sequence is skipped before the suffix
5382 match is performed. This sequence is used to differentiate homonyms,
5383 is an optional part of a valid name suffix. */
5384
5385 static int
5386 is_name_suffix (const char *str)
5387 {
5388 int k;
5389 const char *matching;
5390 const int len = strlen (str);
5391
5392 /* Skip optional leading __[0-9]+. */
5393
5394 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && isdigit (str[2]))
5395 {
5396 str += 3;
5397 while (isdigit (str[0]))
5398 str += 1;
5399 }
5400
5401 /* [.$][0-9]+ */
5402
5403 if (str[0] == '.' || str[0] == '$')
5404 {
5405 matching = str + 1;
5406 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5407 matching += 1;
5408 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5409 return 1;
5410 }
5411
5412 /* ___[0-9]+ */
5413
5414 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && str[2] == '_')
5415 {
5416 matching = str + 3;
5417 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5418 matching += 1;
5419 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5420 return 1;
5421 }
5422
5423 /* "TKB" suffixes are used for subprograms implementing task bodies. */
5424
5425 if (strcmp (str, "TKB") == 0)
5426 return 1;
5427
5428 #if 0
5429 /* FIXME: brobecker/2005-09-23: Protected Object subprograms end
5430 with a N at the end. Unfortunately, the compiler uses the same
5431 convention for other internal types it creates. So treating
5432 all entity names that end with an "N" as a name suffix causes
5433 some regressions. For instance, consider the case of an enumerated
5434 type. To support the 'Image attribute, it creates an array whose
5435 name ends with N.
5436 Having a single character like this as a suffix carrying some
5437 information is a bit risky. Perhaps we should change the encoding
5438 to be something like "_N" instead. In the meantime, do not do
5439 the following check. */
5440 /* Protected Object Subprograms */
5441 if (len == 1 && str [0] == 'N')
5442 return 1;
5443 #endif
5444
5445 /* _E[0-9]+[bs]$ */
5446 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str [1] == 'E' && isdigit (str[2]))
5447 {
5448 matching = str + 3;
5449 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5450 matching += 1;
5451 if ((matching[0] == 'b' || matching[0] == 's')
5452 && matching [1] == '\0')
5453 return 1;
5454 }
5455
5456 /* ??? We should not modify STR directly, as we are doing below. This
5457 is fine in this case, but may become problematic later if we find
5458 that this alternative did not work, and want to try matching
5459 another one from the begining of STR. Since we modified it, we
5460 won't be able to find the begining of the string anymore! */
5461 if (str[0] == 'X')
5462 {
5463 str += 1;
5464 while (str[0] != '_' && str[0] != '\0')
5465 {
5466 if (str[0] != 'n' && str[0] != 'b')
5467 return 0;
5468 str += 1;
5469 }
5470 }
5471
5472 if (str[0] == '\000')
5473 return 1;
5474
5475 if (str[0] == '_')
5476 {
5477 if (str[1] != '_' || str[2] == '\000')
5478 return 0;
5479 if (str[2] == '_')
5480 {
5481 if (strcmp (str + 3, "JM") == 0)
5482 return 1;
5483 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-09-30: GNAT will soon stop using
5484 the LJM suffix in favor of the JM one. But we will
5485 still accept LJM as a valid suffix for a reasonable
5486 amount of time, just to allow ourselves to debug programs
5487 compiled using an older version of GNAT. */
5488 if (strcmp (str + 3, "LJM") == 0)
5489 return 1;
5490 if (str[3] != 'X')
5491 return 0;
5492 if (str[4] == 'F' || str[4] == 'D' || str[4] == 'B'
5493 || str[4] == 'U' || str[4] == 'P')
5494 return 1;
5495 if (str[4] == 'R' && str[5] != 'T')
5496 return 1;
5497 return 0;
5498 }
5499 if (!isdigit (str[2]))
5500 return 0;
5501 for (k = 3; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
5502 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
5503 return 0;
5504 return 1;
5505 }
5506 if (str[0] == '$' && isdigit (str[1]))
5507 {
5508 for (k = 2; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
5509 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
5510 return 0;
5511 return 1;
5512 }
5513 return 0;
5514 }
5515
5516 /* Return non-zero if the string starting at NAME and ending before
5517 NAME_END contains no capital letters. */
5518
5519 static int
5520 is_valid_name_for_wild_match (const char *name0)
5521 {
5522 const char *decoded_name = ada_decode (name0);
5523 int i;
5524
5525 /* If the decoded name starts with an angle bracket, it means that
5526 NAME0 does not follow the GNAT encoding format. It should then
5527 not be allowed as a possible wild match. */
5528 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
5529 return 0;
5530
5531 for (i=0; decoded_name[i] != '\0'; i++)
5532 if (isalpha (decoded_name[i]) && !islower (decoded_name[i]))
5533 return 0;
5534
5535 return 1;
5536 }
5537
5538 /* Advance *NAMEP to next occurrence of TARGET0 in the string NAME0
5539 that could start a simple name. Assumes that *NAMEP points into
5540 the string beginning at NAME0. */
5541
5542 static int
5543 advance_wild_match (const char **namep, const char *name0, int target0)
5544 {
5545 const char *name = *namep;
5546
5547 while (1)
5548 {
5549 int t0, t1;
5550
5551 t0 = *name;
5552 if (t0 == '_')
5553 {
5554 t1 = name[1];
5555 if ((t1 >= 'a' && t1 <= 'z') || (t1 >= '0' && t1 <= '9'))
5556 {
5557 name += 1;
5558 if (name == name0 + 5 && strncmp (name0, "_ada", 4) == 0)
5559 break;
5560 else
5561 name += 1;
5562 }
5563 else if (t1 == '_' && ((name[2] >= 'a' && name[2] <= 'z')
5564 || name[2] == target0))
5565 {
5566 name += 2;
5567 break;
5568 }
5569 else
5570 return 0;
5571 }
5572 else if ((t0 >= 'a' && t0 <= 'z') || (t0 >= '0' && t0 <= '9'))
5573 name += 1;
5574 else
5575 return 0;
5576 }
5577
5578 *namep = name;
5579 return 1;
5580 }
5581
5582 /* Return 0 iff NAME encodes a name of the form prefix.PATN. Ignores any
5583 informational suffixes of NAME (i.e., for which is_name_suffix is
5584 true). Assumes that PATN is a lower-cased Ada simple name. */
5585
5586 static int
5587 wild_match (const char *name, const char *patn)
5588 {
5589 const char *p;
5590 const char *name0 = name;
5591
5592 while (1)
5593 {
5594 const char *match = name;
5595
5596 if (*name == *patn)
5597 {
5598 for (name += 1, p = patn + 1; *p != '\0'; name += 1, p += 1)
5599 if (*p != *name)
5600 break;
5601 if (*p == '\0' && is_name_suffix (name))
5602 return match != name0 && !is_valid_name_for_wild_match (name0);
5603
5604 if (name[-1] == '_')
5605 name -= 1;
5606 }
5607 if (!advance_wild_match (&name, name0, *patn))
5608 return 1;
5609 }
5610 }
5611
5612 /* Returns 0 iff symbol name SYM_NAME matches SEARCH_NAME, apart from
5613 informational suffix. */
5614
5615 static int
5616 full_match (const char *sym_name, const char *search_name)
5617 {
5618 return !match_name (sym_name, search_name, 0);
5619 }
5620
5621
5622 /* Add symbols from BLOCK matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN to
5623 vector *defn_symbols, updating the list of symbols in OBSTACKP
5624 (if necessary). If WILD, treat as NAME with a wildcard prefix.
5625 OBJFILE is the section containing BLOCK. */
5626
5627 static void
5628 ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5629 struct block *block, const char *name,
5630 domain_enum domain, struct objfile *objfile,
5631 int wild)
5632 {
5633 struct block_iterator iter;
5634 int name_len = strlen (name);
5635 /* A matching argument symbol, if any. */
5636 struct symbol *arg_sym;
5637 /* Set true when we find a matching non-argument symbol. */
5638 int found_sym;
5639 struct symbol *sym;
5640
5641 arg_sym = NULL;
5642 found_sym = 0;
5643 if (wild)
5644 {
5645 for (sym = block_iter_match_first (block, name, wild_match, &iter);
5646 sym != NULL; sym = block_iter_match_next (name, wild_match, &iter))
5647 {
5648 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5649 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain)
5650 && wild_match (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), name) == 0)
5651 {
5652 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5653 continue;
5654 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5655 arg_sym = sym;
5656 else
5657 {
5658 found_sym = 1;
5659 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5660 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5661 block);
5662 }
5663 }
5664 }
5665 }
5666 else
5667 {
5668 for (sym = block_iter_match_first (block, name, full_match, &iter);
5669 sym != NULL; sym = block_iter_match_next (name, full_match, &iter))
5670 {
5671 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5672 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5673 {
5674 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5675 {
5676 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5677 arg_sym = sym;
5678 else
5679 {
5680 found_sym = 1;
5681 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5682 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5683 block);
5684 }
5685 }
5686 }
5687 }
5688 }
5689
5690 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5691 {
5692 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5693 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5694 block);
5695 }
5696
5697 if (!wild)
5698 {
5699 arg_sym = NULL;
5700 found_sym = 0;
5701
5702 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5703 {
5704 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5705 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5706 {
5707 int cmp;
5708
5709 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym)[0];
5710 if (cmp == 0)
5711 {
5712 cmp = strncmp ("_ada_", SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), 5);
5713 if (cmp == 0)
5714 cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + 5,
5715 name_len);
5716 }
5717
5718 if (cmp == 0
5719 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + name_len + 5))
5720 {
5721 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5722 {
5723 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5724 arg_sym = sym;
5725 else
5726 {
5727 found_sym = 1;
5728 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5729 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5730 block);
5731 }
5732 }
5733 }
5734 }
5735 }
5736
5737 /* NOTE: This really shouldn't be needed for _ada_ symbols.
5738 They aren't parameters, right? */
5739 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5740 {
5741 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5742 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5743 block);
5744 }
5745 }
5746 }
5747 \f
5748
5749 /* Symbol Completion */
5750
5751 /* If SYM_NAME is a completion candidate for TEXT, return this symbol
5752 name in a form that's appropriate for the completion. The result
5753 does not need to be deallocated, but is only good until the next call.
5754
5755 TEXT_LEN is equal to the length of TEXT.
5756 Perform a wild match if WILD_MATCH_P is set.
5757 ENCODED_P should be set if TEXT represents the start of a symbol name
5758 in its encoded form. */
5759
5760 static const char *
5761 symbol_completion_match (const char *sym_name,
5762 const char *text, int text_len,
5763 int wild_match_p, int encoded_p)
5764 {
5765 const int verbatim_match = (text[0] == '<');
5766 int match = 0;
5767
5768 if (verbatim_match)
5769 {
5770 /* Strip the leading angle bracket. */
5771 text = text + 1;
5772 text_len--;
5773 }
5774
5775 /* First, test against the fully qualified name of the symbol. */
5776
5777 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5778 match = 1;
5779
5780 if (match && !encoded_p)
5781 {
5782 /* One needed check before declaring a positive match is to verify
5783 that iff we are doing a verbatim match, the decoded version
5784 of the symbol name starts with '<'. Otherwise, this symbol name
5785 is not a suitable completion. */
5786 const char *sym_name_copy = sym_name;
5787 int has_angle_bracket;
5788
5789 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5790 has_angle_bracket = (sym_name[0] == '<');
5791 match = (has_angle_bracket == verbatim_match);
5792 sym_name = sym_name_copy;
5793 }
5794
5795 if (match && !verbatim_match)
5796 {
5797 /* When doing non-verbatim match, another check that needs to
5798 be done is to verify that the potentially matching symbol name
5799 does not include capital letters, because the ada-mode would
5800 not be able to understand these symbol names without the
5801 angle bracket notation. */
5802 const char *tmp;
5803
5804 for (tmp = sym_name; *tmp != '\0' && !isupper (*tmp); tmp++);
5805 if (*tmp != '\0')
5806 match = 0;
5807 }
5808
5809 /* Second: Try wild matching... */
5810
5811 if (!match && wild_match_p)
5812 {
5813 /* Since we are doing wild matching, this means that TEXT
5814 may represent an unqualified symbol name. We therefore must
5815 also compare TEXT against the unqualified name of the symbol. */
5816 sym_name = ada_unqualified_name (ada_decode (sym_name));
5817
5818 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5819 match = 1;
5820 }
5821
5822 /* Finally: If we found a mach, prepare the result to return. */
5823
5824 if (!match)
5825 return NULL;
5826
5827 if (verbatim_match)
5828 sym_name = add_angle_brackets (sym_name);
5829
5830 if (!encoded_p)
5831 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5832
5833 return sym_name;
5834 }
5835
5836 /* A companion function to ada_make_symbol_completion_list().
5837 Check if SYM_NAME represents a symbol which name would be suitable
5838 to complete TEXT (TEXT_LEN is the length of TEXT), in which case
5839 it is appended at the end of the given string vector SV.
5840
5841 ORIG_TEXT is the string original string from the user command
5842 that needs to be completed. WORD is the entire command on which
5843 completion should be performed. These two parameters are used to
5844 determine which part of the symbol name should be added to the
5845 completion vector.
5846 if WILD_MATCH_P is set, then wild matching is performed.
5847 ENCODED_P should be set if TEXT represents a symbol name in its
5848 encoded formed (in which case the completion should also be
5849 encoded). */
5850
5851 static void
5852 symbol_completion_add (VEC(char_ptr) **sv,
5853 const char *sym_name,
5854 const char *text, int text_len,
5855 const char *orig_text, const char *word,
5856 int wild_match_p, int encoded_p)
5857 {
5858 const char *match = symbol_completion_match (sym_name, text, text_len,
5859 wild_match_p, encoded_p);
5860 char *completion;
5861
5862 if (match == NULL)
5863 return;
5864
5865 /* We found a match, so add the appropriate completion to the given
5866 string vector. */
5867
5868 if (word == orig_text)
5869 {
5870 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5871 strcpy (completion, match);
5872 }
5873 else if (word > orig_text)
5874 {
5875 /* Return some portion of sym_name. */
5876 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5877 strcpy (completion, match + (word - orig_text));
5878 }
5879 else
5880 {
5881 /* Return some of ORIG_TEXT plus sym_name. */
5882 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + (orig_text - word) + 5);
5883 strncpy (completion, word, orig_text - word);
5884 completion[orig_text - word] = '\0';
5885 strcat (completion, match);
5886 }
5887
5888 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, *sv, completion);
5889 }
5890
5891 /* An object of this type is passed as the user_data argument to the
5892 expand_symtabs_matching method. */
5893 struct add_partial_datum
5894 {
5895 VEC(char_ptr) **completions;
5896 const char *text;
5897 int text_len;
5898 const char *text0;
5899 const char *word;
5900 int wild_match;
5901 int encoded;
5902 };
5903
5904 /* A callback for expand_symtabs_matching. */
5905
5906 static int
5907 ada_complete_symbol_matcher (const char *name, void *user_data)
5908 {
5909 struct add_partial_datum *data = user_data;
5910
5911 return symbol_completion_match (name, data->text, data->text_len,
5912 data->wild_match, data->encoded) != NULL;
5913 }
5914
5915 /* Return a list of possible symbol names completing TEXT0. WORD is
5916 the entire command on which completion is made. */
5917
5918 static VEC (char_ptr) *
5919 ada_make_symbol_completion_list (const char *text0, const char *word,
5920 enum type_code code)
5921 {
5922 char *text;
5923 int text_len;
5924 int wild_match_p;
5925 int encoded_p;
5926 VEC(char_ptr) *completions = VEC_alloc (char_ptr, 128);
5927 struct symbol *sym;
5928 struct symtab *s;
5929 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
5930 struct objfile *objfile;
5931 struct block *b, *surrounding_static_block = 0;
5932 int i;
5933 struct block_iterator iter;
5934 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
5935
5936 gdb_assert (code == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF);
5937
5938 if (text0[0] == '<')
5939 {
5940 text = xstrdup (text0);
5941 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5942 text_len = strlen (text);
5943 wild_match_p = 0;
5944 encoded_p = 1;
5945 }
5946 else
5947 {
5948 text = xstrdup (ada_encode (text0));
5949 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5950 text_len = strlen (text);
5951 for (i = 0; i < text_len; i++)
5952 text[i] = tolower (text[i]);
5953
5954 encoded_p = (strstr (text0, "__") != NULL);
5955 /* If the name contains a ".", then the user is entering a fully
5956 qualified entity name, and the match must not be done in wild
5957 mode. Similarly, if the user wants to complete what looks like
5958 an encoded name, the match must not be done in wild mode. */
5959 wild_match_p = (strchr (text0, '.') == NULL && !encoded_p);
5960 }
5961
5962 /* First, look at the partial symtab symbols. */
5963 {
5964 struct add_partial_datum data;
5965
5966 data.completions = &completions;
5967 data.text = text;
5968 data.text_len = text_len;
5969 data.text0 = text0;
5970 data.word = word;
5971 data.wild_match = wild_match_p;
5972 data.encoded = encoded_p;
5973 expand_symtabs_matching (NULL, ada_complete_symbol_matcher, ALL_DOMAIN,
5974 &data);
5975 }
5976
5977 /* At this point scan through the misc symbol vectors and add each
5978 symbol you find to the list. Eventually we want to ignore
5979 anything that isn't a text symbol (everything else will be
5980 handled by the psymtab code above). */
5981
5982 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
5983 {
5984 QUIT;
5985 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol),
5986 text, text_len, text0, word, wild_match_p,
5987 encoded_p);
5988 }
5989
5990 /* Search upwards from currently selected frame (so that we can
5991 complete on local vars. */
5992
5993 for (b = get_selected_block (0); b != NULL; b = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5994 {
5995 if (!BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5996 surrounding_static_block = b; /* For elmin of dups */
5997
5998 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5999 {
6000 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
6001 text, text_len, text0, word,
6002 wild_match_p, encoded_p);
6003 }
6004 }
6005
6006 /* Go through the symtabs and check the externs and statics for
6007 symbols which match. */
6008
6009 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
6010 {
6011 QUIT;
6012 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
6013 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6014 {
6015 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
6016 text, text_len, text0, word,
6017 wild_match_p, encoded_p);
6018 }
6019 }
6020
6021 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
6022 {
6023 QUIT;
6024 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK);
6025 /* Don't do this block twice. */
6026 if (b == surrounding_static_block)
6027 continue;
6028 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6029 {
6030 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
6031 text, text_len, text0, word,
6032 wild_match_p, encoded_p);
6033 }
6034 }
6035
6036 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6037 return completions;
6038 }
6039
6040 /* Field Access */
6041
6042 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is a pointer to the GNAT dispatch table used
6043 for tagged types. */
6044
6045 static int
6046 ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (struct type *type)
6047 {
6048 const char *name;
6049
6050 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6051 return 0;
6052
6053 name = TYPE_NAME (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
6054 if (name == NULL)
6055 return 0;
6056
6057 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
6058 }
6059
6060 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is an interface tag. */
6061
6062 static int
6063 ada_is_interface_tag (struct type *type)
6064 {
6065 const char *name = TYPE_NAME (type);
6066
6067 if (name == NULL)
6068 return 0;
6069
6070 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__interface_tag") == 0);
6071 }
6072
6073 /* True if field number FIELD_NUM in struct or union type TYPE is supposed
6074 to be invisible to users. */
6075
6076 int
6077 ada_is_ignored_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6078 {
6079 if (field_num < 0 || field_num > TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
6080 return 1;
6081
6082 /* Check the name of that field. */
6083 {
6084 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6085
6086 /* Anonymous field names should not be printed.
6087 brobecker/2007-02-20: I don't think this can actually happen
6088 but we don't want to print the value of annonymous fields anyway. */
6089 if (name == NULL)
6090 return 1;
6091
6092 /* Normally, fields whose name start with an underscore ("_")
6093 are fields that have been internally generated by the compiler,
6094 and thus should not be printed. The "_parent" field is special,
6095 however: This is a field internally generated by the compiler
6096 for tagged types, and it contains the components inherited from
6097 the parent type. This field should not be printed as is, but
6098 should not be ignored either. */
6099 if (name[0] == '_' && strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) != 0)
6100 return 1;
6101 }
6102
6103 /* If this is the dispatch table of a tagged type or an interface tag,
6104 then ignore. */
6105 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 1)
6106 && (ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num))
6107 || ada_is_interface_tag (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num))))
6108 return 1;
6109
6110 /* Not a special field, so it should not be ignored. */
6111 return 0;
6112 }
6113
6114 /* True iff TYPE has a tag field. If REFOK, then TYPE may also be a
6115 pointer or reference type whose ultimate target has a tag field. */
6116
6117 int
6118 ada_is_tagged_type (struct type *type, int refok)
6119 {
6120 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "_tag", refok, 1, NULL) != NULL);
6121 }
6122
6123 /* True iff TYPE represents the type of X'Tag */
6124
6125 int
6126 ada_is_tag_type (struct type *type)
6127 {
6128 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6129 return 0;
6130 else
6131 {
6132 const char *name = ada_type_name (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
6133
6134 return (name != NULL
6135 && strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
6136 }
6137 }
6138
6139 /* The type of the tag on VAL. */
6140
6141 struct type *
6142 ada_tag_type (struct value *val)
6143 {
6144 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (value_type (val), "_tag", 1, 0, NULL);
6145 }
6146
6147 /* Return 1 if TAG follows the old scheme for Ada tags (used for Ada 95,
6148 retired at Ada 05). */
6149
6150 static int
6151 is_ada95_tag (struct value *tag)
6152 {
6153 return ada_value_struct_elt (tag, "tsd", 1) != NULL;
6154 }
6155
6156 /* The value of the tag on VAL. */
6157
6158 struct value *
6159 ada_value_tag (struct value *val)
6160 {
6161 return ada_value_struct_elt (val, "_tag", 0);
6162 }
6163
6164 /* The value of the tag on the object of type TYPE whose contents are
6165 saved at VALADDR, if it is non-null, or is at memory address
6166 ADDRESS. */
6167
6168 static struct value *
6169 value_tag_from_contents_and_address (struct type *type,
6170 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
6171 CORE_ADDR address)
6172 {
6173 int tag_byte_offset;
6174 struct type *tag_type;
6175
6176 if (find_struct_field ("_tag", type, 0, &tag_type, &tag_byte_offset,
6177 NULL, NULL, NULL))
6178 {
6179 const gdb_byte *valaddr1 = ((valaddr == NULL)
6180 ? NULL
6181 : valaddr + tag_byte_offset);
6182 CORE_ADDR address1 = (address == 0) ? 0 : address + tag_byte_offset;
6183
6184 return value_from_contents_and_address (tag_type, valaddr1, address1);
6185 }
6186 return NULL;
6187 }
6188
6189 static struct type *
6190 type_from_tag (struct value *tag)
6191 {
6192 const char *type_name = ada_tag_name (tag);
6193
6194 if (type_name != NULL)
6195 return ada_find_any_type (ada_encode (type_name));
6196 return NULL;
6197 }
6198
6199 /* Given a value OBJ of a tagged type, return a value of this
6200 type at the base address of the object. The base address, as
6201 defined in Ada.Tags, it is the address of the primary tag of
6202 the object, and therefore where the field values of its full
6203 view can be fetched. */
6204
6205 struct value *
6206 ada_tag_value_at_base_address (struct value *obj)
6207 {
6208 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
6209 struct value *val;
6210 LONGEST offset_to_top = 0;
6211 struct type *ptr_type, *obj_type;
6212 struct value *tag;
6213 CORE_ADDR base_address;
6214
6215 obj_type = value_type (obj);
6216
6217 /* It is the responsability of the caller to deref pointers. */
6218
6219 if (TYPE_CODE (obj_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
6220 || TYPE_CODE (obj_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6221 return obj;
6222
6223 tag = ada_value_tag (obj);
6224 if (!tag)
6225 return obj;
6226
6227 /* Base addresses only appeared with Ada 05 and multiple inheritance. */
6228
6229 if (is_ada95_tag (tag))
6230 return obj;
6231
6232 ptr_type = builtin_type (target_gdbarch ())->builtin_data_ptr;
6233 ptr_type = lookup_pointer_type (ptr_type);
6234 val = value_cast (ptr_type, tag);
6235 if (!val)
6236 return obj;
6237
6238 /* It is perfectly possible that an exception be raised while
6239 trying to determine the base address, just like for the tag;
6240 see ada_tag_name for more details. We do not print the error
6241 message for the same reason. */
6242
6243 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
6244 {
6245 offset_to_top = value_as_long (value_ind (value_ptradd (val, -2)));
6246 }
6247
6248 if (e.reason < 0)
6249 return obj;
6250
6251 /* If offset is null, nothing to do. */
6252
6253 if (offset_to_top == 0)
6254 return obj;
6255
6256 /* -1 is a special case in Ada.Tags; however, what should be done
6257 is not quite clear from the documentation. So do nothing for
6258 now. */
6259
6260 if (offset_to_top == -1)
6261 return obj;
6262
6263 base_address = value_address (obj) - offset_to_top;
6264 tag = value_tag_from_contents_and_address (obj_type, NULL, base_address);
6265
6266 /* Make sure that we have a proper tag at the new address.
6267 Otherwise, offset_to_top is bogus (which can happen when
6268 the object is not initialized yet). */
6269
6270 if (!tag)
6271 return obj;
6272
6273 obj_type = type_from_tag (tag);
6274
6275 if (!obj_type)
6276 return obj;
6277
6278 return value_from_contents_and_address (obj_type, NULL, base_address);
6279 }
6280
6281 /* Return the "ada__tags__type_specific_data" type. */
6282
6283 static struct type *
6284 ada_get_tsd_type (struct inferior *inf)
6285 {
6286 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (inf);
6287
6288 if (data->tsd_type == 0)
6289 data->tsd_type = ada_find_any_type ("ada__tags__type_specific_data");
6290 return data->tsd_type;
6291 }
6292
6293 /* Return the TSD (type-specific data) associated to the given TAG.
6294 TAG is assumed to be the tag of a tagged-type entity.
6295
6296 May return NULL if we are unable to get the TSD. */
6297
6298 static struct value *
6299 ada_get_tsd_from_tag (struct value *tag)
6300 {
6301 struct value *val;
6302 struct type *type;
6303
6304 /* First option: The TSD is simply stored as a field of our TAG.
6305 Only older versions of GNAT would use this format, but we have
6306 to test it first, because there are no visible markers for
6307 the current approach except the absence of that field. */
6308
6309 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tag, "tsd", 1);
6310 if (val)
6311 return val;
6312
6313 /* Try the second representation for the dispatch table (in which
6314 there is no explicit 'tsd' field in the referent of the tag pointer,
6315 and instead the tsd pointer is stored just before the dispatch
6316 table. */
6317
6318 type = ada_get_tsd_type (current_inferior());
6319 if (type == NULL)
6320 return NULL;
6321 type = lookup_pointer_type (lookup_pointer_type (type));
6322 val = value_cast (type, tag);
6323 if (val == NULL)
6324 return NULL;
6325 return value_ind (value_ptradd (val, -1));
6326 }
6327
6328 /* Given the TSD of a tag (type-specific data), return a string
6329 containing the name of the associated type.
6330
6331 The returned value is good until the next call. May return NULL
6332 if we are unable to determine the tag name. */
6333
6334 static char *
6335 ada_tag_name_from_tsd (struct value *tsd)
6336 {
6337 static char name[1024];
6338 char *p;
6339 struct value *val;
6340
6341 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tsd, "expanded_name", 1);
6342 if (val == NULL)
6343 return NULL;
6344 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
6345 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
6346 if (isalpha (*p))
6347 *p = tolower (*p);
6348 return name;
6349 }
6350
6351 /* The type name of the dynamic type denoted by the 'tag value TAG, as
6352 a C string.
6353
6354 Return NULL if the TAG is not an Ada tag, or if we were unable to
6355 determine the name of that tag. The result is good until the next
6356 call. */
6357
6358 const char *
6359 ada_tag_name (struct value *tag)
6360 {
6361 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
6362 char *name = NULL;
6363
6364 if (!ada_is_tag_type (value_type (tag)))
6365 return NULL;
6366
6367 /* It is perfectly possible that an exception be raised while trying
6368 to determine the TAG's name, even under normal circumstances:
6369 The associated variable may be uninitialized or corrupted, for
6370 instance. We do not let any exception propagate past this point.
6371 instead we return NULL.
6372
6373 We also do not print the error message either (which often is very
6374 low-level (Eg: "Cannot read memory at 0x[...]"), but instead let
6375 the caller print a more meaningful message if necessary. */
6376 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
6377 {
6378 struct value *tsd = ada_get_tsd_from_tag (tag);
6379
6380 if (tsd != NULL)
6381 name = ada_tag_name_from_tsd (tsd);
6382 }
6383
6384 return name;
6385 }
6386
6387 /* The parent type of TYPE, or NULL if none. */
6388
6389 struct type *
6390 ada_parent_type (struct type *type)
6391 {
6392 int i;
6393
6394 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6395
6396 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
6397 return NULL;
6398
6399 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6400 if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
6401 {
6402 struct type *parent_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
6403
6404 /* If the _parent field is a pointer, then dereference it. */
6405 if (TYPE_CODE (parent_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6406 parent_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (parent_type);
6407 /* If there is a parallel XVS type, get the actual base type. */
6408 parent_type = ada_get_base_type (parent_type);
6409
6410 return ada_check_typedef (parent_type);
6411 }
6412
6413 return NULL;
6414 }
6415
6416 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE contains the
6417 parent-type (inherited) fields of a derived type. Assumes TYPE is
6418 a structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6419
6420 int
6421 ada_is_parent_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6422 {
6423 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (ada_check_typedef (type), field_num);
6424
6425 return (name != NULL
6426 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
6427 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0));
6428 }
6429
6430 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE is a
6431 transparent wrapper field (which should be silently traversed when doing
6432 field selection and flattened when printing). Assumes TYPE is a
6433 structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. Such fields are always
6434 structures. */
6435
6436 int
6437 ada_is_wrapper_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6438 {
6439 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6440
6441 return (name != NULL
6442 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
6443 || strcmp (name, "REP") == 0
6444 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0
6445 || name[0] == 'S' || name[0] == 'R' || name[0] == 'O'));
6446 }
6447
6448 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure or union type TYPE
6449 is a variant wrapper. Assumes TYPE is a structure type with at least
6450 FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6451
6452 int
6453 ada_is_variant_part (struct type *type, int field_num)
6454 {
6455 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num);
6456
6457 return (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNION
6458 || (is_dynamic_field (type, field_num)
6459 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type))
6460 == TYPE_CODE_UNION)));
6461 }
6462
6463 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is a variant wrapper (type of the variant part)
6464 whose discriminants are contained in the record type OUTER_TYPE,
6465 returns the type of the controlling discriminant for the variant.
6466 May return NULL if the type could not be found. */
6467
6468 struct type *
6469 ada_variant_discrim_type (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
6470 {
6471 char *name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6472
6473 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, name, 1, 1, NULL);
6474 }
6475
6476 /* Assuming that TYPE is the type of a variant wrapper, and FIELD_NUM is a
6477 valid field number within it, returns 1 iff field FIELD_NUM of TYPE
6478 represents a 'when others' clause; otherwise 0. */
6479
6480 int
6481 ada_is_others_clause (struct type *type, int field_num)
6482 {
6483 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6484
6485 return (name != NULL && name[0] == 'O');
6486 }
6487
6488 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is the type of the variant part of a record,
6489 returns the name of the discriminant controlling the variant.
6490 The value is valid until the next call to ada_variant_discrim_name. */
6491
6492 char *
6493 ada_variant_discrim_name (struct type *type0)
6494 {
6495 static char *result = NULL;
6496 static size_t result_len = 0;
6497 struct type *type;
6498 const char *name;
6499 const char *discrim_end;
6500 const char *discrim_start;
6501
6502 if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6503 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
6504 else
6505 type = type0;
6506
6507 name = ada_type_name (type);
6508
6509 if (name == NULL || name[0] == '\000')
6510 return "";
6511
6512 for (discrim_end = name + strlen (name) - 6; discrim_end != name;
6513 discrim_end -= 1)
6514 {
6515 if (strncmp (discrim_end, "___XVN", 6) == 0)
6516 break;
6517 }
6518 if (discrim_end == name)
6519 return "";
6520
6521 for (discrim_start = discrim_end; discrim_start != name + 3;
6522 discrim_start -= 1)
6523 {
6524 if (discrim_start == name + 1)
6525 return "";
6526 if ((discrim_start > name + 3
6527 && strncmp (discrim_start - 3, "___", 3) == 0)
6528 || discrim_start[-1] == '.')
6529 break;
6530 }
6531
6532 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, discrim_end - discrim_start + 1);
6533 strncpy (result, discrim_start, discrim_end - discrim_start);
6534 result[discrim_end - discrim_start] = '\0';
6535 return result;
6536 }
6537
6538 /* Scan STR for a subtype-encoded number, beginning at position K.
6539 Put the position of the character just past the number scanned in
6540 *NEW_K, if NEW_K!=NULL. Put the scanned number in *R, if R!=NULL.
6541 Return 1 if there was a valid number at the given position, and 0
6542 otherwise. A "subtype-encoded" number consists of the absolute value
6543 in decimal, followed by the letter 'm' to indicate a negative number.
6544 Assumes 0m does not occur. */
6545
6546 int
6547 ada_scan_number (const char str[], int k, LONGEST * R, int *new_k)
6548 {
6549 ULONGEST RU;
6550
6551 if (!isdigit (str[k]))
6552 return 0;
6553
6554 /* Do it the hard way so as not to make any assumption about
6555 the relationship of unsigned long (%lu scan format code) and
6556 LONGEST. */
6557 RU = 0;
6558 while (isdigit (str[k]))
6559 {
6560 RU = RU * 10 + (str[k] - '0');
6561 k += 1;
6562 }
6563
6564 if (str[k] == 'm')
6565 {
6566 if (R != NULL)
6567 *R = (-(LONGEST) (RU - 1)) - 1;
6568 k += 1;
6569 }
6570 else if (R != NULL)
6571 *R = (LONGEST) RU;
6572
6573 /* NOTE on the above: Technically, C does not say what the results of
6574 - (LONGEST) RU or (LONGEST) -RU are for RU == largest positive
6575 number representable as a LONGEST (although either would probably work
6576 in most implementations). When RU>0, the locution in the then branch
6577 above is always equivalent to the negative of RU. */
6578
6579 if (new_k != NULL)
6580 *new_k = k;
6581 return 1;
6582 }
6583
6584 /* Assuming that TYPE is a variant part wrapper type (a VARIANTS field),
6585 and FIELD_NUM is a valid field number within it, returns 1 iff VAL is
6586 in the range encoded by field FIELD_NUM of TYPE; otherwise 0. */
6587
6588 int
6589 ada_in_variant (LONGEST val, struct type *type, int field_num)
6590 {
6591 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6592 int p;
6593
6594 p = 0;
6595 while (1)
6596 {
6597 switch (name[p])
6598 {
6599 case '\0':
6600 return 0;
6601 case 'S':
6602 {
6603 LONGEST W;
6604
6605 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &W, &p))
6606 return 0;
6607 if (val == W)
6608 return 1;
6609 break;
6610 }
6611 case 'R':
6612 {
6613 LONGEST L, U;
6614
6615 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &L, &p)
6616 || name[p] != 'T' || !ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &U, &p))
6617 return 0;
6618 if (val >= L && val <= U)
6619 return 1;
6620 break;
6621 }
6622 case 'O':
6623 return 1;
6624 default:
6625 return 0;
6626 }
6627 }
6628 }
6629
6630 /* FIXME: Lots of redundancy below. Try to consolidate. */
6631
6632 /* Given a value ARG1 (offset by OFFSET bytes) of a struct or union type
6633 ARG_TYPE, extract and return the value of one of its (non-static)
6634 fields. FIELDNO says which field. Differs from value_primitive_field
6635 only in that it can handle packed values of arbitrary type. */
6636
6637 static struct value *
6638 ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *arg1, int offset, int fieldno,
6639 struct type *arg_type)
6640 {
6641 struct type *type;
6642
6643 arg_type = ada_check_typedef (arg_type);
6644 type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (arg_type, fieldno);
6645
6646 /* Handle packed fields. */
6647
6648 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno) != 0)
6649 {
6650 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (arg_type, fieldno);
6651 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno);
6652
6653 return ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg1, value_contents (arg1),
6654 offset + bit_pos / 8,
6655 bit_pos % 8, bit_size, type);
6656 }
6657 else
6658 return value_primitive_field (arg1, offset, fieldno, arg_type);
6659 }
6660
6661 /* Find field with name NAME in object of type TYPE. If found,
6662 set the following for each argument that is non-null:
6663 - *FIELD_TYPE_P to the field's type;
6664 - *BYTE_OFFSET_P to OFFSET + the byte offset of the field within
6665 an object of that type;
6666 - *BIT_OFFSET_P to the bit offset modulo byte size of the field;
6667 - *BIT_SIZE_P to its size in bits if the field is packed, and
6668 0 otherwise;
6669 If INDEX_P is non-null, increment *INDEX_P by the number of source-visible
6670 fields up to but not including the desired field, or by the total
6671 number of fields if not found. A NULL value of NAME never
6672 matches; the function just counts visible fields in this case.
6673
6674 Returns 1 if found, 0 otherwise. */
6675
6676 static int
6677 find_struct_field (const char *name, struct type *type, int offset,
6678 struct type **field_type_p,
6679 int *byte_offset_p, int *bit_offset_p, int *bit_size_p,
6680 int *index_p)
6681 {
6682 int i;
6683
6684 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6685
6686 if (field_type_p != NULL)
6687 *field_type_p = NULL;
6688 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
6689 *byte_offset_p = 0;
6690 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
6691 *bit_offset_p = 0;
6692 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
6693 *bit_size_p = 0;
6694
6695 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6696 {
6697 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i);
6698 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
6699 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6700
6701 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6702 continue;
6703
6704 else if (name != NULL && field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6705 {
6706 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, i);
6707
6708 if (field_type_p != NULL)
6709 *field_type_p = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
6710 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
6711 *byte_offset_p = fld_offset;
6712 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
6713 *bit_offset_p = bit_pos % 8;
6714 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
6715 *bit_size_p = bit_size;
6716 return 1;
6717 }
6718 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6719 {
6720 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), fld_offset,
6721 field_type_p, byte_offset_p, bit_offset_p,
6722 bit_size_p, index_p))
6723 return 1;
6724 }
6725 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6726 {
6727 /* PNH: Wait. Do we ever execute this section, or is ARG always of
6728 fixed type?? */
6729 int j;
6730 struct type *field_type
6731 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6732
6733 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
6734 {
6735 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
6736 fld_offset
6737 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
6738 field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
6739 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
6740 return 1;
6741 }
6742 }
6743 else if (index_p != NULL)
6744 *index_p += 1;
6745 }
6746 return 0;
6747 }
6748
6749 /* Number of user-visible fields in record type TYPE. */
6750
6751 static int
6752 num_visible_fields (struct type *type)
6753 {
6754 int n;
6755
6756 n = 0;
6757 find_struct_field (NULL, type, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &n);
6758 return n;
6759 }
6760
6761 /* Look for a field NAME in ARG. Adjust the address of ARG by OFFSET bytes,
6762 and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6763 If found, return value, else return NULL.
6764
6765 Searches recursively through wrapper fields (e.g., '_parent'). */
6766
6767 static struct value *
6768 ada_search_struct_field (char *name, struct value *arg, int offset,
6769 struct type *type)
6770 {
6771 int i;
6772
6773 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6774 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6775 {
6776 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6777
6778 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6779 continue;
6780
6781 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6782 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6783
6784 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6785 {
6786 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6787 ada_search_struct_field (name, arg,
6788 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6789 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6790
6791 if (v != NULL)
6792 return v;
6793 }
6794
6795 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6796 {
6797 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See find_struct_field. */
6798 int j;
6799 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
6800 i));
6801 int var_offset = offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6802
6803 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
6804 {
6805 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field /* Force line
6806 break. */
6807 (name, arg,
6808 var_offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
6809 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
6810
6811 if (v != NULL)
6812 return v;
6813 }
6814 }
6815 }
6816 return NULL;
6817 }
6818
6819 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *, struct value *,
6820 int, struct type *);
6821
6822
6823 /* Return field #INDEX in ARG, where the index is that returned by
6824 * find_struct_field through its INDEX_P argument. Adjust the address
6825 * of ARG by OFFSET bytes, and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6826 * If found, return value, else return NULL. */
6827
6828 static struct value *
6829 ada_index_struct_field (int index, struct value *arg, int offset,
6830 struct type *type)
6831 {
6832 return ada_index_struct_field_1 (&index, arg, offset, type);
6833 }
6834
6835
6836 /* Auxiliary function for ada_index_struct_field. Like
6837 * ada_index_struct_field, but takes index from *INDEX_P and modifies
6838 * *INDEX_P. */
6839
6840 static struct value *
6841 ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *index_p, struct value *arg, int offset,
6842 struct type *type)
6843 {
6844 int i;
6845 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6846
6847 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6848 {
6849 if (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i) == NULL)
6850 continue;
6851 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6852 {
6853 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6854 ada_index_struct_field_1 (index_p, arg,
6855 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6856 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6857
6858 if (v != NULL)
6859 return v;
6860 }
6861
6862 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6863 {
6864 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See ada_search_struct_field,
6865 find_struct_field. */
6866 error (_("Cannot assign this kind of variant record"));
6867 }
6868 else if (*index_p == 0)
6869 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6870 else
6871 *index_p -= 1;
6872 }
6873 return NULL;
6874 }
6875
6876 /* Given ARG, a value of type (pointer or reference to a)*
6877 structure/union, extract the component named NAME from the ultimate
6878 target structure/union and return it as a value with its
6879 appropriate type.
6880
6881 The routine searches for NAME among all members of the structure itself
6882 and (recursively) among all members of any wrapper members
6883 (e.g., '_parent').
6884
6885 If NO_ERR, then simply return NULL in case of error, rather than
6886 calling error. */
6887
6888 struct value *
6889 ada_value_struct_elt (struct value *arg, char *name, int no_err)
6890 {
6891 struct type *t, *t1;
6892 struct value *v;
6893
6894 v = NULL;
6895 t1 = t = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg));
6896 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6897 {
6898 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6899 if (t1 == NULL)
6900 goto BadValue;
6901 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6902 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6903 {
6904 arg = coerce_ref (arg);
6905 t = t1;
6906 }
6907 }
6908
6909 while (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6910 {
6911 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6912 if (t1 == NULL)
6913 goto BadValue;
6914 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6915 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6916 {
6917 arg = value_ind (arg);
6918 t = t1;
6919 }
6920 else
6921 break;
6922 }
6923
6924 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT && TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_UNION)
6925 goto BadValue;
6926
6927 if (t1 == t)
6928 v = ada_search_struct_field (name, arg, 0, t);
6929 else
6930 {
6931 int bit_offset, bit_size, byte_offset;
6932 struct type *field_type;
6933 CORE_ADDR address;
6934
6935 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6936 address = value_address (ada_value_ind (arg));
6937 else
6938 address = value_address (ada_coerce_ref (arg));
6939
6940 t1 = ada_to_fixed_type (ada_get_base_type (t1), NULL, address, NULL, 1);
6941 if (find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
6942 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
6943 &bit_size, NULL))
6944 {
6945 if (bit_size != 0)
6946 {
6947 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6948 arg = ada_coerce_ref (arg);
6949 else
6950 arg = ada_value_ind (arg);
6951 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg, NULL, byte_offset,
6952 bit_offset, bit_size,
6953 field_type);
6954 }
6955 else
6956 v = value_at_lazy (field_type, address + byte_offset);
6957 }
6958 }
6959
6960 if (v != NULL || no_err)
6961 return v;
6962 else
6963 error (_("There is no member named %s."), name);
6964
6965 BadValue:
6966 if (no_err)
6967 return NULL;
6968 else
6969 error (_("Attempt to extract a component of "
6970 "a value that is not a record."));
6971 }
6972
6973 /* Given a type TYPE, look up the type of the component of type named NAME.
6974 If DISPP is non-null, add its byte displacement from the beginning of a
6975 structure (pointed to by a value) of type TYPE to *DISPP (does not
6976 work for packed fields).
6977
6978 Matches any field whose name has NAME as a prefix, possibly
6979 followed by "___".
6980
6981 TYPE can be either a struct or union. If REFOK, TYPE may also
6982 be a (pointer or reference)+ to a struct or union, and the
6983 ultimate target type will be searched.
6984
6985 Looks recursively into variant clauses and parent types.
6986
6987 If NOERR is nonzero, return NULL if NAME is not suitably defined or
6988 TYPE is not a type of the right kind. */
6989
6990 static struct type *
6991 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *type, char *name, int refok,
6992 int noerr, int *dispp)
6993 {
6994 int i;
6995
6996 if (name == NULL)
6997 goto BadName;
6998
6999 if (refok && type != NULL)
7000 while (1)
7001 {
7002 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7003 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
7004 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
7005 break;
7006 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
7007 }
7008
7009 if (type == NULL
7010 || (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7011 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_UNION))
7012 {
7013 if (noerr)
7014 return NULL;
7015 else
7016 {
7017 target_terminal_ours ();
7018 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
7019 if (type == NULL)
7020 error (_("Type (null) is not a structure or union type"));
7021 else
7022 {
7023 /* XXX: type_sprint */
7024 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
7025 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
7026 error (_(" is not a structure or union type"));
7027 }
7028 }
7029 }
7030
7031 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
7032
7033 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7034 {
7035 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
7036 struct type *t;
7037 int disp;
7038
7039 if (t_field_name == NULL)
7040 continue;
7041
7042 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
7043 {
7044 if (dispp != NULL)
7045 *dispp += TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
7046 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
7047 }
7048
7049 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7050 {
7051 disp = 0;
7052 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), name,
7053 0, 1, &disp);
7054 if (t != NULL)
7055 {
7056 if (dispp != NULL)
7057 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
7058 return t;
7059 }
7060 }
7061
7062 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7063 {
7064 int j;
7065 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
7066 i));
7067
7068 for (j = TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type) - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
7069 {
7070 /* FIXME pnh 2008/01/26: We check for a field that is
7071 NOT wrapped in a struct, since the compiler sometimes
7072 generates these for unchecked variant types. Revisit
7073 if the compiler changes this practice. */
7074 const char *v_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (field_type, j);
7075 disp = 0;
7076 if (v_field_name != NULL
7077 && field_name_match (v_field_name, name))
7078 t = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
7079 else
7080 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type,
7081 j),
7082 name, 0, 1, &disp);
7083
7084 if (t != NULL)
7085 {
7086 if (dispp != NULL)
7087 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
7088 return t;
7089 }
7090 }
7091 }
7092
7093 }
7094
7095 BadName:
7096 if (!noerr)
7097 {
7098 target_terminal_ours ();
7099 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
7100 if (name == NULL)
7101 {
7102 /* XXX: type_sprint */
7103 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
7104 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
7105 error (_(" has no component named <null>"));
7106 }
7107 else
7108 {
7109 /* XXX: type_sprint */
7110 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
7111 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
7112 error (_(" has no component named %s"), name);
7113 }
7114 }
7115
7116 return NULL;
7117 }
7118
7119 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
7120 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE, return true iff VAR_TYPE
7121 represents an unchecked union (that is, the variant part of a
7122 record that is named in an Unchecked_Union pragma). */
7123
7124 static int
7125 is_unchecked_variant (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
7126 {
7127 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
7128
7129 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, discrim_name, 0, 1, NULL)
7130 == NULL);
7131 }
7132
7133
7134 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
7135 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE that is stored in GDB at
7136 OUTER_VALADDR, determine which variant clause (field number in VAR_TYPE,
7137 numbering from 0) is applicable. Returns -1 if none are. */
7138
7139 int
7140 ada_which_variant_applies (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type,
7141 const gdb_byte *outer_valaddr)
7142 {
7143 int others_clause;
7144 int i;
7145 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
7146 struct value *outer;
7147 struct value *discrim;
7148 LONGEST discrim_val;
7149
7150 outer = value_from_contents_and_address (outer_type, outer_valaddr, 0);
7151 discrim = ada_value_struct_elt (outer, discrim_name, 1);
7152 if (discrim == NULL)
7153 return -1;
7154 discrim_val = value_as_long (discrim);
7155
7156 others_clause = -1;
7157 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (var_type); i += 1)
7158 {
7159 if (ada_is_others_clause (var_type, i))
7160 others_clause = i;
7161 else if (ada_in_variant (discrim_val, var_type, i))
7162 return i;
7163 }
7164
7165 return others_clause;
7166 }
7167 \f
7168
7169
7170 /* Dynamic-Sized Records */
7171
7172 /* Strategy: The type ostensibly attached to a value with dynamic size
7173 (i.e., a size that is not statically recorded in the debugging
7174 data) does not accurately reflect the size or layout of the value.
7175 Our strategy is to convert these values to values with accurate,
7176 conventional types that are constructed on the fly. */
7177
7178 /* There is a subtle and tricky problem here. In general, we cannot
7179 determine the size of dynamic records without its data. However,
7180 the 'struct value' data structure, which GDB uses to represent
7181 quantities in the inferior process (the target), requires the size
7182 of the type at the time of its allocation in order to reserve space
7183 for GDB's internal copy of the data. That's why the
7184 'to_fixed_xxx_type' routines take (target) addresses as parameters,
7185 rather than struct value*s.
7186
7187 However, GDB's internal history variables ($1, $2, etc.) are
7188 struct value*s containing internal copies of the data that are not, in
7189 general, the same as the data at their corresponding addresses in
7190 the target. Fortunately, the types we give to these values are all
7191 conventional, fixed-size types (as per the strategy described
7192 above), so that we don't usually have to perform the
7193 'to_fixed_xxx_type' conversions to look at their values.
7194 Unfortunately, there is one exception: if one of the internal
7195 history variables is an array whose elements are unconstrained
7196 records, then we will need to create distinct fixed types for each
7197 element selected. */
7198
7199 /* The upshot of all of this is that many routines take a (type, host
7200 address, target address) triple as arguments to represent a value.
7201 The host address, if non-null, is supposed to contain an internal
7202 copy of the relevant data; otherwise, the program is to consult the
7203 target at the target address. */
7204
7205 /* Assuming that VAL0 represents a pointer value, the result of
7206 dereferencing it. Differs from value_ind in its treatment of
7207 dynamic-sized types. */
7208
7209 struct value *
7210 ada_value_ind (struct value *val0)
7211 {
7212 struct value *val = value_ind (val0);
7213
7214 if (ada_is_tagged_type (value_type (val), 0))
7215 val = ada_tag_value_at_base_address (val);
7216
7217 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
7218 }
7219
7220 /* The value resulting from dereferencing any "reference to"
7221 qualifiers on VAL0. */
7222
7223 static struct value *
7224 ada_coerce_ref (struct value *val0)
7225 {
7226 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val0)) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
7227 {
7228 struct value *val = val0;
7229
7230 val = coerce_ref (val);
7231
7232 if (ada_is_tagged_type (value_type (val), 0))
7233 val = ada_tag_value_at_base_address (val);
7234
7235 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
7236 }
7237 else
7238 return val0;
7239 }
7240
7241 /* Return OFF rounded upward if necessary to a multiple of
7242 ALIGNMENT (a power of 2). */
7243
7244 static unsigned int
7245 align_value (unsigned int off, unsigned int alignment)
7246 {
7247 return (off + alignment - 1) & ~(alignment - 1);
7248 }
7249
7250 /* Return the bit alignment required for field #F of template type TYPE. */
7251
7252 static unsigned int
7253 field_alignment (struct type *type, int f)
7254 {
7255 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7256 int len;
7257 int align_offset;
7258
7259 /* The field name should never be null, unless the debugging information
7260 is somehow malformed. In this case, we assume the field does not
7261 require any alignment. */
7262 if (name == NULL)
7263 return 1;
7264
7265 len = strlen (name);
7266
7267 if (!isdigit (name[len - 1]))
7268 return 1;
7269
7270 if (isdigit (name[len - 2]))
7271 align_offset = len - 2;
7272 else
7273 align_offset = len - 1;
7274
7275 if (align_offset < 7 || strncmp ("___XV", name + align_offset - 6, 5) != 0)
7276 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7277
7278 return atoi (name + align_offset) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7279 }
7280
7281 /* Find a typedef or tag symbol named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */
7282
7283 static struct symbol *
7284 ada_find_any_type_symbol (const char *name)
7285 {
7286 struct symbol *sym;
7287
7288 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (NULL), VAR_DOMAIN);
7289 if (sym != NULL && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
7290 return sym;
7291
7292 sym = standard_lookup (name, NULL, STRUCT_DOMAIN);
7293 return sym;
7294 }
7295
7296 /* Find a type named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. This routine will look
7297 solely for types defined by debug info, it will not search the GDB
7298 primitive types. */
7299
7300 static struct type *
7301 ada_find_any_type (const char *name)
7302 {
7303 struct symbol *sym = ada_find_any_type_symbol (name);
7304
7305 if (sym != NULL)
7306 return SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
7307
7308 return NULL;
7309 }
7310
7311 /* Given NAME_SYM and an associated BLOCK, find a "renaming" symbol
7312 associated with NAME_SYM's name. NAME_SYM may itself be a renaming
7313 symbol, in which case it is returned. Otherwise, this looks for
7314 symbols whose name is that of NAME_SYM suffixed with "___XR".
7315 Return symbol if found, and NULL otherwise. */
7316
7317 struct symbol *
7318 ada_find_renaming_symbol (struct symbol *name_sym, const struct block *block)
7319 {
7320 const char *name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (name_sym);
7321 struct symbol *sym;
7322
7323 if (strstr (name, "___XR") != NULL)
7324 return name_sym;
7325
7326 sym = find_old_style_renaming_symbol (name, block);
7327
7328 if (sym != NULL)
7329 return sym;
7330
7331 /* Not right yet. FIXME pnh 7/20/2007. */
7332 sym = ada_find_any_type_symbol (name);
7333 if (sym != NULL && strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR") != NULL)
7334 return sym;
7335 else
7336 return NULL;
7337 }
7338
7339 static struct symbol *
7340 find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block)
7341 {
7342 const struct symbol *function_sym = block_linkage_function (block);
7343 char *rename;
7344
7345 if (function_sym != NULL)
7346 {
7347 /* If the symbol is defined inside a function, NAME is not fully
7348 qualified. This means we need to prepend the function name
7349 as well as adding the ``___XR'' suffix to build the name of
7350 the associated renaming symbol. */
7351 const char *function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (function_sym);
7352 /* Function names sometimes contain suffixes used
7353 for instance to qualify nested subprograms. When building
7354 the XR type name, we need to make sure that this suffix is
7355 not included. So do not include any suffix in the function
7356 name length below. */
7357 int function_name_len = ada_name_prefix_len (function_name);
7358 const int rename_len = function_name_len + 2 /* "__" */
7359 + strlen (name) + 6 /* "___XR\0" */ ;
7360
7361 /* Strip the suffix if necessary. */
7362 ada_remove_trailing_digits (function_name, &function_name_len);
7363 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len);
7364 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len);
7365
7366 /* Library-level functions are a special case, as GNAT adds
7367 a ``_ada_'' prefix to the function name to avoid namespace
7368 pollution. However, the renaming symbols themselves do not
7369 have this prefix, so we need to skip this prefix if present. */
7370 if (function_name_len > 5 /* "_ada_" */
7371 && strstr (function_name, "_ada_") == function_name)
7372 {
7373 function_name += 5;
7374 function_name_len -= 5;
7375 }
7376
7377 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
7378 strncpy (rename, function_name, function_name_len);
7379 xsnprintf (rename + function_name_len, rename_len - function_name_len,
7380 "__%s___XR", name);
7381 }
7382 else
7383 {
7384 const int rename_len = strlen (name) + 6;
7385
7386 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
7387 xsnprintf (rename, rename_len * sizeof (char), "%s___XR", name);
7388 }
7389
7390 return ada_find_any_type_symbol (rename);
7391 }
7392
7393 /* Because of GNAT encoding conventions, several GDB symbols may match a
7394 given type name. If the type denoted by TYPE0 is to be preferred to
7395 that of TYPE1 for purposes of type printing, return non-zero;
7396 otherwise return 0. */
7397
7398 int
7399 ada_prefer_type (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
7400 {
7401 if (type1 == NULL)
7402 return 1;
7403 else if (type0 == NULL)
7404 return 0;
7405 else if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7406 return 1;
7407 else if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7408 return 0;
7409 else if (TYPE_NAME (type1) == NULL && TYPE_NAME (type0) != NULL)
7410 return 1;
7411 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0))
7412 return 1;
7413 else if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type0)
7414 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type1))
7415 return 1;
7416 else
7417 {
7418 const char *type0_name = type_name_no_tag (type0);
7419 const char *type1_name = type_name_no_tag (type1);
7420
7421 if (type0_name != NULL && strstr (type0_name, "___XR") != NULL
7422 && (type1_name == NULL || strstr (type1_name, "___XR") == NULL))
7423 return 1;
7424 }
7425 return 0;
7426 }
7427
7428 /* The name of TYPE, which is either its TYPE_NAME, or, if that is
7429 null, its TYPE_TAG_NAME. Null if TYPE is null. */
7430
7431 const char *
7432 ada_type_name (struct type *type)
7433 {
7434 if (type == NULL)
7435 return NULL;
7436 else if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL)
7437 return TYPE_NAME (type);
7438 else
7439 return TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
7440 }
7441
7442 /* Search the list of "descriptive" types associated to TYPE for a type
7443 whose name is NAME. */
7444
7445 static struct type *
7446 find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (struct type *type, const char *name)
7447 {
7448 struct type *result;
7449
7450 if (ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p)
7451 return NULL;
7452
7453 /* If there no descriptive-type info, then there is no parallel type
7454 to be found. */
7455 if (!HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7456 return NULL;
7457
7458 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (type);
7459 while (result != NULL)
7460 {
7461 const char *result_name = ada_type_name (result);
7462
7463 if (result_name == NULL)
7464 {
7465 warning (_("unexpected null name on descriptive type"));
7466 return NULL;
7467 }
7468
7469 /* If the names match, stop. */
7470 if (strcmp (result_name, name) == 0)
7471 break;
7472
7473 /* Otherwise, look at the next item on the list, if any. */
7474 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (result))
7475 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (result);
7476 else
7477 result = NULL;
7478 }
7479
7480 /* If we didn't find a match, see whether this is a packed array. With
7481 older compilers, the descriptive type information is either absent or
7482 irrelevant when it comes to packed arrays so the above lookup fails.
7483 Fall back to using a parallel lookup by name in this case. */
7484 if (result == NULL && ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
7485 return ada_find_any_type (name);
7486
7487 return result;
7488 }
7489
7490 /* Find a parallel type to TYPE with the specified NAME, using the
7491 descriptive type taken from the debugging information, if available,
7492 and otherwise using the (slower) name-based method. */
7493
7494 static struct type *
7495 ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *type, const char *name)
7496 {
7497 struct type *result = NULL;
7498
7499 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7500 result = find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (type, name);
7501 else
7502 result = ada_find_any_type (name);
7503
7504 return result;
7505 }
7506
7507 /* Same as above, but specify the name of the parallel type by appending
7508 SUFFIX to the name of TYPE. */
7509
7510 struct type *
7511 ada_find_parallel_type (struct type *type, const char *suffix)
7512 {
7513 char *name;
7514 const char *typename = ada_type_name (type);
7515 int len;
7516
7517 if (typename == NULL)
7518 return NULL;
7519
7520 len = strlen (typename);
7521
7522 name = (char *) alloca (len + strlen (suffix) + 1);
7523
7524 strcpy (name, typename);
7525 strcpy (name + len, suffix);
7526
7527 return ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
7528 }
7529
7530 /* If TYPE is a variable-size record type, return the corresponding template
7531 type describing its fields. Otherwise, return NULL. */
7532
7533 static struct type *
7534 dynamic_template_type (struct type *type)
7535 {
7536 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7537
7538 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7539 || ada_type_name (type) == NULL)
7540 return NULL;
7541 else
7542 {
7543 int len = strlen (ada_type_name (type));
7544
7545 if (len > 6 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type) + len - 6, "___XVE") == 0)
7546 return type;
7547 else
7548 return ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE");
7549 }
7550 }
7551
7552 /* Assuming that TEMPL_TYPE is a union or struct type, returns
7553 non-zero iff field FIELD_NUM of TEMPL_TYPE has dynamic size. */
7554
7555 static int
7556 is_dynamic_field (struct type *templ_type, int field_num)
7557 {
7558 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (templ_type, field_num);
7559
7560 return name != NULL
7561 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (templ_type, field_num)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
7562 && strstr (name, "___XVL") != NULL;
7563 }
7564
7565 /* The index of the variant field of TYPE, or -1 if TYPE does not
7566 represent a variant record type. */
7567
7568 static int
7569 variant_field_index (struct type *type)
7570 {
7571 int f;
7572
7573 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
7574 return -1;
7575
7576 for (f = 0; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); f += 1)
7577 {
7578 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
7579 return f;
7580 }
7581 return -1;
7582 }
7583
7584 /* A record type with no fields. */
7585
7586 static struct type *
7587 empty_record (struct type *template)
7588 {
7589 struct type *type = alloc_type_copy (template);
7590
7591 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7592 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = 0;
7593 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = NULL;
7594 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
7595 TYPE_NAME (type) = "<empty>";
7596 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
7597 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
7598 return type;
7599 }
7600
7601 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7602 the value of type TYPE at VALADDR or ADDRESS (see comments at
7603 the beginning of this section) VAL according to GNAT conventions.
7604 DVAL0 should describe the (portion of a) record that contains any
7605 necessary discriminants. It should be NULL if value_type (VAL) is
7606 an outer-level type (i.e., as opposed to a branch of a variant.) A
7607 variant field (unless unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch
7608 of the variant.
7609
7610 If not KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS, then all fields whose position or
7611 length are not statically known are discarded. As a consequence,
7612 VALADDR, ADDRESS and DVAL0 are ignored.
7613
7614 NOTE: Limitations: For now, we assume that dynamic fields and
7615 variants occupy whole numbers of bytes. However, they need not be
7616 byte-aligned. */
7617
7618 struct type *
7619 ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (struct type *type,
7620 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7621 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0,
7622 int keep_dynamic_fields)
7623 {
7624 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
7625 struct value *dval;
7626 struct type *rtype;
7627 int nfields, bit_len;
7628 int variant_field;
7629 long off;
7630 int fld_bit_len;
7631 int f;
7632
7633 /* Compute the number of fields in this record type that are going
7634 to be processed: unless keep_dynamic_fields, this includes only
7635 fields whose position and length are static will be processed. */
7636 if (keep_dynamic_fields)
7637 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
7638 else
7639 {
7640 nfields = 0;
7641 while (nfields < TYPE_NFIELDS (type)
7642 && !ada_is_variant_part (type, nfields)
7643 && !is_dynamic_field (type, nfields))
7644 nfields++;
7645 }
7646
7647 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
7648 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7649 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
7650 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
7651 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) = (struct field *)
7652 TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7653 memset (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), 0, sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7654 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
7655 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
7656 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
7657
7658 off = 0;
7659 bit_len = 0;
7660 variant_field = -1;
7661
7662 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
7663 {
7664 off = align_value (off, field_alignment (type, f))
7665 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, f);
7666 SET_FIELD_BITPOS (TYPE_FIELD (rtype, f), off);
7667 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = 0;
7668
7669 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
7670 {
7671 variant_field = f;
7672 fld_bit_len = 0;
7673 }
7674 else if (is_dynamic_field (type, f))
7675 {
7676 const gdb_byte *field_valaddr = valaddr;
7677 CORE_ADDR field_address = address;
7678 struct type *field_type =
7679 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f));
7680
7681 if (dval0 == NULL)
7682 {
7683 /* rtype's length is computed based on the run-time
7684 value of discriminants. If the discriminants are not
7685 initialized, the type size may be completely bogus and
7686 GDB may fail to allocate a value for it. So check the
7687 size first before creating the value. */
7688 check_size (rtype);
7689 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
7690 }
7691 else
7692 dval = dval0;
7693
7694 /* If the type referenced by this field is an aligner type, we need
7695 to unwrap that aligner type, because its size might not be set.
7696 Keeping the aligner type would cause us to compute the wrong
7697 size for this field, impacting the offset of the all the fields
7698 that follow this one. */
7699 if (ada_is_aligner_type (field_type))
7700 {
7701 long field_offset = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, f);
7702
7703 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr, field_offset);
7704 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address, field_offset);
7705 field_type = ada_aligned_type (field_type);
7706 }
7707
7708 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr,
7709 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
7710 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address,
7711 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
7712
7713 /* Get the fixed type of the field. Note that, in this case,
7714 we do not want to get the real type out of the tag: if
7715 the current field is the parent part of a tagged record,
7716 we will get the tag of the object. Clearly wrong: the real
7717 type of the parent is not the real type of the child. We
7718 would end up in an infinite loop. */
7719 field_type = ada_get_base_type (field_type);
7720 field_type = ada_to_fixed_type (field_type, field_valaddr,
7721 field_address, dval, 0);
7722 /* If the field size is already larger than the maximum
7723 object size, then the record itself will necessarily
7724 be larger than the maximum object size. We need to make
7725 this check now, because the size might be so ridiculously
7726 large (due to an uninitialized variable in the inferior)
7727 that it would cause an overflow when adding it to the
7728 record size. */
7729 check_size (field_type);
7730
7731 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = field_type;
7732 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7733 /* The multiplication can potentially overflow. But because
7734 the field length has been size-checked just above, and
7735 assuming that the maximum size is a reasonable value,
7736 an overflow should not happen in practice. So rather than
7737 adding overflow recovery code to this already complex code,
7738 we just assume that it's not going to happen. */
7739 fld_bit_len =
7740 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7741 }
7742 else
7743 {
7744 /* Note: If this field's type is a typedef, it is important
7745 to preserve the typedef layer.
7746
7747 Otherwise, we might be transforming a typedef to a fat
7748 pointer (encoding a pointer to an unconstrained array),
7749 into a basic fat pointer (encoding an unconstrained
7750 array). As both types are implemented using the same
7751 structure, the typedef is the only clue which allows us
7752 to distinguish between the two options. Stripping it
7753 would prevent us from printing this field appropriately. */
7754 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
7755 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7756 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f) > 0)
7757 fld_bit_len =
7758 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f);
7759 else
7760 {
7761 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
7762
7763 /* We need to be careful of typedefs when computing
7764 the length of our field. If this is a typedef,
7765 get the length of the target type, not the length
7766 of the typedef. */
7767 if (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
7768 field_type = ada_typedef_target_type (field_type);
7769
7770 fld_bit_len =
7771 TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (field_type)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7772 }
7773 }
7774 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
7775 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
7776 off += fld_bit_len;
7777 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
7778 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7779 }
7780
7781 /* We handle the variant part, if any, at the end because of certain
7782 odd cases in which it is re-ordered so as NOT to be the last field of
7783 the record. This can happen in the presence of representation
7784 clauses. */
7785 if (variant_field >= 0)
7786 {
7787 struct type *branch_type;
7788
7789 off = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, variant_field);
7790
7791 if (dval0 == NULL)
7792 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
7793 else
7794 dval = dval0;
7795
7796 branch_type =
7797 to_fixed_variant_branch_type
7798 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
7799 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
7800 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
7801 if (branch_type == NULL)
7802 {
7803 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype); f += 1)
7804 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
7805 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
7806 }
7807 else
7808 {
7809 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
7810 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
7811 fld_bit_len =
7812 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field)) *
7813 TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7814 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
7815 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
7816 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
7817 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7818 }
7819 }
7820
7821 /* According to exp_dbug.ads, the size of TYPE for variable-size records
7822 should contain the alignment of that record, which should be a strictly
7823 positive value. If null or negative, then something is wrong, most
7824 probably in the debug info. In that case, we don't round up the size
7825 of the resulting type. If this record is not part of another structure,
7826 the current RTYPE length might be good enough for our purposes. */
7827 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) <= 0)
7828 {
7829 if (TYPE_NAME (rtype))
7830 warning (_("Invalid type size for `%s' detected: %d."),
7831 TYPE_NAME (rtype), TYPE_LENGTH (type));
7832 else
7833 warning (_("Invalid type size for <unnamed> detected: %d."),
7834 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
7835 }
7836 else
7837 {
7838 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = align_value (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype),
7839 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
7840 }
7841
7842 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7843 if (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) > varsize_limit)
7844 error (_("record type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
7845 return rtype;
7846 }
7847
7848 /* As for ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 with KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS
7849 of 1. */
7850
7851 static struct type *
7852 template_to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7853 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
7854 {
7855 return ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (type, valaddr,
7856 address, dval0, 1);
7857 }
7858
7859 /* An ordinary record type in which ___XVL-convention fields and
7860 ___XVU- and ___XVN-convention field types in TYPE0 are replaced with
7861 static approximations, containing all possible fields. Uses
7862 no runtime values. Useless for use in values, but that's OK,
7863 since the results are used only for type determinations. Works on both
7864 structs and unions. Representation note: to save space, we memorize
7865 the result of this function in the TYPE_TARGET_TYPE of the
7866 template type. */
7867
7868 static struct type *
7869 template_to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
7870 {
7871 struct type *type;
7872 int nfields;
7873 int f;
7874
7875 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) != NULL)
7876 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
7877
7878 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type0);
7879 type = type0;
7880
7881 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
7882 {
7883 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type0, f));
7884 struct type *new_type;
7885
7886 if (is_dynamic_field (type0, f))
7887 new_type = to_static_fixed_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type));
7888 else
7889 new_type = static_unwrap_type (field_type);
7890 if (type == type0 && new_type != field_type)
7891 {
7892 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type = alloc_type_copy (type0);
7893 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE (type0);
7894 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
7895 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = nfields;
7896 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = (struct field *)
7897 TYPE_ALLOC (type, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7898 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (type), TYPE_FIELDS (type0),
7899 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7900 TYPE_NAME (type) = ada_type_name (type0);
7901 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
7902 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type) = 1;
7903 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
7904 }
7905 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f) = new_type;
7906 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type0, f);
7907 }
7908 return type;
7909 }
7910
7911 /* Given an object of type TYPE whose contents are at VALADDR and
7912 whose address in memory is ADDRESS, returns a revision of TYPE,
7913 which should be a non-dynamic-sized record, in which the variant
7914 part, if any, is replaced with the appropriate branch. Looks
7915 for discriminant values in DVAL0, which can be NULL if the record
7916 contains the necessary discriminant values. */
7917
7918 static struct type *
7919 to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7920 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
7921 {
7922 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
7923 struct value *dval;
7924 struct type *rtype;
7925 struct type *branch_type;
7926 int nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
7927 int variant_field = variant_field_index (type);
7928
7929 if (variant_field == -1)
7930 return type;
7931
7932 if (dval0 == NULL)
7933 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (type, valaddr, address);
7934 else
7935 dval = dval0;
7936
7937 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
7938 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7939 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
7940 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
7941 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) =
7942 (struct field *) TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7943 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), TYPE_FIELDS (type),
7944 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7945 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
7946 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
7947 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
7948 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
7949
7950 branch_type = to_fixed_variant_branch_type
7951 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
7952 cond_offset_host (valaddr,
7953 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7954 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
7955 cond_offset_target (address,
7956 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7957 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
7958 if (branch_type == NULL)
7959 {
7960 int f;
7961
7962 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < nfields; f += 1)
7963 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
7964 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
7965 }
7966 else
7967 {
7968 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
7969 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
7970 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, variant_field) = 0;
7971 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) += TYPE_LENGTH (branch_type);
7972 }
7973 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) -= TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field));
7974
7975 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7976 return rtype;
7977 }
7978
7979 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7980 the value at (TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS) [see explanation at
7981 beginning of this section]. Any necessary discriminants' values
7982 should be in DVAL, a record value; it may be NULL if the object
7983 at ADDR itself contains any necessary discriminant values.
7984 Additionally, VALADDR and ADDRESS may also be NULL if no discriminant
7985 values from the record are needed. Except in the case that DVAL,
7986 VALADDR, and ADDRESS are all 0 or NULL, a variant field (unless
7987 unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch of the variant.
7988
7989 NOTE: the case in which DVAL and VALADDR are NULL and ADDRESS is 0
7990 is questionable and may be removed. It can arise during the
7991 processing of an unconstrained-array-of-record type where all the
7992 variant branches have exactly the same size. This is because in
7993 such cases, the compiler does not bother to use the XVS convention
7994 when encoding the record. I am currently dubious of this
7995 shortcut and suspect the compiler should be altered. FIXME. */
7996
7997 static struct type *
7998 to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7999 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
8000 {
8001 struct type *templ_type;
8002
8003 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8004 return type0;
8005
8006 templ_type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
8007
8008 if (templ_type != NULL)
8009 return template_to_fixed_record_type (templ_type, valaddr, address, dval);
8010 else if (variant_field_index (type0) >= 0)
8011 {
8012 if (dval == NULL && valaddr == NULL && address == 0)
8013 return type0;
8014 return to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (type0, valaddr, address,
8015 dval);
8016 }
8017 else
8018 {
8019 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0) = 1;
8020 return type0;
8021 }
8022
8023 }
8024
8025 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
8026 the value at (VAR_TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS), where VAR_TYPE0 is a
8027 union type. Any necessary discriminants' values should be in DVAL,
8028 a record value. That is, this routine selects the appropriate
8029 branch of the union at ADDR according to the discriminant value
8030 indicated in the union's type name. Returns VAR_TYPE0 itself if
8031 it represents a variant subject to a pragma Unchecked_Union. */
8032
8033 static struct type *
8034 to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *var_type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8035 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
8036 {
8037 int which;
8038 struct type *templ_type;
8039 struct type *var_type;
8040
8041 if (TYPE_CODE (var_type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8042 var_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (var_type0);
8043 else
8044 var_type = var_type0;
8045
8046 templ_type = ada_find_parallel_type (var_type, "___XVU");
8047
8048 if (templ_type != NULL)
8049 var_type = templ_type;
8050
8051 if (is_unchecked_variant (var_type, value_type (dval)))
8052 return var_type0;
8053 which =
8054 ada_which_variant_applies (var_type,
8055 value_type (dval), value_contents (dval));
8056
8057 if (which < 0)
8058 return empty_record (var_type);
8059 else if (is_dynamic_field (var_type, which))
8060 return to_fixed_record_type
8061 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)),
8062 valaddr, address, dval);
8063 else if (variant_field_index (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)) >= 0)
8064 return
8065 to_fixed_record_type
8066 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which), valaddr, address, dval);
8067 else
8068 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which);
8069 }
8070
8071 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is an array type describing the type of a value
8072 at ADDR, and that DVAL describes a record containing any
8073 discriminants used in TYPE0, returns a type for the value that
8074 contains no dynamic components (that is, no components whose sizes
8075 are determined by run-time quantities). Unless IGNORE_TOO_BIG is
8076 true, gives an error message if the resulting type's size is over
8077 varsize_limit. */
8078
8079 static struct type *
8080 to_fixed_array_type (struct type *type0, struct value *dval,
8081 int ignore_too_big)
8082 {
8083 struct type *index_type_desc;
8084 struct type *result;
8085 int constrained_packed_array_p;
8086
8087 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
8088 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8089 return type0;
8090
8091 constrained_packed_array_p = ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
8092 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
8093 type0 = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
8094
8095 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XA");
8096 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
8097 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
8098 {
8099 struct type *elt_type0 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0));
8100
8101 /* NOTE: elt_type---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
8102 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
8103 debugging data. */
8104 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
8105 We're not providing the address of an element here,
8106 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
8107 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
8108 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
8109 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
8110 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
8111 consult the object tag. */
8112 struct type *elt_type = ada_to_fixed_type (elt_type0, 0, 0, dval, 1);
8113
8114 /* Make sure we always create a new array type when dealing with
8115 packed array types, since we're going to fix-up the array
8116 type length and element bitsize a little further down. */
8117 if (elt_type0 == elt_type && !constrained_packed_array_p)
8118 result = type0;
8119 else
8120 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (type0),
8121 elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
8122 }
8123 else
8124 {
8125 int i;
8126 struct type *elt_type0;
8127
8128 elt_type0 = type0;
8129 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc); i > 0; i -= 1)
8130 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
8131
8132 /* NOTE: result---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
8133 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
8134 debugging data. */
8135 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
8136 We're not providing the address of an element here,
8137 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
8138 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
8139 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
8140 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
8141 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
8142 consult the object tag. */
8143 result =
8144 ada_to_fixed_type (ada_check_typedef (elt_type0), 0, 0, dval, 1);
8145
8146 elt_type0 = type0;
8147 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
8148 {
8149 struct type *range_type =
8150 to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, i), dval);
8151
8152 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (elt_type0),
8153 result, range_type);
8154 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
8155 }
8156 if (!ignore_too_big && TYPE_LENGTH (result) > varsize_limit)
8157 error (_("array type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
8158 }
8159
8160 /* We want to preserve the type name. This can be useful when
8161 trying to get the type name of a value that has already been
8162 printed (for instance, if the user did "print VAR; whatis $". */
8163 TYPE_NAME (result) = TYPE_NAME (type0);
8164
8165 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
8166 {
8167 /* So far, the resulting type has been created as if the original
8168 type was a regular (non-packed) array type. As a result, the
8169 bitsize of the array elements needs to be set again, and the array
8170 length needs to be recomputed based on that bitsize. */
8171 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (result) / TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (result));
8172 int elt_bitsize = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
8173
8174 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (result, 0) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
8175 TYPE_LENGTH (result) = len * elt_bitsize / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
8176 if (TYPE_LENGTH (result) * HOST_CHAR_BIT < len * elt_bitsize)
8177 TYPE_LENGTH (result)++;
8178 }
8179
8180 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (result) = 1;
8181 return result;
8182 }
8183
8184
8185 /* A standard type (containing no dynamically sized components)
8186 corresponding to TYPE for the value (TYPE, VALADDR, ADDRESS)
8187 DVAL describes a record containing any discriminants used in TYPE0,
8188 and may be NULL if there are none, or if the object of type TYPE at
8189 ADDRESS or in VALADDR contains these discriminants.
8190
8191 If CHECK_TAG is not null, in the case of tagged types, this function
8192 attempts to locate the object's tag and use it to compute the actual
8193 type. However, when ADDRESS is null, we cannot use it to determine the
8194 location of the tag, and therefore compute the tagged type's actual type.
8195 So we return the tagged type without consulting the tag. */
8196
8197 static struct type *
8198 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8199 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
8200 {
8201 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8202 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
8203 {
8204 default:
8205 return type;
8206 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8207 {
8208 struct type *static_type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
8209 struct type *fixed_record_type =
8210 to_fixed_record_type (type, valaddr, address, NULL);
8211
8212 /* If STATIC_TYPE is a tagged type and we know the object's address,
8213 then we can determine its tag, and compute the object's actual
8214 type from there. Note that we have to use the fixed record
8215 type (the parent part of the record may have dynamic fields
8216 and the way the location of _tag is expressed may depend on
8217 them). */
8218
8219 if (check_tag && address != 0 && ada_is_tagged_type (static_type, 0))
8220 {
8221 struct value *tag =
8222 value_tag_from_contents_and_address
8223 (fixed_record_type,
8224 valaddr,
8225 address);
8226 struct type *real_type = type_from_tag (tag);
8227 struct value *obj =
8228 value_from_contents_and_address (fixed_record_type,
8229 valaddr,
8230 address);
8231 if (real_type != NULL)
8232 return to_fixed_record_type
8233 (real_type, NULL,
8234 value_address (ada_tag_value_at_base_address (obj)), NULL);
8235 }
8236
8237 /* Check to see if there is a parallel ___XVZ variable.
8238 If there is, then it provides the actual size of our type. */
8239 else if (ada_type_name (fixed_record_type) != NULL)
8240 {
8241 const char *name = ada_type_name (fixed_record_type);
8242 char *xvz_name = alloca (strlen (name) + 7 /* "___XVZ\0" */);
8243 int xvz_found = 0;
8244 LONGEST size;
8245
8246 xsnprintf (xvz_name, strlen (name) + 7, "%s___XVZ", name);
8247 size = get_int_var_value (xvz_name, &xvz_found);
8248 if (xvz_found && TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) != size)
8249 {
8250 fixed_record_type = copy_type (fixed_record_type);
8251 TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) = size;
8252
8253 /* The FIXED_RECORD_TYPE may have be a stub. We have
8254 observed this when the debugging info is STABS, and
8255 apparently it is something that is hard to fix.
8256
8257 In practice, we don't need the actual type definition
8258 at all, because the presence of the XVZ variable allows us
8259 to assume that there must be a XVS type as well, which we
8260 should be able to use later, when we need the actual type
8261 definition.
8262
8263 In the meantime, pretend that the "fixed" type we are
8264 returning is NOT a stub, because this can cause trouble
8265 when using this type to create new types targeting it.
8266 Indeed, the associated creation routines often check
8267 whether the target type is a stub and will try to replace
8268 it, thus using a type with the wrong size. This, in turn,
8269 might cause the new type to have the wrong size too.
8270 Consider the case of an array, for instance, where the size
8271 of the array is computed from the number of elements in
8272 our array multiplied by the size of its element. */
8273 TYPE_STUB (fixed_record_type) = 0;
8274 }
8275 }
8276 return fixed_record_type;
8277 }
8278 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
8279 return to_fixed_array_type (type, dval, 1);
8280 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
8281 if (dval == NULL)
8282 return type;
8283 else
8284 return to_fixed_variant_branch_type (type, valaddr, address, dval);
8285 }
8286 }
8287
8288 /* The same as ada_to_fixed_type_1, except that it preserves the type
8289 if it is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a type that is already fixed.
8290
8291 The typedef layer needs be preserved in order to differentiate between
8292 arrays and array pointers when both types are implemented using the same
8293 fat pointer. In the array pointer case, the pointer is encoded as
8294 a typedef of the pointer type. For instance, considering:
8295
8296 type String_Access is access String;
8297 S1 : String_Access := null;
8298
8299 To the debugger, S1 is defined as a typedef of type String. But
8300 to the user, it is a pointer. So if the user tries to print S1,
8301 we should not dereference the array, but print the array address
8302 instead.
8303
8304 If we didn't preserve the typedef layer, we would lose the fact that
8305 the type is to be presented as a pointer (needs de-reference before
8306 being printed). And we would also use the source-level type name. */
8307
8308 struct type *
8309 ada_to_fixed_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8310 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
8311
8312 {
8313 struct type *fixed_type =
8314 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (type, valaddr, address, dval, check_tag);
8315
8316 /* If TYPE is a typedef and its target type is the same as the FIXED_TYPE,
8317 then preserve the typedef layer.
8318
8319 Implementation note: We can only check the main-type portion of
8320 the TYPE and FIXED_TYPE, because eliminating the typedef layer
8321 from TYPE now returns a type that has the same instance flags
8322 as TYPE. For instance, if TYPE is a "typedef const", and its
8323 target type is a "struct", then the typedef elimination will return
8324 a "const" version of the target type. See check_typedef for more
8325 details about how the typedef layer elimination is done.
8326
8327 brobecker/2010-11-19: It seems to me that the only case where it is
8328 useful to preserve the typedef layer is when dealing with fat pointers.
8329 Perhaps, we could add a check for that and preserve the typedef layer
8330 only in that situation. But this seems unecessary so far, probably
8331 because we call check_typedef/ada_check_typedef pretty much everywhere.
8332 */
8333 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
8334 && (TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (ada_typedef_target_type (type))
8335 == TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (fixed_type)))
8336 return type;
8337
8338 return fixed_type;
8339 }
8340
8341 /* A standard (static-sized) type corresponding as well as possible to
8342 TYPE0, but based on no runtime data. */
8343
8344 static struct type *
8345 to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
8346 {
8347 struct type *type;
8348
8349 if (type0 == NULL)
8350 return NULL;
8351
8352 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8353 return type0;
8354
8355 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
8356
8357 switch (TYPE_CODE (type0))
8358 {
8359 default:
8360 return type0;
8361 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8362 type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
8363 if (type != NULL)
8364 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8365 else
8366 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8367 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
8368 type = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XVU");
8369 if (type != NULL)
8370 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8371 else
8372 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8373 }
8374 }
8375
8376 /* A static approximation of TYPE with all type wrappers removed. */
8377
8378 static struct type *
8379 static_unwrap_type (struct type *type)
8380 {
8381 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8382 {
8383 struct type *type1 = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (type), 0);
8384 if (ada_type_name (type1) == NULL)
8385 TYPE_NAME (type1) = ada_type_name (type);
8386
8387 return static_unwrap_type (type1);
8388 }
8389 else
8390 {
8391 struct type *raw_real_type = ada_get_base_type (type);
8392
8393 if (raw_real_type == type)
8394 return type;
8395 else
8396 return to_static_fixed_type (raw_real_type);
8397 }
8398 }
8399
8400 /* In some cases, incomplete and private types require
8401 cross-references that are not resolved as records (for example,
8402 type Foo;
8403 type FooP is access Foo;
8404 V: FooP;
8405 type Foo is array ...;
8406 ). In these cases, since there is no mechanism for producing
8407 cross-references to such types, we instead substitute for FooP a
8408 stub enumeration type that is nowhere resolved, and whose tag is
8409 the name of the actual type. Call these types "non-record stubs". */
8410
8411 /* A type equivalent to TYPE that is not a non-record stub, if one
8412 exists, otherwise TYPE. */
8413
8414 struct type *
8415 ada_check_typedef (struct type *type)
8416 {
8417 if (type == NULL)
8418 return NULL;
8419
8420 /* If our type is a typedef type of a fat pointer, then we're done.
8421 We don't want to strip the TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF layer, because this is
8422 what allows us to distinguish between fat pointers that represent
8423 array types, and fat pointers that represent array access types
8424 (in both cases, the compiler implements them as fat pointers). */
8425 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
8426 && is_thick_pntr (ada_typedef_target_type (type)))
8427 return type;
8428
8429 CHECK_TYPEDEF (type);
8430 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
8431 || !TYPE_STUB (type)
8432 || TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) == NULL)
8433 return type;
8434 else
8435 {
8436 const char *name = TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
8437 struct type *type1 = ada_find_any_type (name);
8438
8439 if (type1 == NULL)
8440 return type;
8441
8442 /* TYPE1 might itself be a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF (this can happen with
8443 stubs pointing to arrays, as we don't create symbols for array
8444 types, only for the typedef-to-array types). If that's the case,
8445 strip the typedef layer. */
8446 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
8447 type1 = ada_check_typedef (type1);
8448
8449 return type1;
8450 }
8451 }
8452
8453 /* A value representing the data at VALADDR/ADDRESS as described by
8454 type TYPE0, but with a standard (static-sized) type that correctly
8455 describes it. If VAL0 is not NULL and TYPE0 already is a standard
8456 type, then return VAL0 [this feature is simply to avoid redundant
8457 creation of struct values]. */
8458
8459 static struct value *
8460 ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *type0, CORE_ADDR address,
8461 struct value *val0)
8462 {
8463 struct type *type = ada_to_fixed_type (type0, 0, address, NULL, 1);
8464
8465 if (type == type0 && val0 != NULL)
8466 return val0;
8467 else
8468 return value_from_contents_and_address (type, 0, address);
8469 }
8470
8471 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
8472 that correctly describes it. Does not necessarily create a new
8473 value. */
8474
8475 struct value *
8476 ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *val)
8477 {
8478 val = unwrap_value (val);
8479 val = ada_to_fixed_value_create (value_type (val),
8480 value_address (val),
8481 val);
8482 return val;
8483 }
8484 \f
8485
8486 /* Attributes */
8487
8488 /* Table mapping attribute numbers to names.
8489 NOTE: Keep up to date with enum ada_attribute definition in ada-lang.h. */
8490
8491 static const char *attribute_names[] = {
8492 "<?>",
8493
8494 "first",
8495 "last",
8496 "length",
8497 "image",
8498 "max",
8499 "min",
8500 "modulus",
8501 "pos",
8502 "size",
8503 "tag",
8504 "val",
8505 0
8506 };
8507
8508 const char *
8509 ada_attribute_name (enum exp_opcode n)
8510 {
8511 if (n >= OP_ATR_FIRST && n <= (int) OP_ATR_VAL)
8512 return attribute_names[n - OP_ATR_FIRST + 1];
8513 else
8514 return attribute_names[0];
8515 }
8516
8517 /* Evaluate the 'POS attribute applied to ARG. */
8518
8519 static LONGEST
8520 pos_atr (struct value *arg)
8521 {
8522 struct value *val = coerce_ref (arg);
8523 struct type *type = value_type (val);
8524
8525 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
8526 error (_("'POS only defined on discrete types"));
8527
8528 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
8529 {
8530 int i;
8531 LONGEST v = value_as_long (val);
8532
8533 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
8534 {
8535 if (v == TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, i))
8536 return i;
8537 }
8538 error (_("enumeration value is invalid: can't find 'POS"));
8539 }
8540 else
8541 return value_as_long (val);
8542 }
8543
8544 static struct value *
8545 value_pos_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
8546 {
8547 return value_from_longest (type, pos_atr (arg));
8548 }
8549
8550 /* Evaluate the TYPE'VAL attribute applied to ARG. */
8551
8552 static struct value *
8553 value_val_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
8554 {
8555 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
8556 error (_("'VAL only defined on discrete types"));
8557 if (!integer_type_p (value_type (arg)))
8558 error (_("'VAL requires integral argument"));
8559
8560 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
8561 {
8562 long pos = value_as_long (arg);
8563
8564 if (pos < 0 || pos >= TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
8565 error (_("argument to 'VAL out of range"));
8566 return value_from_longest (type, TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, pos));
8567 }
8568 else
8569 return value_from_longest (type, value_as_long (arg));
8570 }
8571 \f
8572
8573 /* Evaluation */
8574
8575 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada character type.
8576 [At the moment, this is true only for Character and Wide_Character;
8577 It is a heuristic test that could stand improvement]. */
8578
8579 int
8580 ada_is_character_type (struct type *type)
8581 {
8582 const char *name;
8583
8584 /* If the type code says it's a character, then assume it really is,
8585 and don't check any further. */
8586 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_CHAR)
8587 return 1;
8588
8589 /* Otherwise, assume it's a character type iff it is a discrete type
8590 with a known character type name. */
8591 name = ada_type_name (type);
8592 return (name != NULL
8593 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
8594 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
8595 && (strcmp (name, "character") == 0
8596 || strcmp (name, "wide_character") == 0
8597 || strcmp (name, "wide_wide_character") == 0
8598 || strcmp (name, "unsigned char") == 0));
8599 }
8600
8601 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada string type. */
8602
8603 int
8604 ada_is_string_type (struct type *type)
8605 {
8606 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8607 if (type != NULL
8608 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
8609 && (ada_is_simple_array_type (type)
8610 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
8611 && ada_array_arity (type) == 1)
8612 {
8613 struct type *elttype = ada_array_element_type (type, 1);
8614
8615 return ada_is_character_type (elttype);
8616 }
8617 else
8618 return 0;
8619 }
8620
8621 /* The compiler sometimes provides a parallel XVS type for a given
8622 PAD type. Normally, it is safe to follow the PAD type directly,
8623 but older versions of the compiler have a bug that causes the offset
8624 of its "F" field to be wrong. Following that field in that case
8625 would lead to incorrect results, but this can be worked around
8626 by ignoring the PAD type and using the associated XVS type instead.
8627
8628 Set to True if the debugger should trust the contents of PAD types.
8629 Otherwise, ignore the PAD type if there is a parallel XVS type. */
8630 static int trust_pad_over_xvs = 1;
8631
8632 /* True if TYPE is a struct type introduced by the compiler to force the
8633 alignment of a value. Such types have a single field with a
8634 distinctive name. */
8635
8636 int
8637 ada_is_aligner_type (struct type *type)
8638 {
8639 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8640
8641 if (!trust_pad_over_xvs && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVS") != NULL)
8642 return 0;
8643
8644 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
8645 && TYPE_NFIELDS (type) == 1
8646 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0), "F") == 0);
8647 }
8648
8649 /* If there is an ___XVS-convention type parallel to SUBTYPE, return
8650 the parallel type. */
8651
8652 struct type *
8653 ada_get_base_type (struct type *raw_type)
8654 {
8655 struct type *real_type_namer;
8656 struct type *raw_real_type;
8657
8658 if (raw_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (raw_type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
8659 return raw_type;
8660
8661 if (ada_is_aligner_type (raw_type))
8662 /* The encoding specifies that we should always use the aligner type.
8663 So, even if this aligner type has an associated XVS type, we should
8664 simply ignore it.
8665
8666 According to the compiler gurus, an XVS type parallel to an aligner
8667 type may exist because of a stabs limitation. In stabs, aligner
8668 types are empty because the field has a variable-sized type, and
8669 thus cannot actually be used as an aligner type. As a result,
8670 we need the associated parallel XVS type to decode the type.
8671 Since the policy in the compiler is to not change the internal
8672 representation based on the debugging info format, we sometimes
8673 end up having a redundant XVS type parallel to the aligner type. */
8674 return raw_type;
8675
8676 real_type_namer = ada_find_parallel_type (raw_type, "___XVS");
8677 if (real_type_namer == NULL
8678 || TYPE_CODE (real_type_namer) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
8679 || TYPE_NFIELDS (real_type_namer) != 1)
8680 return raw_type;
8681
8682 if (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0)) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
8683 {
8684 /* This is an older encoding form where the base type needs to be
8685 looked up by name. We prefer the newer enconding because it is
8686 more efficient. */
8687 raw_real_type = ada_find_any_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (real_type_namer, 0));
8688 if (raw_real_type == NULL)
8689 return raw_type;
8690 else
8691 return raw_real_type;
8692 }
8693
8694 /* The field in our XVS type is a reference to the base type. */
8695 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0));
8696 }
8697
8698 /* The type of value designated by TYPE, with all aligners removed. */
8699
8700 struct type *
8701 ada_aligned_type (struct type *type)
8702 {
8703 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8704 return ada_aligned_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
8705 else
8706 return ada_get_base_type (type);
8707 }
8708
8709
8710 /* The address of the aligned value in an object at address VALADDR
8711 having type TYPE. Assumes ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE). */
8712
8713 const gdb_byte *
8714 ada_aligned_value_addr (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr)
8715 {
8716 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8717 return ada_aligned_value_addr (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0),
8718 valaddr +
8719 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type,
8720 0) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
8721 else
8722 return valaddr;
8723 }
8724
8725
8726
8727 /* The printed representation of an enumeration literal with encoded
8728 name NAME. The value is good to the next call of ada_enum_name. */
8729 const char *
8730 ada_enum_name (const char *name)
8731 {
8732 static char *result;
8733 static size_t result_len = 0;
8734 char *tmp;
8735
8736 /* First, unqualify the enumeration name:
8737 1. Search for the last '.' character. If we find one, then skip
8738 all the preceding characters, the unqualified name starts
8739 right after that dot.
8740 2. Otherwise, we may be debugging on a target where the compiler
8741 translates dots into "__". Search forward for double underscores,
8742 but stop searching when we hit an overloading suffix, which is
8743 of the form "__" followed by digits. */
8744
8745 tmp = strrchr (name, '.');
8746 if (tmp != NULL)
8747 name = tmp + 1;
8748 else
8749 {
8750 while ((tmp = strstr (name, "__")) != NULL)
8751 {
8752 if (isdigit (tmp[2]))
8753 break;
8754 else
8755 name = tmp + 2;
8756 }
8757 }
8758
8759 if (name[0] == 'Q')
8760 {
8761 int v;
8762
8763 if (name[1] == 'U' || name[1] == 'W')
8764 {
8765 if (sscanf (name + 2, "%x", &v) != 1)
8766 return name;
8767 }
8768 else
8769 return name;
8770
8771 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 16);
8772 if (isascii (v) && isprint (v))
8773 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "'%c'", v);
8774 else if (name[1] == 'U')
8775 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%02x\"]", v);
8776 else
8777 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%04x\"]", v);
8778
8779 return result;
8780 }
8781 else
8782 {
8783 tmp = strstr (name, "__");
8784 if (tmp == NULL)
8785 tmp = strstr (name, "$");
8786 if (tmp != NULL)
8787 {
8788 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, tmp - name + 1);
8789 strncpy (result, name, tmp - name);
8790 result[tmp - name] = '\0';
8791 return result;
8792 }
8793
8794 return name;
8795 }
8796 }
8797
8798 /* Evaluate the subexpression of EXP starting at *POS as for
8799 evaluate_type, updating *POS to point just past the evaluated
8800 expression. */
8801
8802 static struct value *
8803 evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *exp, int *pos)
8804 {
8805 return evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
8806 }
8807
8808 /* If VAL is wrapped in an aligner or subtype wrapper, return the
8809 value it wraps. */
8810
8811 static struct value *
8812 unwrap_value (struct value *val)
8813 {
8814 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
8815
8816 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8817 {
8818 struct value *v = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "F", 0);
8819 struct type *val_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (v));
8820
8821 if (ada_type_name (val_type) == NULL)
8822 TYPE_NAME (val_type) = ada_type_name (type);
8823
8824 return unwrap_value (v);
8825 }
8826 else
8827 {
8828 struct type *raw_real_type =
8829 ada_check_typedef (ada_get_base_type (type));
8830
8831 /* If there is no parallel XVS or XVE type, then the value is
8832 already unwrapped. Return it without further modification. */
8833 if ((type == raw_real_type)
8834 && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE") == NULL)
8835 return val;
8836
8837 return
8838 coerce_unspec_val_to_type
8839 (val, ada_to_fixed_type (raw_real_type, 0,
8840 value_address (val),
8841 NULL, 1));
8842 }
8843 }
8844
8845 static struct value *
8846 cast_to_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
8847 {
8848 LONGEST val;
8849
8850 if (type == value_type (arg))
8851 return arg;
8852 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg)))
8853 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type,
8854 ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
8855 value_as_long (arg)));
8856 else
8857 {
8858 DOUBLEST argd = value_as_double (arg);
8859
8860 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type, argd);
8861 }
8862
8863 return value_from_longest (type, val);
8864 }
8865
8866 static struct value *
8867 cast_from_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
8868 {
8869 DOUBLEST val = ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
8870 value_as_long (arg));
8871
8872 return value_from_double (type, val);
8873 }
8874
8875 /* Given two array types T1 and T2, return nonzero iff both arrays
8876 contain the same number of elements. */
8877
8878 static int
8879 ada_same_array_size_p (struct type *t1, struct type *t2)
8880 {
8881 LONGEST lo1, hi1, lo2, hi2;
8882
8883 /* Get the array bounds in order to verify that the size of
8884 the two arrays match. */
8885 if (!get_array_bounds (t1, &lo1, &hi1)
8886 || !get_array_bounds (t2, &lo2, &hi2))
8887 error (_("unable to determine array bounds"));
8888
8889 /* To make things easier for size comparison, normalize a bit
8890 the case of empty arrays by making sure that the difference
8891 between upper bound and lower bound is always -1. */
8892 if (lo1 > hi1)
8893 hi1 = lo1 - 1;
8894 if (lo2 > hi2)
8895 hi2 = lo2 - 1;
8896
8897 return (hi1 - lo1 == hi2 - lo2);
8898 }
8899
8900 /* Assuming that VAL is an array of integrals, and TYPE represents
8901 an array with the same number of elements, but with wider integral
8902 elements, return an array "casted" to TYPE. In practice, this
8903 means that the returned array is built by casting each element
8904 of the original array into TYPE's (wider) element type. */
8905
8906 static struct value *
8907 ada_promote_array_of_integrals (struct type *type, struct value *val)
8908 {
8909 struct type *elt_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
8910 LONGEST lo, hi;
8911 struct value *res;
8912 LONGEST i;
8913
8914 /* Verify that both val and type are arrays of scalars, and
8915 that the size of val's elements is smaller than the size
8916 of type's element. */
8917 gdb_assert (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY);
8918 gdb_assert (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
8919 gdb_assert (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY);
8920 gdb_assert (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (val))));
8921 gdb_assert (TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))
8922 > TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (val))));
8923
8924 if (!get_array_bounds (type, &lo, &hi))
8925 error (_("unable to determine array bounds"));
8926
8927 res = allocate_value (type);
8928
8929 /* Promote each array element. */
8930 for (i = 0; i < hi - lo + 1; i++)
8931 {
8932 struct value *elt = value_cast (elt_type, value_subscript (val, lo + i));
8933
8934 memcpy (value_contents_writeable (res) + (i * TYPE_LENGTH (elt_type)),
8935 value_contents_all (elt), TYPE_LENGTH (elt_type));
8936 }
8937
8938 return res;
8939 }
8940
8941 /* Coerce VAL as necessary for assignment to an lval of type TYPE, and
8942 return the converted value. */
8943
8944 static struct value *
8945 coerce_for_assign (struct type *type, struct value *val)
8946 {
8947 struct type *type2 = value_type (val);
8948
8949 if (type == type2)
8950 return val;
8951
8952 type2 = ada_check_typedef (type2);
8953 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8954
8955 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
8956 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8957 {
8958 val = ada_value_ind (val);
8959 type2 = value_type (val);
8960 }
8961
8962 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8963 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8964 {
8965 if (!ada_same_array_size_p (type, type2))
8966 error (_("cannot assign arrays of different length"));
8967
8968 if (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))
8969 && is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
8970 && TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
8971 < TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
8972 {
8973 /* Allow implicit promotion of the array elements to
8974 a wider type. */
8975 return ada_promote_array_of_integrals (type, val);
8976 }
8977
8978 if (TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
8979 != TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
8980 error (_("Incompatible types in assignment"));
8981 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
8982 }
8983 return val;
8984 }
8985
8986 static struct value *
8987 ada_value_binop (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2, enum exp_opcode op)
8988 {
8989 struct value *val;
8990 struct type *type1, *type2;
8991 LONGEST v, v1, v2;
8992
8993 arg1 = coerce_ref (arg1);
8994 arg2 = coerce_ref (arg2);
8995 type1 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1)));
8996 type2 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)));
8997
8998 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) != TYPE_CODE_INT
8999 || TYPE_CODE (type2) != TYPE_CODE_INT)
9000 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9001
9002 switch (op)
9003 {
9004 case BINOP_MOD:
9005 case BINOP_DIV:
9006 case BINOP_REM:
9007 break;
9008 default:
9009 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9010 }
9011
9012 v2 = value_as_long (arg2);
9013 if (v2 == 0)
9014 error (_("second operand of %s must not be zero."), op_string (op));
9015
9016 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type1) || op == BINOP_MOD)
9017 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9018
9019 v1 = value_as_long (arg1);
9020 switch (op)
9021 {
9022 case BINOP_DIV:
9023 v = v1 / v2;
9024 if (!TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO && v1 * (v1 % v2) < 0)
9025 v += v > 0 ? -1 : 1;
9026 break;
9027 case BINOP_REM:
9028 v = v1 % v2;
9029 if (v * v1 < 0)
9030 v -= v2;
9031 break;
9032 default:
9033 /* Should not reach this point. */
9034 v = 0;
9035 }
9036
9037 val = allocate_value (type1);
9038 store_unsigned_integer (value_contents_raw (val),
9039 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)),
9040 gdbarch_byte_order (get_type_arch (type1)), v);
9041 return val;
9042 }
9043
9044 static int
9045 ada_value_equal (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2)
9046 {
9047 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg1))
9048 || ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg2)))
9049 {
9050 /* Automatically dereference any array reference before
9051 we attempt to perform the comparison. */
9052 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
9053 arg2 = ada_coerce_ref (arg2);
9054
9055 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
9056 arg2 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg2);
9057 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9058 || TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9059 error (_("Attempt to compare array with non-array"));
9060 /* FIXME: The following works only for types whose
9061 representations use all bits (no padding or undefined bits)
9062 and do not have user-defined equality. */
9063 return
9064 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg2))
9065 && memcmp (value_contents (arg1), value_contents (arg2),
9066 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1))) == 0;
9067 }
9068 return value_equal (arg1, arg2);
9069 }
9070
9071 /* Total number of component associations in the aggregate starting at
9072 index PC in EXP. Assumes that index PC is the start of an
9073 OP_AGGREGATE. */
9074
9075 static int
9076 num_component_specs (struct expression *exp, int pc)
9077 {
9078 int n, m, i;
9079
9080 m = exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
9081 pc += 3;
9082 n = 0;
9083 for (i = 0; i < m; i += 1)
9084 {
9085 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
9086 {
9087 default:
9088 n += 1;
9089 break;
9090 case OP_CHOICES:
9091 n += exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
9092 break;
9093 }
9094 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &pc, EVAL_SKIP);
9095 }
9096 return n;
9097 }
9098
9099 /* Assign the result of evaluating EXP starting at *POS to the INDEXth
9100 component of LHS (a simple array or a record), updating *POS past
9101 the expression, assuming that LHS is contained in CONTAINER. Does
9102 not modify the inferior's memory, nor does it modify LHS (unless
9103 LHS == CONTAINER). */
9104
9105 static void
9106 assign_component (struct value *container, struct value *lhs, LONGEST index,
9107 struct expression *exp, int *pos)
9108 {
9109 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
9110 struct value *elt;
9111
9112 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (lhs)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9113 {
9114 struct type *index_type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9115 struct value *index_val = value_from_longest (index_type, index);
9116
9117 elt = unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript (lhs, 1, &index_val));
9118 }
9119 else
9120 {
9121 elt = ada_index_struct_field (index, lhs, 0, value_type (lhs));
9122 elt = ada_to_fixed_value (elt);
9123 }
9124
9125 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
9126 assign_aggregate (container, elt, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
9127 else
9128 value_assign_to_component (container, elt,
9129 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9130 EVAL_NORMAL));
9131
9132 value_free_to_mark (mark);
9133 }
9134
9135 /* Assuming that LHS represents an lvalue having a record or array
9136 type, and EXP->ELTS[*POS] is an OP_AGGREGATE, evaluate an assignment
9137 of that aggregate's value to LHS, advancing *POS past the
9138 aggregate. NOSIDE is as for evaluate_subexp. CONTAINER is an
9139 lvalue containing LHS (possibly LHS itself). Does not modify
9140 the inferior's memory, nor does it modify the contents of
9141 LHS (unless == CONTAINER). Returns the modified CONTAINER. */
9142
9143 static struct value *
9144 assign_aggregate (struct value *container,
9145 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9146 int *pos, enum noside noside)
9147 {
9148 struct type *lhs_type;
9149 int n = exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst;
9150 LONGEST low_index, high_index;
9151 int num_specs;
9152 LONGEST *indices;
9153 int max_indices, num_indices;
9154 int i;
9155
9156 *pos += 3;
9157 if (noside != EVAL_NORMAL)
9158 {
9159 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
9160 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
9161 return container;
9162 }
9163
9164 container = ada_coerce_ref (container);
9165 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (container)))
9166 container = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (container);
9167 lhs = ada_coerce_ref (lhs);
9168 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (lhs))
9169 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
9170
9171 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
9172 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (lhs_type))
9173 {
9174 lhs = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (lhs);
9175 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
9176 low_index = TYPE_ARRAY_LOWER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
9177 high_index = TYPE_ARRAY_UPPER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
9178 }
9179 else if (TYPE_CODE (lhs_type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
9180 {
9181 low_index = 0;
9182 high_index = num_visible_fields (lhs_type) - 1;
9183 }
9184 else
9185 error (_("Left-hand side must be array or record."));
9186
9187 num_specs = num_component_specs (exp, *pos - 3);
9188 max_indices = 4 * num_specs + 4;
9189 indices = alloca (max_indices * sizeof (indices[0]));
9190 indices[0] = indices[1] = low_index - 1;
9191 indices[2] = indices[3] = high_index + 1;
9192 num_indices = 4;
9193
9194 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
9195 {
9196 switch (exp->elts[*pos].opcode)
9197 {
9198 case OP_CHOICES:
9199 aggregate_assign_from_choices (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9200 &num_indices, max_indices,
9201 low_index, high_index);
9202 break;
9203 case OP_POSITIONAL:
9204 aggregate_assign_positional (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9205 &num_indices, max_indices,
9206 low_index, high_index);
9207 break;
9208 case OP_OTHERS:
9209 if (i != n-1)
9210 error (_("Misplaced 'others' clause"));
9211 aggregate_assign_others (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9212 num_indices, low_index, high_index);
9213 break;
9214 default:
9215 error (_("Internal error: bad aggregate clause"));
9216 }
9217 }
9218
9219 return container;
9220 }
9221
9222 /* Assign into the component of LHS indexed by the OP_POSITIONAL
9223 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
9224 the positions are relative to lower bound LOW, where HIGH is the
9225 upper bound. Record the position in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1]
9226 updating *NUM_INDICES as needed. CONTAINER is as for
9227 assign_aggregate. */
9228 static void
9229 aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *container,
9230 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9231 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
9232 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9233 {
9234 LONGEST ind = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 1].longconst) + low;
9235
9236 if (ind - 1 == high)
9237 warning (_("Extra components in aggregate ignored."));
9238 if (ind <= high)
9239 {
9240 add_component_interval (ind, ind, indices, num_indices, max_indices);
9241 *pos += 3;
9242 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, pos);
9243 }
9244 else
9245 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9246 }
9247
9248 /* Assign into the components of LHS indexed by the OP_CHOICES
9249 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
9250 the allowable indices are LOW..HIGH. Record the indices assigned
9251 to in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1], updating *NUM_INDICES as
9252 needed. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
9253 static void
9254 aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *container,
9255 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9256 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
9257 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9258 {
9259 int j;
9260 int n_choices = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst);
9261 int choice_pos, expr_pc;
9262 int is_array = ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (lhs));
9263
9264 choice_pos = *pos += 3;
9265
9266 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
9267 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9268 expr_pc = *pos;
9269 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9270
9271 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
9272 {
9273 LONGEST lower, upper;
9274 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[choice_pos].opcode;
9275
9276 if (op == OP_DISCRETE_RANGE)
9277 {
9278 choice_pos += 1;
9279 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9280 EVAL_NORMAL));
9281 upper = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9282 EVAL_NORMAL));
9283 }
9284 else if (is_array)
9285 {
9286 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos,
9287 EVAL_NORMAL));
9288 upper = lower;
9289 }
9290 else
9291 {
9292 int ind;
9293 const char *name;
9294
9295 switch (op)
9296 {
9297 case OP_NAME:
9298 name = &exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].string;
9299 break;
9300 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
9301 name = SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].symbol);
9302 break;
9303 default:
9304 error (_("Invalid record component association."));
9305 }
9306 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9307 ind = 0;
9308 if (! find_struct_field (name, value_type (lhs), 0,
9309 NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &ind))
9310 error (_("Unknown component name: %s."), name);
9311 lower = upper = ind;
9312 }
9313
9314 if (lower <= upper && (lower < low || upper > high))
9315 error (_("Index in component association out of bounds."));
9316
9317 add_component_interval (lower, upper, indices, num_indices,
9318 max_indices);
9319 while (lower <= upper)
9320 {
9321 int pos1;
9322
9323 pos1 = expr_pc;
9324 assign_component (container, lhs, lower, exp, &pos1);
9325 lower += 1;
9326 }
9327 }
9328 }
9329
9330 /* Assign the value of the expression in the OP_OTHERS construct in
9331 EXP at *POS into the components of LHS indexed from LOW .. HIGH that
9332 have not been previously assigned. The index intervals already assigned
9333 are in INDICES[0 .. NUM_INDICES-1]. Updates *POS to after the
9334 OP_OTHERS clause. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
9335 static void
9336 aggregate_assign_others (struct value *container,
9337 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9338 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int num_indices,
9339 LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9340 {
9341 int i;
9342 int expr_pc = *pos + 1;
9343
9344 for (i = 0; i < num_indices - 2; i += 2)
9345 {
9346 LONGEST ind;
9347
9348 for (ind = indices[i + 1] + 1; ind < indices[i + 2]; ind += 1)
9349 {
9350 int localpos;
9351
9352 localpos = expr_pc;
9353 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, &localpos);
9354 }
9355 }
9356 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9357 }
9358
9359 /* Add the interval [LOW .. HIGH] to the sorted set of intervals
9360 [ INDICES[0] .. INDICES[1] ],..., [ INDICES[*SIZE-2] .. INDICES[*SIZE-1] ],
9361 modifying *SIZE as needed. It is an error if *SIZE exceeds
9362 MAX_SIZE. The resulting intervals do not overlap. */
9363 static void
9364 add_component_interval (LONGEST low, LONGEST high,
9365 LONGEST* indices, int *size, int max_size)
9366 {
9367 int i, j;
9368
9369 for (i = 0; i < *size; i += 2) {
9370 if (high >= indices[i] && low <= indices[i + 1])
9371 {
9372 int kh;
9373
9374 for (kh = i + 2; kh < *size; kh += 2)
9375 if (high < indices[kh])
9376 break;
9377 if (low < indices[i])
9378 indices[i] = low;
9379 indices[i + 1] = indices[kh - 1];
9380 if (high > indices[i + 1])
9381 indices[i + 1] = high;
9382 memcpy (indices + i + 2, indices + kh, *size - kh);
9383 *size -= kh - i - 2;
9384 return;
9385 }
9386 else if (high < indices[i])
9387 break;
9388 }
9389
9390 if (*size == max_size)
9391 error (_("Internal error: miscounted aggregate components."));
9392 *size += 2;
9393 for (j = *size-1; j >= i+2; j -= 1)
9394 indices[j] = indices[j - 2];
9395 indices[i] = low;
9396 indices[i + 1] = high;
9397 }
9398
9399 /* Perform and Ada cast of ARG2 to type TYPE if the type of ARG2
9400 is different. */
9401
9402 static struct value *
9403 ada_value_cast (struct type *type, struct value *arg2, enum noside noside)
9404 {
9405 if (type == ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)))
9406 return arg2;
9407
9408 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (type))
9409 return (cast_to_fixed (type, arg2));
9410
9411 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9412 return cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
9413
9414 return value_cast (type, arg2);
9415 }
9416
9417 /* Evaluating Ada expressions, and printing their result.
9418 ------------------------------------------------------
9419
9420 1. Introduction:
9421 ----------------
9422
9423 We usually evaluate an Ada expression in order to print its value.
9424 We also evaluate an expression in order to print its type, which
9425 happens during the EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase of the evaluation,
9426 but we'll focus mostly on the EVAL_NORMAL phase. In practice, the
9427 EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase allows us to simplify certain aspects of
9428 the evaluation compared to the EVAL_NORMAL, but is otherwise very
9429 similar.
9430
9431 Evaluating expressions is a little more complicated for Ada entities
9432 than it is for entities in languages such as C. The main reason for
9433 this is that Ada provides types whose definition might be dynamic.
9434 One example of such types is variant records. Or another example
9435 would be an array whose bounds can only be known at run time.
9436
9437 The following description is a general guide as to what should be
9438 done (and what should NOT be done) in order to evaluate an expression
9439 involving such types, and when. This does not cover how the semantic
9440 information is encoded by GNAT as this is covered separatly. For the
9441 document used as the reference for the GNAT encoding, see exp_dbug.ads
9442 in the GNAT sources.
9443
9444 Ideally, we should embed each part of this description next to its
9445 associated code. Unfortunately, the amount of code is so vast right
9446 now that it's hard to see whether the code handling a particular
9447 situation might be duplicated or not. One day, when the code is
9448 cleaned up, this guide might become redundant with the comments
9449 inserted in the code, and we might want to remove it.
9450
9451 2. ``Fixing'' an Entity, the Simple Case:
9452 -----------------------------------------
9453
9454 When evaluating Ada expressions, the tricky issue is that they may
9455 reference entities whose type contents and size are not statically
9456 known. Consider for instance a variant record:
9457
9458 type Rec (Empty : Boolean := True) is record
9459 case Empty is
9460 when True => null;
9461 when False => Value : Integer;
9462 end case;
9463 end record;
9464 Yes : Rec := (Empty => False, Value => 1);
9465 No : Rec := (empty => True);
9466
9467 The size and contents of that record depends on the value of the
9468 descriminant (Rec.Empty). At this point, neither the debugging
9469 information nor the associated type structure in GDB are able to
9470 express such dynamic types. So what the debugger does is to create
9471 "fixed" versions of the type that applies to the specific object.
9472 We also informally refer to this opperation as "fixing" an object,
9473 which means creating its associated fixed type.
9474
9475 Example: when printing the value of variable "Yes" above, its fixed
9476 type would look like this:
9477
9478 type Rec is record
9479 Empty : Boolean;
9480 Value : Integer;
9481 end record;
9482
9483 On the other hand, if we printed the value of "No", its fixed type
9484 would become:
9485
9486 type Rec is record
9487 Empty : Boolean;
9488 end record;
9489
9490 Things become a little more complicated when trying to fix an entity
9491 with a dynamic type that directly contains another dynamic type,
9492 such as an array of variant records, for instance. There are
9493 two possible cases: Arrays, and records.
9494
9495 3. ``Fixing'' Arrays:
9496 ---------------------
9497
9498 The type structure in GDB describes an array in terms of its bounds,
9499 and the type of its elements. By design, all elements in the array
9500 have the same type and we cannot represent an array of variant elements
9501 using the current type structure in GDB. When fixing an array,
9502 we cannot fix the array element, as we would potentially need one
9503 fixed type per element of the array. As a result, the best we can do
9504 when fixing an array is to produce an array whose bounds and size
9505 are correct (allowing us to read it from memory), but without having
9506 touched its element type. Fixing each element will be done later,
9507 when (if) necessary.
9508
9509 Arrays are a little simpler to handle than records, because the same
9510 amount of memory is allocated for each element of the array, even if
9511 the amount of space actually used by each element differs from element
9512 to element. Consider for instance the following array of type Rec:
9513
9514 type Rec_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Rec;
9515
9516 The actual amount of memory occupied by each element might be different
9517 from element to element, depending on the value of their discriminant.
9518 But the amount of space reserved for each element in the array remains
9519 fixed regardless. So we simply need to compute that size using
9520 the debugging information available, from which we can then determine
9521 the array size (we multiply the number of elements of the array by
9522 the size of each element).
9523
9524 The simplest case is when we have an array of a constrained element
9525 type. For instance, consider the following type declarations:
9526
9527 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Integer) is
9528 Length : Integer;
9529 Buffer : String (1 .. Max_Size);
9530 end record;
9531 type Bounded_String_Array is array (1 ..2) of Bounded_String (80);
9532
9533 In this case, the compiler describes the array as an array of
9534 variable-size elements (identified by its XVS suffix) for which
9535 the size can be read in the parallel XVZ variable.
9536
9537 In the case of an array of an unconstrained element type, the compiler
9538 wraps the array element inside a private PAD type. This type should not
9539 be shown to the user, and must be "unwrap"'ed before printing. Note
9540 that we also use the adjective "aligner" in our code to designate
9541 these wrapper types.
9542
9543 In some cases, the size allocated for each element is statically
9544 known. In that case, the PAD type already has the correct size,
9545 and the array element should remain unfixed.
9546
9547 But there are cases when this size is not statically known.
9548 For instance, assuming that "Five" is an integer variable:
9549
9550 type Dynamic is array (1 .. Five) of Integer;
9551 type Wrapper (Has_Length : Boolean := False) is record
9552 Data : Dynamic;
9553 case Has_Length is
9554 when True => Length : Integer;
9555 when False => null;
9556 end case;
9557 end record;
9558 type Wrapper_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Wrapper;
9559
9560 Hello : Wrapper_Array := (others => (Has_Length => True,
9561 Data => (others => 17),
9562 Length => 1));
9563
9564
9565 The debugging info would describe variable Hello as being an
9566 array of a PAD type. The size of that PAD type is not statically
9567 known, but can be determined using a parallel XVZ variable.
9568 In that case, a copy of the PAD type with the correct size should
9569 be used for the fixed array.
9570
9571 3. ``Fixing'' record type objects:
9572 ----------------------------------
9573
9574 Things are slightly different from arrays in the case of dynamic
9575 record types. In this case, in order to compute the associated
9576 fixed type, we need to determine the size and offset of each of
9577 its components. This, in turn, requires us to compute the fixed
9578 type of each of these components.
9579
9580 Consider for instance the example:
9581
9582 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Natural) is record
9583 Str : String (1 .. Max_Size);
9584 Length : Natural;
9585 end record;
9586 My_String : Bounded_String (Max_Size => 10);
9587
9588 In that case, the position of field "Length" depends on the size
9589 of field Str, which itself depends on the value of the Max_Size
9590 discriminant. In order to fix the type of variable My_String,
9591 we need to fix the type of field Str. Therefore, fixing a variant
9592 record requires us to fix each of its components.
9593
9594 However, if a component does not have a dynamic size, the component
9595 should not be fixed. In particular, fields that use a PAD type
9596 should not fixed. Here is an example where this might happen
9597 (assuming type Rec above):
9598
9599 type Container (Big : Boolean) is record
9600 First : Rec;
9601 After : Integer;
9602 case Big is
9603 when True => Another : Integer;
9604 when False => null;
9605 end case;
9606 end record;
9607 My_Container : Container := (Big => False,
9608 First => (Empty => True),
9609 After => 42);
9610
9611 In that example, the compiler creates a PAD type for component First,
9612 whose size is constant, and then positions the component After just
9613 right after it. The offset of component After is therefore constant
9614 in this case.
9615
9616 The debugger computes the position of each field based on an algorithm
9617 that uses, among other things, the actual position and size of the field
9618 preceding it. Let's now imagine that the user is trying to print
9619 the value of My_Container. If the type fixing was recursive, we would
9620 end up computing the offset of field After based on the size of the
9621 fixed version of field First. And since in our example First has
9622 only one actual field, the size of the fixed type is actually smaller
9623 than the amount of space allocated to that field, and thus we would
9624 compute the wrong offset of field After.
9625
9626 To make things more complicated, we need to watch out for dynamic
9627 components of variant records (identified by the ___XVL suffix in
9628 the component name). Even if the target type is a PAD type, the size
9629 of that type might not be statically known. So the PAD type needs
9630 to be unwrapped and the resulting type needs to be fixed. Otherwise,
9631 we might end up with the wrong size for our component. This can be
9632 observed with the following type declarations:
9633
9634 type Octal is new Integer range 0 .. 7;
9635 type Octal_Array is array (Positive range <>) of Octal;
9636 pragma Pack (Octal_Array);
9637
9638 type Octal_Buffer (Size : Positive) is record
9639 Buffer : Octal_Array (1 .. Size);
9640 Length : Integer;
9641 end record;
9642
9643 In that case, Buffer is a PAD type whose size is unset and needs
9644 to be computed by fixing the unwrapped type.
9645
9646 4. When to ``Fix'' un-``Fixed'' sub-elements of an entity:
9647 ----------------------------------------------------------
9648
9649 Lastly, when should the sub-elements of an entity that remained unfixed
9650 thus far, be actually fixed?
9651
9652 The answer is: Only when referencing that element. For instance
9653 when selecting one component of a record, this specific component
9654 should be fixed at that point in time. Or when printing the value
9655 of a record, each component should be fixed before its value gets
9656 printed. Similarly for arrays, the element of the array should be
9657 fixed when printing each element of the array, or when extracting
9658 one element out of that array. On the other hand, fixing should
9659 not be performed on the elements when taking a slice of an array!
9660
9661 Note that one of the side-effects of miscomputing the offset and
9662 size of each field is that we end up also miscomputing the size
9663 of the containing type. This can have adverse results when computing
9664 the value of an entity. GDB fetches the value of an entity based
9665 on the size of its type, and thus a wrong size causes GDB to fetch
9666 the wrong amount of memory. In the case where the computed size is
9667 too small, GDB fetches too little data to print the value of our
9668 entiry. Results in this case as unpredicatble, as we usually read
9669 past the buffer containing the data =:-o. */
9670
9671 /* Implement the evaluate_exp routine in the exp_descriptor structure
9672 for the Ada language. */
9673
9674 static struct value *
9675 ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp,
9676 int *pos, enum noside noside)
9677 {
9678 enum exp_opcode op;
9679 int tem;
9680 int pc;
9681 struct value *arg1 = NULL, *arg2 = NULL, *arg3;
9682 struct type *type;
9683 int nargs, oplen;
9684 struct value **argvec;
9685
9686 pc = *pos;
9687 *pos += 1;
9688 op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
9689
9690 switch (op)
9691 {
9692 default:
9693 *pos -= 1;
9694 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9695
9696 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
9697 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
9698
9699 /* If evaluating an OP_DOUBLE and an EXPECT_TYPE was provided,
9700 then we need to perform the conversion manually, because
9701 evaluate_subexp_standard doesn't do it. This conversion is
9702 necessary in Ada because the different kinds of float/fixed
9703 types in Ada have different representations.
9704
9705 Similarly, we need to perform the conversion from OP_LONG
9706 ourselves. */
9707 if ((op == OP_DOUBLE || op == OP_LONG) && expect_type != NULL)
9708 arg1 = ada_value_cast (expect_type, arg1, noside);
9709
9710 return arg1;
9711
9712 case OP_STRING:
9713 {
9714 struct value *result;
9715
9716 *pos -= 1;
9717 result = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9718 /* The result type will have code OP_STRING, bashed there from
9719 OP_ARRAY. Bash it back. */
9720 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) == TYPE_CODE_STRING)
9721 TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) = TYPE_CODE_ARRAY;
9722 return result;
9723 }
9724
9725 case UNOP_CAST:
9726 (*pos) += 2;
9727 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
9728 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
9729 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9730 goto nosideret;
9731 arg1 = ada_value_cast (type, arg1, noside);
9732 return arg1;
9733
9734 case UNOP_QUAL:
9735 (*pos) += 2;
9736 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
9737 return ada_evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
9738
9739 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
9740 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9741 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
9742 {
9743 arg1 = assign_aggregate (arg1, arg1, exp, pos, noside);
9744 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9745 return arg1;
9746 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg1);
9747 }
9748 /* Force the evaluation of the rhs ARG2 to the type of the lhs ARG1,
9749 except if the lhs of our assignment is a convenience variable.
9750 In the case of assigning to a convenience variable, the lhs
9751 should be exactly the result of the evaluation of the rhs. */
9752 type = value_type (arg1);
9753 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
9754 type = NULL;
9755 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
9756 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9757 return arg1;
9758 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
9759 arg2 = cast_to_fixed (value_type (arg1), arg2);
9760 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9761 error
9762 (_("Fixed-point values must be assigned to fixed-point variables"));
9763 else
9764 arg2 = coerce_for_assign (value_type (arg1), arg2);
9765 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg2);
9766
9767 case BINOP_ADD:
9768 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
9769 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
9770 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9771 goto nosideret;
9772 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
9773 return (value_from_longest
9774 (value_type (arg1),
9775 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
9776 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
9777 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9778 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
9779 error (_("Operands of fixed-point addition must have the same type"));
9780 /* Do the addition, and cast the result to the type of the first
9781 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
9782 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
9783 type = value_type (arg1);
9784 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
9785 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9786 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9787 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_ADD));
9788
9789 case BINOP_SUB:
9790 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
9791 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
9792 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9793 goto nosideret;
9794 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
9795 return (value_from_longest
9796 (value_type (arg1),
9797 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
9798 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
9799 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9800 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
9801 error (_("Operands of fixed-point subtraction "
9802 "must have the same type"));
9803 /* Do the substraction, and cast the result to the type of the first
9804 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
9805 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
9806 type = value_type (arg1);
9807 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
9808 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9809 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9810 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_SUB));
9811
9812 case BINOP_MUL:
9813 case BINOP_DIV:
9814 case BINOP_REM:
9815 case BINOP_MOD:
9816 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9817 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9818 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9819 goto nosideret;
9820 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9821 {
9822 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9823 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
9824 }
9825 else
9826 {
9827 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_double;
9828 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
9829 arg1 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg1);
9830 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9831 arg2 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
9832 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9833 return ada_value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9834 }
9835
9836 case BINOP_EQUAL:
9837 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
9838 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9839 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (value_type (arg1), exp, pos, noside);
9840 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9841 goto nosideret;
9842 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9843 tem = 0;
9844 else
9845 {
9846 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9847 tem = ada_value_equal (arg1, arg2);
9848 }
9849 if (op == BINOP_NOTEQUAL)
9850 tem = !tem;
9851 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9852 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) tem);
9853
9854 case UNOP_NEG:
9855 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9856 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9857 goto nosideret;
9858 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
9859 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), value_neg (arg1));
9860 else
9861 {
9862 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
9863 return value_neg (arg1);
9864 }
9865
9866 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
9867 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
9868 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
9869 {
9870 struct value *val;
9871
9872 *pos -= 1;
9873 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9874 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9875 return value_cast (type, val);
9876 }
9877
9878 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
9879 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
9880 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
9881 {
9882 struct value *val;
9883
9884 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
9885 *pos = pc;
9886 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9887
9888 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), val);
9889 }
9890
9891 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
9892 *pos -= 1;
9893
9894 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9895 {
9896 *pos += 4;
9897 goto nosideret;
9898 }
9899 else if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
9900 /* Only encountered when an unresolved symbol occurs in a
9901 context other than a function call, in which case, it is
9902 invalid. */
9903 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
9904 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
9905 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9906 {
9907 type = static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
9908 /* Check to see if this is a tagged type. We also need to handle
9909 the case where the type is a reference to a tagged type, but
9910 we have to be careful to exclude pointers to tagged types.
9911 The latter should be shown as usual (as a pointer), whereas
9912 a reference should mostly be transparent to the user. */
9913 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 0)
9914 || (TYPE_CODE(type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9915 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), 0)))
9916 {
9917 /* Tagged types are a little special in the fact that the real
9918 type is dynamic and can only be determined by inspecting the
9919 object's tag. This means that we need to get the object's
9920 value first (EVAL_NORMAL) and then extract the actual object
9921 type from its tag.
9922
9923 Note that we cannot skip the final step where we extract
9924 the object type from its tag, because the EVAL_NORMAL phase
9925 results in dynamic components being resolved into fixed ones.
9926 This can cause problems when trying to print the type
9927 description of tagged types whose parent has a dynamic size:
9928 We use the type name of the "_parent" component in order
9929 to print the name of the ancestor type in the type description.
9930 If that component had a dynamic size, the resolution into
9931 a fixed type would result in the loss of that type name,
9932 thus preventing us from printing the name of the ancestor
9933 type in the type description. */
9934 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
9935
9936 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
9937 {
9938 struct type *actual_type;
9939
9940 actual_type = type_from_tag (ada_value_tag (arg1));
9941 if (actual_type == NULL)
9942 /* If, for some reason, we were unable to determine
9943 the actual type from the tag, then use the static
9944 approximation that we just computed as a fallback.
9945 This can happen if the debugging information is
9946 incomplete, for instance. */
9947 actual_type = type;
9948 return value_zero (actual_type, not_lval);
9949 }
9950 else
9951 {
9952 /* In the case of a ref, ada_coerce_ref takes care
9953 of determining the actual type. But the evaluation
9954 should return a ref as it should be valid to ask
9955 for its address; so rebuild a ref after coerce. */
9956 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
9957 return value_ref (arg1);
9958 }
9959 }
9960
9961 *pos += 4;
9962 return value_zero
9963 (to_static_fixed_type
9964 (static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))),
9965 not_lval);
9966 }
9967 else
9968 {
9969 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9970 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
9971 }
9972
9973 case OP_FUNCALL:
9974 (*pos) += 2;
9975
9976 /* Allocate arg vector, including space for the function to be
9977 called in argvec[0] and a terminating NULL. */
9978 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
9979 argvec =
9980 (struct value **) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 2));
9981
9982 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
9983 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
9984 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
9985 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
9986 else
9987 {
9988 for (tem = 0; tem <= nargs; tem += 1)
9989 argvec[tem] = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9990 argvec[tem] = 0;
9991
9992 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9993 goto nosideret;
9994 }
9995
9996 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type
9997 (desc_base_type (value_type (argvec[0]))))
9998 argvec[0] = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]);
9999 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10000 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (value_type (argvec[0]), 0) != 0)
10001 /* This is a packed array that has already been fixed, and
10002 therefore already coerced to a simple array. Nothing further
10003 to do. */
10004 ;
10005 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_REF
10006 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10007 && VALUE_LVAL (argvec[0]) == lval_memory))
10008 argvec[0] = value_addr (argvec[0]);
10009
10010 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (argvec[0]));
10011
10012 /* Ada allows us to implicitly dereference arrays when subscripting
10013 them. So, if this is an array typedef (encoding use for array
10014 access types encoded as fat pointers), strip it now. */
10015 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
10016 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
10017
10018 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10019 {
10020 switch (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))))
10021 {
10022 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
10023 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10024 break;
10025 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
10026 break;
10027 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
10028 if (noside != EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10029 argvec[0] = ada_value_ind (argvec[0]);
10030 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10031 break;
10032 default:
10033 error (_("cannot subscript or call something of type `%s'"),
10034 ada_type_name (value_type (argvec[0])));
10035 break;
10036 }
10037 }
10038
10039 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
10040 {
10041 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
10042 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10043 {
10044 struct type *rtype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
10045
10046 if (TYPE_GNU_IFUNC (type))
10047 return allocate_value (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (rtype));
10048 return allocate_value (rtype);
10049 }
10050 return call_function_by_hand (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
10051 case TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION:
10052 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10053 /* We don't know anything about what the internal
10054 function might return, but we have to return
10055 something. */
10056 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10057 not_lval);
10058 else
10059 return call_internal_function (exp->gdbarch, exp->language_defn,
10060 argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
10061
10062 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
10063 {
10064 int arity;
10065
10066 arity = ada_array_arity (type);
10067 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10068 if (type == NULL)
10069 error (_("cannot subscript or call a record"));
10070 if (arity != nargs)
10071 error (_("wrong number of subscripts; expecting %d"), arity);
10072 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10073 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10074 return
10075 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
10076 (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1));
10077 }
10078 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
10079 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10080 {
10081 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10082 if (type == NULL)
10083 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
10084 else
10085 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10086 }
10087 return
10088 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
10089 (ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]),
10090 nargs, argvec + 1));
10091 case TYPE_CODE_PTR: /* Pointer to array */
10092 type = to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, 1);
10093 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10094 {
10095 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10096 if (type == NULL)
10097 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
10098 else
10099 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10100 }
10101 return
10102 unwrap_value (ada_value_ptr_subscript (argvec[0], type,
10103 nargs, argvec + 1));
10104
10105 default:
10106 error (_("Attempt to index or call something other than an "
10107 "array or function"));
10108 }
10109
10110 case TERNOP_SLICE:
10111 {
10112 struct value *array = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10113 struct value *low_bound_val =
10114 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10115 struct value *high_bound_val =
10116 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10117 LONGEST low_bound;
10118 LONGEST high_bound;
10119
10120 low_bound_val = coerce_ref (low_bound_val);
10121 high_bound_val = coerce_ref (high_bound_val);
10122 low_bound = pos_atr (low_bound_val);
10123 high_bound = pos_atr (high_bound_val);
10124
10125 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10126 goto nosideret;
10127
10128 /* If this is a reference to an aligner type, then remove all
10129 the aligners. */
10130 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
10131 && ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))))
10132 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)) =
10133 ada_aligned_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)));
10134
10135 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (array)))
10136 error (_("cannot slice a packed array"));
10137
10138 /* If this is a reference to an array or an array lvalue,
10139 convert to a pointer. */
10140 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
10141 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10142 && VALUE_LVAL (array) == lval_memory))
10143 array = value_addr (array);
10144
10145 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
10146 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ada_check_typedef
10147 (value_type (array))))
10148 return empty_array (ada_type_of_array (array, 0), low_bound);
10149
10150 array = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (array);
10151
10152 /* If we have more than one level of pointer indirection,
10153 dereference the value until we get only one level. */
10154 while (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
10155 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)))
10156 == TYPE_CODE_PTR))
10157 array = value_ind (array);
10158
10159 /* Make sure we really do have an array type before going further,
10160 to avoid a SEGV when trying to get the index type or the target
10161 type later down the road if the debug info generated by
10162 the compiler is incorrect or incomplete. */
10163 if (!ada_is_simple_array_type (value_type (array)))
10164 error (_("cannot take slice of non-array"));
10165
10166 if (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (value_type (array)))
10167 == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10168 {
10169 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
10170
10171 if (high_bound < low_bound || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10172 return empty_array (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), low_bound);
10173 else
10174 {
10175 struct type *arr_type0 =
10176 to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), NULL, 1);
10177
10178 return ada_value_slice_from_ptr (array, arr_type0,
10179 longest_to_int (low_bound),
10180 longest_to_int (high_bound));
10181 }
10182 }
10183 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10184 return array;
10185 else if (high_bound < low_bound)
10186 return empty_array (value_type (array), low_bound);
10187 else
10188 return ada_value_slice (array, longest_to_int (low_bound),
10189 longest_to_int (high_bound));
10190 }
10191
10192 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
10193 (*pos) += 2;
10194 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10195 type = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
10196
10197 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10198 goto nosideret;
10199
10200 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
10201 {
10202 default:
10203 lim_warning (_("Membership test incompletely implemented; "
10204 "always returns true"));
10205 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10206 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) 1);
10207
10208 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
10209 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type));
10210 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type));
10211 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10212 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10213 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10214 return
10215 value_from_longest (type,
10216 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10217 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10218 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10219 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10220 }
10221
10222 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
10223 (*pos) += 2;
10224 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10225 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10226
10227 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10228 goto nosideret;
10229
10230 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10231 {
10232 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10233 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
10234 }
10235
10236 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10237
10238 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg2), tem, "range");
10239 if (!type)
10240 type = value_type (arg1);
10241
10242 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 1));
10243 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 0));
10244
10245 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10246 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10247 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10248 return
10249 value_from_longest (type,
10250 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10251 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10252 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10253 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10254
10255 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
10256 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10257 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10258 arg3 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10259
10260 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10261 goto nosideret;
10262
10263 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10264 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10265 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10266 return
10267 value_from_longest (type,
10268 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10269 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10270 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10271 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10272
10273 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10274 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10275 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10276 {
10277 struct type *type_arg;
10278
10279 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
10280 {
10281 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10282 arg1 = NULL;
10283 type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
10284 }
10285 else
10286 {
10287 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10288 type_arg = NULL;
10289 }
10290
10291 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode != OP_LONG)
10292 error (_("Invalid operand to '%s"), ada_attribute_name (op));
10293 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 2].longconst);
10294 *pos += 4;
10295
10296 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10297 goto nosideret;
10298
10299 if (type_arg == NULL)
10300 {
10301 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
10302
10303 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arg1)))
10304 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
10305
10306 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg1), tem,
10307 ada_attribute_name (op));
10308 if (type == NULL)
10309 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10310
10311 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10312 return allocate_value (type);
10313
10314 switch (op)
10315 {
10316 default: /* Should never happen. */
10317 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
10318 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10319 return value_from_longest
10320 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 0));
10321 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10322 return value_from_longest
10323 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 1));
10324 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10325 return value_from_longest
10326 (type, ada_array_length (arg1, tem));
10327 }
10328 }
10329 else if (discrete_type_p (type_arg))
10330 {
10331 struct type *range_type;
10332 const char *name = ada_type_name (type_arg);
10333
10334 range_type = NULL;
10335 if (name != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type_arg) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
10336 range_type = to_fixed_range_type (type_arg, NULL);
10337 if (range_type == NULL)
10338 range_type = type_arg;
10339 switch (op)
10340 {
10341 default:
10342 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
10343 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10344 return value_from_longest
10345 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_low_bound (range_type));
10346 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10347 return value_from_longest
10348 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_high_bound (range_type));
10349 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10350 error (_("the 'length attribute applies only to array types"));
10351 }
10352 }
10353 else if (TYPE_CODE (type_arg) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
10354 error (_("unimplemented type attribute"));
10355 else
10356 {
10357 LONGEST low, high;
10358
10359 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg))
10360 type_arg = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg);
10361
10362 type = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem, ada_attribute_name (op));
10363 if (type == NULL)
10364 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10365
10366 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10367 return allocate_value (type);
10368
10369 switch (op)
10370 {
10371 default:
10372 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
10373 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10374 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
10375 return value_from_longest (type, low);
10376 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10377 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
10378 return value_from_longest (type, high);
10379 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10380 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
10381 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
10382 return value_from_longest (type, high - low + 1);
10383 }
10384 }
10385 }
10386
10387 case OP_ATR_TAG:
10388 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10389 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10390 goto nosideret;
10391
10392 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10393 return value_zero (ada_tag_type (arg1), not_lval);
10394
10395 return ada_value_tag (arg1);
10396
10397 case OP_ATR_MIN:
10398 case OP_ATR_MAX:
10399 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10400 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10401 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10402 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10403 goto nosideret;
10404 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10405 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
10406 else
10407 {
10408 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10409 return value_binop (arg1, arg2,
10410 op == OP_ATR_MIN ? BINOP_MIN : BINOP_MAX);
10411 }
10412
10413 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
10414 {
10415 struct type *type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
10416
10417 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10418 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10419 goto nosideret;
10420
10421 if (!ada_is_modular_type (type_arg))
10422 error (_("'modulus must be applied to modular type"));
10423
10424 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type_arg),
10425 ada_modulus (type_arg));
10426 }
10427
10428
10429 case OP_ATR_POS:
10430 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10431 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10432 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10433 goto nosideret;
10434 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10435 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10436 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
10437 else
10438 return value_pos_atr (type, arg1);
10439
10440 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
10441 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10442 type = value_type (arg1);
10443
10444 /* If the argument is a reference, then dereference its type, since
10445 the user is really asking for the size of the actual object,
10446 not the size of the pointer. */
10447 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10448 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
10449
10450 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10451 goto nosideret;
10452 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10453 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, not_lval);
10454 else
10455 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10456 TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (type));
10457
10458 case OP_ATR_VAL:
10459 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10460 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10461 type = exp->elts[pc + 2].type;
10462 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10463 goto nosideret;
10464 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10465 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
10466 else
10467 return value_val_atr (type, arg1);
10468
10469 case BINOP_EXP:
10470 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10471 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10472 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10473 goto nosideret;
10474 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10475 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
10476 else
10477 {
10478 /* For integer exponentiation operations,
10479 only promote the first argument. */
10480 if (is_integral_type (value_type (arg2)))
10481 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
10482 else
10483 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10484
10485 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
10486 }
10487
10488 case UNOP_PLUS:
10489 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10490 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10491 goto nosideret;
10492 else
10493 return arg1;
10494
10495 case UNOP_ABS:
10496 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10497 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10498 goto nosideret;
10499 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
10500 if (value_less (arg1, value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval)))
10501 return value_neg (arg1);
10502 else
10503 return arg1;
10504
10505 case UNOP_IND:
10506 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10507 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10508 goto nosideret;
10509 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
10510 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10511 {
10512 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
10513 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
10514 {
10515 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arg1, 0);
10516
10517 if (arrType == NULL)
10518 error (_("Attempt to dereference null array pointer."));
10519 return value_at_lazy (arrType, 0);
10520 }
10521 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
10522 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
10523 /* In C you can dereference an array to get the 1st elt. */
10524 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
10525 {
10526 type = to_static_fixed_type
10527 (ada_aligned_type
10528 (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))));
10529 check_size (type);
10530 return value_zero (type, lval_memory);
10531 }
10532 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
10533 {
10534 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. */
10535 if (expect_type == NULL)
10536 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10537 lval_memory);
10538 else
10539 {
10540 expect_type =
10541 to_static_fixed_type (ada_aligned_type (expect_type));
10542 return value_zero (expect_type, lval_memory);
10543 }
10544 }
10545 else
10546 error (_("Attempt to take contents of a non-pointer value."));
10547 }
10548 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); /* FIXME: What is this for?? */
10549 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
10550
10551 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
10552 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. If we were given
10553 the expect_type, then use that as the target type.
10554 Otherwise, assume that the target type is an int. */
10555 {
10556 if (expect_type != NULL)
10557 return ada_value_ind (value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (expect_type),
10558 arg1));
10559 else
10560 return value_at_lazy (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10561 (CORE_ADDR) value_as_address (arg1));
10562 }
10563
10564 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
10565 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
10566 return ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
10567 else
10568 return ada_value_ind (arg1);
10569
10570 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
10571 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10572 (*pos) += 3 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (tem + 1);
10573 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10574 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10575 goto nosideret;
10576 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10577 {
10578 struct type *type1 = value_type (arg1);
10579
10580 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type1, 1))
10581 {
10582 type = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1,
10583 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
10584 1, 1, NULL);
10585 if (type == NULL)
10586 /* In this case, we assume that the field COULD exist
10587 in some extension of the type. Return an object of
10588 "type" void, which will match any formal
10589 (see ada_type_match). */
10590 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_void,
10591 lval_memory);
10592 }
10593 else
10594 type =
10595 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 1,
10596 0, NULL);
10597
10598 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10599 }
10600 else
10601 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 0);
10602 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
10603 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
10604
10605 case OP_TYPE:
10606 /* The value is not supposed to be used. This is here to make it
10607 easier to accommodate expressions that contain types. */
10608 (*pos) += 2;
10609 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10610 goto nosideret;
10611 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10612 return allocate_value (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
10613 else
10614 error (_("Attempt to use a type name as an expression"));
10615
10616 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10617 case OP_CHOICES:
10618 case OP_OTHERS:
10619 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
10620 case OP_POSITIONAL:
10621 case OP_NAME:
10622 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
10623 switch (op)
10624 {
10625 case OP_NAME:
10626 error (_("Undefined name, ambiguous name, or renaming used in "
10627 "component association: %s."), &exp->elts[pc+2].string);
10628 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10629 error (_("Aggregates only allowed on the right of an assignment"));
10630 default:
10631 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10632 _("aggregate apparently mangled"));
10633 }
10634
10635 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
10636 *pos += oplen - 1;
10637 for (tem = 0; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
10638 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
10639 goto nosideret;
10640 }
10641
10642 nosideret:
10643 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, 1);
10644 }
10645 \f
10646
10647 /* Fixed point */
10648
10649 /* If TYPE encodes an Ada fixed-point type, return the suffix of the
10650 type name that encodes the 'small and 'delta information.
10651 Otherwise, return NULL. */
10652
10653 static const char *
10654 fixed_type_info (struct type *type)
10655 {
10656 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
10657 enum type_code code = (type == NULL) ? TYPE_CODE_UNDEF : TYPE_CODE (type);
10658
10659 if ((code == TYPE_CODE_INT || code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) && name != NULL)
10660 {
10661 const char *tail = strstr (name, "___XF_");
10662
10663 if (tail == NULL)
10664 return NULL;
10665 else
10666 return tail + 5;
10667 }
10668 else if (code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != type)
10669 return fixed_type_info (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10670 else
10671 return NULL;
10672 }
10673
10674 /* Returns non-zero iff TYPE represents an Ada fixed-point type. */
10675
10676 int
10677 ada_is_fixed_point_type (struct type *type)
10678 {
10679 return fixed_type_info (type) != NULL;
10680 }
10681
10682 /* Return non-zero iff TYPE represents a System.Address type. */
10683
10684 int
10685 ada_is_system_address_type (struct type *type)
10686 {
10687 return (TYPE_NAME (type)
10688 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (type), "system__address") == 0);
10689 }
10690
10691 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
10692 type, return its delta, or -1 if the type is malformed and the
10693 delta cannot be determined. */
10694
10695 DOUBLEST
10696 ada_delta (struct type *type)
10697 {
10698 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
10699 DOUBLEST num, den;
10700
10701 /* Strictly speaking, num and den are encoded as integer. However,
10702 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
10703 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
10704 if (sscanf (encoding, "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
10705 &num, &den) < 2)
10706 return -1.0;
10707 else
10708 return num / den;
10709 }
10710
10711 /* Assuming that ada_is_fixed_point_type (TYPE), return the scaling
10712 factor ('SMALL value) associated with the type. */
10713
10714 static DOUBLEST
10715 scaling_factor (struct type *type)
10716 {
10717 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
10718 DOUBLEST num0, den0, num1, den1;
10719 int n;
10720
10721 /* Strictly speaking, num's and den's are encoded as integer. However,
10722 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
10723 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
10724 n = sscanf (encoding,
10725 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT
10726 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
10727 &num0, &den0, &num1, &den1);
10728
10729 if (n < 2)
10730 return 1.0;
10731 else if (n == 4)
10732 return num1 / den1;
10733 else
10734 return num0 / den0;
10735 }
10736
10737
10738 /* Assuming that X is the representation of a value of fixed-point
10739 type TYPE, return its floating-point equivalent. */
10740
10741 DOUBLEST
10742 ada_fixed_to_float (struct type *type, LONGEST x)
10743 {
10744 return (DOUBLEST) x *scaling_factor (type);
10745 }
10746
10747 /* The representation of a fixed-point value of type TYPE
10748 corresponding to the value X. */
10749
10750 LONGEST
10751 ada_float_to_fixed (struct type *type, DOUBLEST x)
10752 {
10753 return (LONGEST) (x / scaling_factor (type) + 0.5);
10754 }
10755
10756 \f
10757
10758 /* Range types */
10759
10760 /* Scan STR beginning at position K for a discriminant name, and
10761 return the value of that discriminant field of DVAL in *PX. If
10762 PNEW_K is not null, put the position of the character beyond the
10763 name scanned in *PNEW_K. Return 1 if successful; return 0 and do
10764 not alter *PX and *PNEW_K if unsuccessful. */
10765
10766 static int
10767 scan_discrim_bound (char *str, int k, struct value *dval, LONGEST * px,
10768 int *pnew_k)
10769 {
10770 static char *bound_buffer = NULL;
10771 static size_t bound_buffer_len = 0;
10772 char *bound;
10773 char *pend;
10774 struct value *bound_val;
10775
10776 if (dval == NULL || str == NULL || str[k] == '\0')
10777 return 0;
10778
10779 pend = strstr (str + k, "__");
10780 if (pend == NULL)
10781 {
10782 bound = str + k;
10783 k += strlen (bound);
10784 }
10785 else
10786 {
10787 GROW_VECT (bound_buffer, bound_buffer_len, pend - (str + k) + 1);
10788 bound = bound_buffer;
10789 strncpy (bound_buffer, str + k, pend - (str + k));
10790 bound[pend - (str + k)] = '\0';
10791 k = pend - str;
10792 }
10793
10794 bound_val = ada_search_struct_field (bound, dval, 0, value_type (dval));
10795 if (bound_val == NULL)
10796 return 0;
10797
10798 *px = value_as_long (bound_val);
10799 if (pnew_k != NULL)
10800 *pnew_k = k;
10801 return 1;
10802 }
10803
10804 /* Value of variable named NAME in the current environment. If
10805 no such variable found, then if ERR_MSG is null, returns 0, and
10806 otherwise causes an error with message ERR_MSG. */
10807
10808 static struct value *
10809 get_var_value (char *name, char *err_msg)
10810 {
10811 struct ada_symbol_info *syms;
10812 int nsyms;
10813
10814 nsyms = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, get_selected_block (0), VAR_DOMAIN,
10815 &syms);
10816
10817 if (nsyms != 1)
10818 {
10819 if (err_msg == NULL)
10820 return 0;
10821 else
10822 error (("%s"), err_msg);
10823 }
10824
10825 return value_of_variable (syms[0].sym, syms[0].block);
10826 }
10827
10828 /* Value of integer variable named NAME in the current environment. If
10829 no such variable found, returns 0, and sets *FLAG to 0. If
10830 successful, sets *FLAG to 1. */
10831
10832 LONGEST
10833 get_int_var_value (char *name, int *flag)
10834 {
10835 struct value *var_val = get_var_value (name, 0);
10836
10837 if (var_val == 0)
10838 {
10839 if (flag != NULL)
10840 *flag = 0;
10841 return 0;
10842 }
10843 else
10844 {
10845 if (flag != NULL)
10846 *flag = 1;
10847 return value_as_long (var_val);
10848 }
10849 }
10850
10851
10852 /* Return a range type whose base type is that of the range type named
10853 NAME in the current environment, and whose bounds are calculated
10854 from NAME according to the GNAT range encoding conventions.
10855 Extract discriminant values, if needed, from DVAL. ORIG_TYPE is the
10856 corresponding range type from debug information; fall back to using it
10857 if symbol lookup fails. If a new type must be created, allocate it
10858 like ORIG_TYPE was. The bounds information, in general, is encoded
10859 in NAME, the base type given in the named range type. */
10860
10861 static struct type *
10862 to_fixed_range_type (struct type *raw_type, struct value *dval)
10863 {
10864 const char *name;
10865 struct type *base_type;
10866 char *subtype_info;
10867
10868 gdb_assert (raw_type != NULL);
10869 gdb_assert (TYPE_NAME (raw_type) != NULL);
10870
10871 if (TYPE_CODE (raw_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
10872 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (raw_type);
10873 else
10874 base_type = raw_type;
10875
10876 name = TYPE_NAME (raw_type);
10877 subtype_info = strstr (name, "___XD");
10878 if (subtype_info == NULL)
10879 {
10880 LONGEST L = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type);
10881 LONGEST U = ada_discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type);
10882
10883 if (L < INT_MIN || U > INT_MAX)
10884 return raw_type;
10885 else
10886 return create_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type), raw_type,
10887 ada_discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type),
10888 ada_discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type));
10889 }
10890 else
10891 {
10892 static char *name_buf = NULL;
10893 static size_t name_len = 0;
10894 int prefix_len = subtype_info - name;
10895 LONGEST L, U;
10896 struct type *type;
10897 char *bounds_str;
10898 int n;
10899
10900 GROW_VECT (name_buf, name_len, prefix_len + 5);
10901 strncpy (name_buf, name, prefix_len);
10902 name_buf[prefix_len] = '\0';
10903
10904 subtype_info += 5;
10905 bounds_str = strchr (subtype_info, '_');
10906 n = 1;
10907
10908 if (*subtype_info == 'L')
10909 {
10910 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &L, &n)
10911 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &L, &n))
10912 return raw_type;
10913 if (bounds_str[n] == '_')
10914 n += 2;
10915 else if (bounds_str[n] == '.') /* FIXME? SGI Workshop kludge. */
10916 n += 1;
10917 subtype_info += 1;
10918 }
10919 else
10920 {
10921 int ok;
10922
10923 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___L");
10924 L = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
10925 if (!ok)
10926 {
10927 lim_warning (_("Unknown lower bound, using 1."));
10928 L = 1;
10929 }
10930 }
10931
10932 if (*subtype_info == 'U')
10933 {
10934 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &U, &n)
10935 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &U, &n))
10936 return raw_type;
10937 }
10938 else
10939 {
10940 int ok;
10941
10942 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___U");
10943 U = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
10944 if (!ok)
10945 {
10946 lim_warning (_("Unknown upper bound, using %ld."), (long) L);
10947 U = L;
10948 }
10949 }
10950
10951 type = create_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type), base_type, L, U);
10952 TYPE_NAME (type) = name;
10953 return type;
10954 }
10955 }
10956
10957 /* True iff NAME is the name of a range type. */
10958
10959 int
10960 ada_is_range_type_name (const char *name)
10961 {
10962 return (name != NULL && strstr (name, "___XD"));
10963 }
10964 \f
10965
10966 /* Modular types */
10967
10968 /* True iff TYPE is an Ada modular type. */
10969
10970 int
10971 ada_is_modular_type (struct type *type)
10972 {
10973 struct type *subranged_type = get_base_type (type);
10974
10975 return (subranged_type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
10976 && TYPE_CODE (subranged_type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
10977 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (subranged_type));
10978 }
10979
10980 /* Assuming ada_is_modular_type (TYPE), the modulus of TYPE. */
10981
10982 ULONGEST
10983 ada_modulus (struct type *type)
10984 {
10985 return (ULONGEST) TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type) + 1;
10986 }
10987 \f
10988
10989 /* Ada exception catchpoint support:
10990 ---------------------------------
10991
10992 We support 3 kinds of exception catchpoints:
10993 . catchpoints on Ada exceptions
10994 . catchpoints on unhandled Ada exceptions
10995 . catchpoints on failed assertions
10996
10997 Exceptions raised during failed assertions, or unhandled exceptions
10998 could perfectly be caught with the general catchpoint on Ada exceptions.
10999 However, we can easily differentiate these two special cases, and having
11000 the option to distinguish these two cases from the rest can be useful
11001 to zero-in on certain situations.
11002
11003 Exception catchpoints are a specialized form of breakpoint,
11004 since they rely on inserting breakpoints inside known routines
11005 of the GNAT runtime. The implementation therefore uses a standard
11006 breakpoint structure of the BP_BREAKPOINT type, but with its own set
11007 of breakpoint_ops.
11008
11009 Support in the runtime for exception catchpoints have been changed
11010 a few times already, and these changes affect the implementation
11011 of these catchpoints. In order to be able to support several
11012 variants of the runtime, we use a sniffer that will determine
11013 the runtime variant used by the program being debugged. */
11014
11015 /* Ada's standard exceptions. */
11016
11017 static char *standard_exc[] = {
11018 "constraint_error",
11019 "program_error",
11020 "storage_error",
11021 "tasking_error"
11022 };
11023
11024 typedef CORE_ADDR (ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype) (void);
11025
11026 /* A structure that describes how to support exception catchpoints
11027 for a given executable. */
11028
11029 struct exception_support_info
11030 {
11031 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11032 a catchpoint on exceptions. */
11033 const char *catch_exception_sym;
11034
11035 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11036 a catchpoint on unhandled exceptions. */
11037 const char *catch_exception_unhandled_sym;
11038
11039 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11040 a catchpoint on failed assertions. */
11041 const char *catch_assert_sym;
11042
11043 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
11044 catchpoint, this function is responsible for returning the address
11045 in inferior memory where the name of that exception is stored.
11046 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
11047 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype *unhandled_exception_name_addr;
11048 };
11049
11050 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void);
11051 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void);
11052
11053 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
11054 implement exception catchpoints with the latest version of the
11055 Ada runtime (as of 2007-03-06). */
11056
11057 static const struct exception_support_info default_exception_support_info =
11058 {
11059 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
11060 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
11061 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
11062 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
11063 };
11064
11065 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
11066 implement exception catchpoints with a slightly older version
11067 of the Ada runtime. */
11068
11069 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_fallback =
11070 {
11071 "__gnat_raise_nodefer_with_msg", /* catch_exception_sym */
11072 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
11073 "system__assertions__raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
11074 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise
11075 };
11076
11077 /* Return nonzero if we can detect the exception support routines
11078 described in EINFO.
11079
11080 This function errors out if an abnormal situation is detected
11081 (for instance, if we find the exception support routines, but
11082 that support is found to be incomplete). */
11083
11084 static int
11085 ada_has_this_exception_support (const struct exception_support_info *einfo)
11086 {
11087 struct symbol *sym;
11088
11089 /* The symbol we're looking up is provided by a unit in the GNAT runtime
11090 that should be compiled with debugging information. As a result, we
11091 expect to find that symbol in the symtabs. */
11092
11093 sym = standard_lookup (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
11094 if (sym == NULL)
11095 {
11096 /* Perhaps we did not find our symbol because the Ada runtime was
11097 compiled without debugging info, or simply stripped of it.
11098 It happens on some GNU/Linux distributions for instance, where
11099 users have to install a separate debug package in order to get
11100 the runtime's debugging info. In that situation, let the user
11101 know why we cannot insert an Ada exception catchpoint.
11102
11103 Note: Just for the purpose of inserting our Ada exception
11104 catchpoint, we could rely purely on the associated minimal symbol.
11105 But we would be operating in degraded mode anyway, since we are
11106 still lacking the debugging info needed later on to extract
11107 the name of the exception being raised (this name is printed in
11108 the catchpoint message, and is also used when trying to catch
11109 a specific exception). We do not handle this case for now. */
11110 struct minimal_symbol *msym
11111 = lookup_minimal_symbol (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, NULL);
11112
11113 if (msym && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msym) != mst_solib_trampoline)
11114 error (_("Your Ada runtime appears to be missing some debugging "
11115 "information.\nCannot insert Ada exception catchpoint "
11116 "in this configuration."));
11117
11118 return 0;
11119 }
11120
11121 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
11122
11123 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
11124 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
11125 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
11126
11127 return 1;
11128 }
11129
11130 /* Inspect the Ada runtime and determine which exception info structure
11131 should be used to provide support for exception catchpoints.
11132
11133 This function will always set the per-inferior exception_info,
11134 or raise an error. */
11135
11136 static void
11137 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer (void)
11138 {
11139 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
11140
11141 /* If the exception info is already known, then no need to recompute it. */
11142 if (data->exception_info != NULL)
11143 return;
11144
11145 /* Check the latest (default) exception support info. */
11146 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&default_exception_support_info))
11147 {
11148 data->exception_info = &default_exception_support_info;
11149 return;
11150 }
11151
11152 /* Try our fallback exception suport info. */
11153 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&exception_support_info_fallback))
11154 {
11155 data->exception_info = &exception_support_info_fallback;
11156 return;
11157 }
11158
11159 /* Sometimes, it is normal for us to not be able to find the routine
11160 we are looking for. This happens when the program is linked with
11161 the shared version of the GNAT runtime, and the program has not been
11162 started yet. Inform the user of these two possible causes if
11163 applicable. */
11164
11165 if (ada_update_initial_language (language_unknown) != language_ada)
11166 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Is this an Ada main program?"));
11167
11168 /* If the symbol does not exist, then check that the program is
11169 already started, to make sure that shared libraries have been
11170 loaded. If it is not started, this may mean that the symbol is
11171 in a shared library. */
11172
11173 if (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid) == 0)
11174 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Try to start the program first."));
11175
11176 /* At this point, we know that we are debugging an Ada program and
11177 that the inferior has been started, but we still are not able to
11178 find the run-time symbols. That can mean that we are in
11179 configurable run time mode, or that a-except as been optimized
11180 out by the linker... In any case, at this point it is not worth
11181 supporting this feature. */
11182
11183 error (_("Cannot insert Ada exception catchpoints in this configuration."));
11184 }
11185
11186 /* True iff FRAME is very likely to be that of a function that is
11187 part of the runtime system. This is all very heuristic, but is
11188 intended to be used as advice as to what frames are uninteresting
11189 to most users. */
11190
11191 static int
11192 is_known_support_routine (struct frame_info *frame)
11193 {
11194 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11195 char *func_name;
11196 enum language func_lang;
11197 int i;
11198 const char *fullname;
11199
11200 /* If this code does not have any debugging information (no symtab),
11201 This cannot be any user code. */
11202
11203 find_frame_sal (frame, &sal);
11204 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
11205 return 1;
11206
11207 /* If there is a symtab, but the associated source file cannot be
11208 located, then assume this is not user code: Selecting a frame
11209 for which we cannot display the code would not be very helpful
11210 for the user. This should also take care of case such as VxWorks
11211 where the kernel has some debugging info provided for a few units. */
11212
11213 fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
11214 if (access (fullname, R_OK) != 0)
11215 return 1;
11216
11217 /* Check the unit filename againt the Ada runtime file naming.
11218 We also check the name of the objfile against the name of some
11219 known system libraries that sometimes come with debugging info
11220 too. */
11221
11222 for (i = 0; known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
11223 {
11224 re_comp (known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i]);
11225 if (re_exec (lbasename (sal.symtab->filename)))
11226 return 1;
11227 if (sal.symtab->objfile != NULL
11228 && re_exec (objfile_name (sal.symtab->objfile)))
11229 return 1;
11230 }
11231
11232 /* Check whether the function is a GNAT-generated entity. */
11233
11234 find_frame_funname (frame, &func_name, &func_lang, NULL);
11235 if (func_name == NULL)
11236 return 1;
11237
11238 for (i = 0; known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
11239 {
11240 re_comp (known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i]);
11241 if (re_exec (func_name))
11242 {
11243 xfree (func_name);
11244 return 1;
11245 }
11246 }
11247
11248 xfree (func_name);
11249 return 0;
11250 }
11251
11252 /* Find the first frame that contains debugging information and that is not
11253 part of the Ada run-time, starting from FI and moving upward. */
11254
11255 void
11256 ada_find_printable_frame (struct frame_info *fi)
11257 {
11258 for (; fi != NULL; fi = get_prev_frame (fi))
11259 {
11260 if (!is_known_support_routine (fi))
11261 {
11262 select_frame (fi);
11263 break;
11264 }
11265 }
11266
11267 }
11268
11269 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
11270 catchpoint, return the address in inferior memory where the name
11271 of the exception is stored.
11272
11273 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
11274
11275 static CORE_ADDR
11276 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void)
11277 {
11278 return parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name");
11279 }
11280
11281 /* Same as ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr, except that this function
11282 should be used when the inferior uses an older version of the runtime,
11283 where the exception name needs to be extracted from a specific frame
11284 several frames up in the callstack. */
11285
11286 static CORE_ADDR
11287 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void)
11288 {
11289 int frame_level;
11290 struct frame_info *fi;
11291 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
11292 struct cleanup *old_chain;
11293
11294 /* To determine the name of this exception, we need to select
11295 the frame corresponding to RAISE_SYM_NAME. This frame is
11296 at least 3 levels up, so we simply skip the first 3 frames
11297 without checking the name of their associated function. */
11298 fi = get_current_frame ();
11299 for (frame_level = 0; frame_level < 3; frame_level += 1)
11300 if (fi != NULL)
11301 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
11302
11303 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11304 while (fi != NULL)
11305 {
11306 char *func_name;
11307 enum language func_lang;
11308
11309 find_frame_funname (fi, &func_name, &func_lang, NULL);
11310 if (func_name != NULL)
11311 {
11312 make_cleanup (xfree, func_name);
11313
11314 if (strcmp (func_name,
11315 data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym) == 0)
11316 break; /* We found the frame we were looking for... */
11317 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
11318 }
11319 }
11320 do_cleanups (old_chain);
11321
11322 if (fi == NULL)
11323 return 0;
11324
11325 select_frame (fi);
11326 return parse_and_eval_address ("id.full_name");
11327 }
11328
11329 /* Assuming the inferior just triggered an Ada exception catchpoint
11330 (of any type), return the address in inferior memory where the name
11331 of the exception is stored, if applicable.
11332
11333 Return zero if the address could not be computed, or if not relevant. */
11334
11335 static CORE_ADDR
11336 ada_exception_name_addr_1 (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11337 struct breakpoint *b)
11338 {
11339 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
11340
11341 switch (ex)
11342 {
11343 case ada_catch_exception:
11344 return (parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name"));
11345 break;
11346
11347 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
11348 return data->exception_info->unhandled_exception_name_addr ();
11349 break;
11350
11351 case ada_catch_assert:
11352 return 0; /* Exception name is not relevant in this case. */
11353 break;
11354
11355 default:
11356 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
11357 break;
11358 }
11359
11360 return 0; /* Should never be reached. */
11361 }
11362
11363 /* Same as ada_exception_name_addr_1, except that it intercepts and contains
11364 any error that ada_exception_name_addr_1 might cause to be thrown.
11365 When an error is intercepted, a warning with the error message is printed,
11366 and zero is returned. */
11367
11368 static CORE_ADDR
11369 ada_exception_name_addr (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11370 struct breakpoint *b)
11371 {
11372 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
11373 CORE_ADDR result = 0;
11374
11375 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
11376 {
11377 result = ada_exception_name_addr_1 (ex, b);
11378 }
11379
11380 if (e.reason < 0)
11381 {
11382 warning (_("failed to get exception name: %s"), e.message);
11383 return 0;
11384 }
11385
11386 return result;
11387 }
11388
11389 static char *ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *excep_string);
11390
11391 /* Ada catchpoints.
11392
11393 In the case of catchpoints on Ada exceptions, the catchpoint will
11394 stop the target on every exception the program throws. When a user
11395 specifies the name of a specific exception, we translate this
11396 request into a condition expression (in text form), and then parse
11397 it into an expression stored in each of the catchpoint's locations.
11398 We then use this condition to check whether the exception that was
11399 raised is the one the user is interested in. If not, then the
11400 target is resumed again. We store the name of the requested
11401 exception, in order to be able to re-set the condition expression
11402 when symbols change. */
11403
11404 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint
11405 breakpoint location. It includes a "struct bp_location" as a kind
11406 of base class; users downcast to "struct bp_location *" when
11407 needed. */
11408
11409 struct ada_catchpoint_location
11410 {
11411 /* The base class. */
11412 struct bp_location base;
11413
11414 /* The condition that checks whether the exception that was raised
11415 is the specific exception the user specified on catchpoint
11416 creation. */
11417 struct expression *excep_cond_expr;
11418 };
11419
11420 /* Implement the DTOR method in the bp_location_ops structure for all
11421 Ada exception catchpoint kinds. */
11422
11423 static void
11424 ada_catchpoint_location_dtor (struct bp_location *bl)
11425 {
11426 struct ada_catchpoint_location *al = (struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
11427
11428 xfree (al->excep_cond_expr);
11429 }
11430
11431 /* The vtable to be used in Ada catchpoint locations. */
11432
11433 static const struct bp_location_ops ada_catchpoint_location_ops =
11434 {
11435 ada_catchpoint_location_dtor
11436 };
11437
11438 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint.
11439 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
11440 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. */
11441
11442 struct ada_catchpoint
11443 {
11444 /* The base class. */
11445 struct breakpoint base;
11446
11447 /* The name of the specific exception the user specified. */
11448 char *excep_string;
11449 };
11450
11451 /* Parse the exception condition string in the context of each of the
11452 catchpoint's locations, and store them for later evaluation. */
11453
11454 static void
11455 create_excep_cond_exprs (struct ada_catchpoint *c)
11456 {
11457 struct cleanup *old_chain;
11458 struct bp_location *bl;
11459 char *cond_string;
11460
11461 /* Nothing to do if there's no specific exception to catch. */
11462 if (c->excep_string == NULL)
11463 return;
11464
11465 /* Same if there are no locations... */
11466 if (c->base.loc == NULL)
11467 return;
11468
11469 /* Compute the condition expression in text form, from the specific
11470 expection we want to catch. */
11471 cond_string = ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (c->excep_string);
11472 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
11473
11474 /* Iterate over all the catchpoint's locations, and parse an
11475 expression for each. */
11476 for (bl = c->base.loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
11477 {
11478 struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
11479 = (struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
11480 struct expression *exp = NULL;
11481
11482 if (!bl->shlib_disabled)
11483 {
11484 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
11485 const char *s;
11486
11487 s = cond_string;
11488 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
11489 {
11490 exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, bl->address,
11491 block_for_pc (bl->address), 0);
11492 }
11493 if (e.reason < 0)
11494 {
11495 warning (_("failed to reevaluate internal exception condition "
11496 "for catchpoint %d: %s"),
11497 c->base.number, e.message);
11498 /* There is a bug in GCC on sparc-solaris when building with
11499 optimization which causes EXP to change unexpectedly
11500 (http://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=56982).
11501 The problem should be fixed starting with GCC 4.9.
11502 In the meantime, work around it by forcing EXP back
11503 to NULL. */
11504 exp = NULL;
11505 }
11506 }
11507
11508 ada_loc->excep_cond_expr = exp;
11509 }
11510
11511 do_cleanups (old_chain);
11512 }
11513
11514 /* Implement the DTOR method in the breakpoint_ops structure for all
11515 exception catchpoint kinds. */
11516
11517 static void
11518 dtor_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b)
11519 {
11520 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11521
11522 xfree (c->excep_string);
11523
11524 bkpt_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
11525 }
11526
11527 /* Implement the ALLOCATE_LOCATION method in the breakpoint_ops
11528 structure for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11529
11530 static struct bp_location *
11531 allocate_location_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11532 struct breakpoint *self)
11533 {
11534 struct ada_catchpoint_location *loc;
11535
11536 loc = XNEW (struct ada_catchpoint_location);
11537 init_bp_location (&loc->base, &ada_catchpoint_location_ops, self);
11538 loc->excep_cond_expr = NULL;
11539 return &loc->base;
11540 }
11541
11542 /* Implement the RE_SET method in the breakpoint_ops structure for all
11543 exception catchpoint kinds. */
11544
11545 static void
11546 re_set_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b)
11547 {
11548 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11549
11550 /* Call the base class's method. This updates the catchpoint's
11551 locations. */
11552 bkpt_breakpoint_ops.re_set (b);
11553
11554 /* Reparse the exception conditional expressions. One for each
11555 location. */
11556 create_excep_cond_exprs (c);
11557 }
11558
11559 /* Returns true if we should stop for this breakpoint hit. If the
11560 user specified a specific exception, we only want to cause a stop
11561 if the program thrown that exception. */
11562
11563 static int
11564 should_stop_exception (const struct bp_location *bl)
11565 {
11566 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
11567 const struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
11568 = (const struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
11569 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
11570 int stop;
11571
11572 /* With no specific exception, should always stop. */
11573 if (c->excep_string == NULL)
11574 return 1;
11575
11576 if (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr == NULL)
11577 {
11578 /* We will have a NULL expression if back when we were creating
11579 the expressions, this location's had failed to parse. */
11580 return 1;
11581 }
11582
11583 stop = 1;
11584 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
11585 {
11586 struct value *mark;
11587
11588 mark = value_mark ();
11589 stop = value_true (evaluate_expression (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr));
11590 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11591 }
11592 if (ex.reason < 0)
11593 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
11594 _("Error in testing exception condition:\n"));
11595 return stop;
11596 }
11597
11598 /* Implement the CHECK_STATUS method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11599 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11600
11601 static void
11602 check_status_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, bpstat bs)
11603 {
11604 bs->stop = should_stop_exception (bs->bp_location_at);
11605 }
11606
11607 /* Implement the PRINT_IT method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11608 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11609
11610 static enum print_stop_action
11611 print_it_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, bpstat bs)
11612 {
11613 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11614 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
11615
11616 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
11617
11618 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11619 {
11620 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
11621 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
11622 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
11623 }
11624
11625 ui_out_text (uiout,
11626 b->disposition == disp_del ? "\nTemporary catchpoint "
11627 : "\nCatchpoint ");
11628 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
11629 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
11630
11631 switch (ex)
11632 {
11633 case ada_catch_exception:
11634 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
11635 {
11636 const CORE_ADDR addr = ada_exception_name_addr (ex, b);
11637 char exception_name[256];
11638
11639 if (addr != 0)
11640 {
11641 read_memory (addr, (gdb_byte *) exception_name,
11642 sizeof (exception_name) - 1);
11643 exception_name [sizeof (exception_name) - 1] = '\0';
11644 }
11645 else
11646 {
11647 /* For some reason, we were unable to read the exception
11648 name. This could happen if the Runtime was compiled
11649 without debugging info, for instance. In that case,
11650 just replace the exception name by the generic string
11651 "exception" - it will read as "an exception" in the
11652 notification we are about to print. */
11653 memcpy (exception_name, "exception", sizeof ("exception"));
11654 }
11655 /* In the case of unhandled exception breakpoints, we print
11656 the exception name as "unhandled EXCEPTION_NAME", to make
11657 it clearer to the user which kind of catchpoint just got
11658 hit. We used ui_out_text to make sure that this extra
11659 info does not pollute the exception name in the MI case. */
11660 if (ex == ada_catch_exception_unhandled)
11661 ui_out_text (uiout, "unhandled ");
11662 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exception-name", exception_name);
11663 }
11664 break;
11665 case ada_catch_assert:
11666 /* In this case, the name of the exception is not really
11667 important. Just print "failed assertion" to make it clearer
11668 that his program just hit an assertion-failure catchpoint.
11669 We used ui_out_text because this info does not belong in
11670 the MI output. */
11671 ui_out_text (uiout, "failed assertion");
11672 break;
11673 }
11674 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
11675 ada_find_printable_frame (get_current_frame ());
11676
11677 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
11678 }
11679
11680 /* Implement the PRINT_ONE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11681 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11682
11683 static void
11684 print_one_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11685 struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
11686 {
11687 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11688 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11689 struct value_print_options opts;
11690
11691 get_user_print_options (&opts);
11692 if (opts.addressprint)
11693 {
11694 annotate_field (4);
11695 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr", b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
11696 }
11697
11698 annotate_field (5);
11699 *last_loc = b->loc;
11700 switch (ex)
11701 {
11702 case ada_catch_exception:
11703 if (c->excep_string != NULL)
11704 {
11705 char *msg = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), c->excep_string);
11706
11707 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
11708 xfree (msg);
11709 }
11710 else
11711 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "all Ada exceptions");
11712
11713 break;
11714
11715 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
11716 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "unhandled Ada exceptions");
11717 break;
11718
11719 case ada_catch_assert:
11720 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "failed Ada assertions");
11721 break;
11722
11723 default:
11724 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
11725 break;
11726 }
11727 }
11728
11729 /* Implement the PRINT_MENTION method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11730 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11731
11732 static void
11733 print_mention_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11734 struct breakpoint *b)
11735 {
11736 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11737 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11738
11739 ui_out_text (uiout, b->disposition == disp_del ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
11740 : _("Catchpoint "));
11741 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
11742 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
11743
11744 switch (ex)
11745 {
11746 case ada_catch_exception:
11747 if (c->excep_string != NULL)
11748 {
11749 char *info = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), c->excep_string);
11750 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, info);
11751
11752 ui_out_text (uiout, info);
11753 do_cleanups (old_chain);
11754 }
11755 else
11756 ui_out_text (uiout, _("all Ada exceptions"));
11757 break;
11758
11759 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
11760 ui_out_text (uiout, _("unhandled Ada exceptions"));
11761 break;
11762
11763 case ada_catch_assert:
11764 ui_out_text (uiout, _("failed Ada assertions"));
11765 break;
11766
11767 default:
11768 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
11769 break;
11770 }
11771 }
11772
11773 /* Implement the PRINT_RECREATE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11774 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11775
11776 static void
11777 print_recreate_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11778 struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11779 {
11780 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11781
11782 switch (ex)
11783 {
11784 case ada_catch_exception:
11785 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception");
11786 if (c->excep_string != NULL)
11787 fprintf_filtered (fp, " %s", c->excep_string);
11788 break;
11789
11790 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
11791 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception unhandled");
11792 break;
11793
11794 case ada_catch_assert:
11795 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch assert");
11796 break;
11797
11798 default:
11799 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
11800 }
11801 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
11802 }
11803
11804 /* Virtual table for "catch exception" breakpoints. */
11805
11806 static void
11807 dtor_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
11808 {
11809 dtor_exception (ada_catch_exception, b);
11810 }
11811
11812 static struct bp_location *
11813 allocate_location_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *self)
11814 {
11815 return allocate_location_exception (ada_catch_exception, self);
11816 }
11817
11818 static void
11819 re_set_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
11820 {
11821 re_set_exception (ada_catch_exception, b);
11822 }
11823
11824 static void
11825 check_status_catch_exception (bpstat bs)
11826 {
11827 check_status_exception (ada_catch_exception, bs);
11828 }
11829
11830 static enum print_stop_action
11831 print_it_catch_exception (bpstat bs)
11832 {
11833 return print_it_exception (ada_catch_exception, bs);
11834 }
11835
11836 static void
11837 print_one_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
11838 {
11839 print_one_exception (ada_catch_exception, b, last_loc);
11840 }
11841
11842 static void
11843 print_mention_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
11844 {
11845 print_mention_exception (ada_catch_exception, b);
11846 }
11847
11848 static void
11849 print_recreate_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11850 {
11851 print_recreate_exception (ada_catch_exception, b, fp);
11852 }
11853
11854 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
11855
11856 /* Virtual table for "catch exception unhandled" breakpoints. */
11857
11858 static void
11859 dtor_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
11860 {
11861 dtor_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
11862 }
11863
11864 static struct bp_location *
11865 allocate_location_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *self)
11866 {
11867 return allocate_location_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, self);
11868 }
11869
11870 static void
11871 re_set_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
11872 {
11873 re_set_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
11874 }
11875
11876 static void
11877 check_status_catch_exception_unhandled (bpstat bs)
11878 {
11879 check_status_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, bs);
11880 }
11881
11882 static enum print_stop_action
11883 print_it_catch_exception_unhandled (bpstat bs)
11884 {
11885 return print_it_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, bs);
11886 }
11887
11888 static void
11889 print_one_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b,
11890 struct bp_location **last_loc)
11891 {
11892 print_one_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b, last_loc);
11893 }
11894
11895 static void
11896 print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
11897 {
11898 print_mention_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
11899 }
11900
11901 static void
11902 print_recreate_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b,
11903 struct ui_file *fp)
11904 {
11905 print_recreate_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b, fp);
11906 }
11907
11908 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
11909
11910 /* Virtual table for "catch assert" breakpoints. */
11911
11912 static void
11913 dtor_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
11914 {
11915 dtor_exception (ada_catch_assert, b);
11916 }
11917
11918 static struct bp_location *
11919 allocate_location_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *self)
11920 {
11921 return allocate_location_exception (ada_catch_assert, self);
11922 }
11923
11924 static void
11925 re_set_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
11926 {
11927 re_set_exception (ada_catch_assert, b);
11928 }
11929
11930 static void
11931 check_status_catch_assert (bpstat bs)
11932 {
11933 check_status_exception (ada_catch_assert, bs);
11934 }
11935
11936 static enum print_stop_action
11937 print_it_catch_assert (bpstat bs)
11938 {
11939 return print_it_exception (ada_catch_assert, bs);
11940 }
11941
11942 static void
11943 print_one_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
11944 {
11945 print_one_exception (ada_catch_assert, b, last_loc);
11946 }
11947
11948 static void
11949 print_mention_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
11950 {
11951 print_mention_exception (ada_catch_assert, b);
11952 }
11953
11954 static void
11955 print_recreate_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11956 {
11957 print_recreate_exception (ada_catch_assert, b, fp);
11958 }
11959
11960 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
11961
11962 /* Return a newly allocated copy of the first space-separated token
11963 in ARGSP, and then adjust ARGSP to point immediately after that
11964 token.
11965
11966 Return NULL if ARGPS does not contain any more tokens. */
11967
11968 static char *
11969 ada_get_next_arg (char **argsp)
11970 {
11971 char *args = *argsp;
11972 char *end;
11973 char *result;
11974
11975 args = skip_spaces (args);
11976 if (args[0] == '\0')
11977 return NULL; /* No more arguments. */
11978
11979 /* Find the end of the current argument. */
11980
11981 end = skip_to_space (args);
11982
11983 /* Adjust ARGSP to point to the start of the next argument. */
11984
11985 *argsp = end;
11986
11987 /* Make a copy of the current argument and return it. */
11988
11989 result = xmalloc (end - args + 1);
11990 strncpy (result, args, end - args);
11991 result[end - args] = '\0';
11992
11993 return result;
11994 }
11995
11996 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch exception" command.
11997 Set EX to the appropriate catchpoint type.
11998 Set EXCEP_STRING to the name of the specific exception if
11999 specified by the user.
12000 If a condition is found at the end of the arguments, the condition
12001 expression is stored in COND_STRING (memory must be deallocated
12002 after use). Otherwise COND_STRING is set to NULL. */
12003
12004 static void
12005 catch_ada_exception_command_split (char *args,
12006 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind *ex,
12007 char **excep_string,
12008 char **cond_string)
12009 {
12010 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
12011 char *exception_name;
12012 char *cond = NULL;
12013
12014 exception_name = ada_get_next_arg (&args);
12015 if (exception_name != NULL && strcmp (exception_name, "if") == 0)
12016 {
12017 /* This is not an exception name; this is the start of a condition
12018 expression for a catchpoint on all exceptions. So, "un-get"
12019 this token, and set exception_name to NULL. */
12020 xfree (exception_name);
12021 exception_name = NULL;
12022 args -= 2;
12023 }
12024 make_cleanup (xfree, exception_name);
12025
12026 /* Check to see if we have a condition. */
12027
12028 args = skip_spaces (args);
12029 if (strncmp (args, "if", 2) == 0
12030 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0'))
12031 {
12032 args += 2;
12033 args = skip_spaces (args);
12034
12035 if (args[0] == '\0')
12036 error (_("Condition missing after `if' keyword"));
12037 cond = xstrdup (args);
12038 make_cleanup (xfree, cond);
12039
12040 args += strlen (args);
12041 }
12042
12043 /* Check that we do not have any more arguments. Anything else
12044 is unexpected. */
12045
12046 if (args[0] != '\0')
12047 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
12048
12049 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
12050
12051 if (exception_name == NULL)
12052 {
12053 /* Catch all exceptions. */
12054 *ex = ada_catch_exception;
12055 *excep_string = NULL;
12056 }
12057 else if (strcmp (exception_name, "unhandled") == 0)
12058 {
12059 /* Catch unhandled exceptions. */
12060 *ex = ada_catch_exception_unhandled;
12061 *excep_string = NULL;
12062 }
12063 else
12064 {
12065 /* Catch a specific exception. */
12066 *ex = ada_catch_exception;
12067 *excep_string = exception_name;
12068 }
12069 *cond_string = cond;
12070 }
12071
12072 /* Return the name of the symbol on which we should break in order to
12073 implement a catchpoint of the EX kind. */
12074
12075 static const char *
12076 ada_exception_sym_name (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12077 {
12078 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
12079
12080 gdb_assert (data->exception_info != NULL);
12081
12082 switch (ex)
12083 {
12084 case ada_catch_exception:
12085 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym);
12086 break;
12087 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12088 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_unhandled_sym);
12089 break;
12090 case ada_catch_assert:
12091 return (data->exception_info->catch_assert_sym);
12092 break;
12093 default:
12094 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12095 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
12096 }
12097 }
12098
12099 /* Return the breakpoint ops "virtual table" used for catchpoints
12100 of the EX kind. */
12101
12102 static const struct breakpoint_ops *
12103 ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12104 {
12105 switch (ex)
12106 {
12107 case ada_catch_exception:
12108 return (&catch_exception_breakpoint_ops);
12109 break;
12110 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12111 return (&catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops);
12112 break;
12113 case ada_catch_assert:
12114 return (&catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
12115 break;
12116 default:
12117 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12118 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
12119 }
12120 }
12121
12122 /* Return the condition that will be used to match the current exception
12123 being raised with the exception that the user wants to catch. This
12124 assumes that this condition is used when the inferior just triggered
12125 an exception catchpoint.
12126
12127 The string returned is a newly allocated string that needs to be
12128 deallocated later. */
12129
12130 static char *
12131 ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *excep_string)
12132 {
12133 int i;
12134
12135 /* The standard exceptions are a special case. They are defined in
12136 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info; if
12137 EXCEP_STRING is the not-fully-qualified name of a standard
12138 exception (e.g. "constraint_error") then, during the evaluation
12139 of the condition expression, the symbol lookup on this name would
12140 *not* return this standard exception. The catchpoint condition
12141 may then be set only on user-defined exceptions which have the
12142 same not-fully-qualified name (e.g. my_package.constraint_error).
12143
12144 To avoid this unexcepted behavior, these standard exceptions are
12145 systematically prefixed by "standard". This means that "catch
12146 exception constraint_error" is rewritten into "catch exception
12147 standard.constraint_error".
12148
12149 If an exception named contraint_error is defined in another package of
12150 the inferior program, then the only way to specify this exception as a
12151 breakpoint condition is to use its fully-qualified named:
12152 e.g. my_package.constraint_error. */
12153
12154 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (standard_exc) / sizeof (char *); i++)
12155 {
12156 if (strcmp (standard_exc [i], excep_string) == 0)
12157 {
12158 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&standard.%s)",
12159 excep_string);
12160 }
12161 }
12162 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&%s)", excep_string);
12163 }
12164
12165 /* Return the symtab_and_line that should be used to insert an exception
12166 catchpoint of the TYPE kind.
12167
12168 EXCEP_STRING should contain the name of a specific exception that
12169 the catchpoint should catch, or NULL otherwise.
12170
12171 ADDR_STRING returns the name of the function where the real
12172 breakpoint that implements the catchpoints is set, depending on the
12173 type of catchpoint we need to create. */
12174
12175 static struct symtab_and_line
12176 ada_exception_sal (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, char *excep_string,
12177 char **addr_string, const struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
12178 {
12179 const char *sym_name;
12180 struct symbol *sym;
12181
12182 /* First, find out which exception support info to use. */
12183 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer ();
12184
12185 /* Then lookup the function on which we will break in order to catch
12186 the Ada exceptions requested by the user. */
12187 sym_name = ada_exception_sym_name (ex);
12188 sym = standard_lookup (sym_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
12189
12190 /* We can assume that SYM is not NULL at this stage. If the symbol
12191 did not exist, ada_exception_support_info_sniffer would have
12192 raised an exception.
12193
12194 Also, ada_exception_support_info_sniffer should have already
12195 verified that SYM is a function symbol. */
12196 gdb_assert (sym != NULL);
12197 gdb_assert (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_BLOCK);
12198
12199 /* Set ADDR_STRING. */
12200 *addr_string = xstrdup (sym_name);
12201
12202 /* Set OPS. */
12203 *ops = ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (ex);
12204
12205 return find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
12206 }
12207
12208 /* Create an Ada exception catchpoint.
12209
12210 EX_KIND is the kind of exception catchpoint to be created.
12211
12212 If EXCEPT_STRING is NULL, this catchpoint is expected to trigger
12213 for all exceptions. Otherwise, EXCEPT_STRING indicates the name
12214 of the exception to which this catchpoint applies. When not NULL,
12215 the string must be allocated on the heap, and its deallocation
12216 is no longer the responsibility of the caller.
12217
12218 COND_STRING, if not NULL, is the catchpoint condition. This string
12219 must be allocated on the heap, and its deallocation is no longer
12220 the responsibility of the caller.
12221
12222 TEMPFLAG, if nonzero, means that the underlying breakpoint
12223 should be temporary.
12224
12225 FROM_TTY is the usual argument passed to all commands implementations. */
12226
12227 void
12228 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12229 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind,
12230 char *excep_string,
12231 char *cond_string,
12232 int tempflag,
12233 int disabled,
12234 int from_tty)
12235 {
12236 struct ada_catchpoint *c;
12237 char *addr_string = NULL;
12238 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
12239 struct symtab_and_line sal
12240 = ada_exception_sal (ex_kind, excep_string, &addr_string, &ops);
12241
12242 c = XNEW (struct ada_catchpoint);
12243 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, sal, addr_string,
12244 ops, tempflag, disabled, from_tty);
12245 c->excep_string = excep_string;
12246 create_excep_cond_exprs (c);
12247 if (cond_string != NULL)
12248 set_breakpoint_condition (&c->base, cond_string, from_tty);
12249 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
12250 }
12251
12252 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
12253
12254 static void
12255 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
12256 struct cmd_list_element *command)
12257 {
12258 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
12259 int tempflag;
12260 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind;
12261 char *excep_string = NULL;
12262 char *cond_string = NULL;
12263
12264 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
12265
12266 if (!arg)
12267 arg = "";
12268 catch_ada_exception_command_split (arg, &ex_kind, &excep_string,
12269 &cond_string);
12270 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ex_kind,
12271 excep_string, cond_string,
12272 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */,
12273 from_tty);
12274 }
12275
12276 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch assert" command.
12277
12278 ARGS contains the command's arguments (or the empty string if
12279 no arguments were passed).
12280
12281 If ARGS contains a condition, set COND_STRING to that condition
12282 (the memory needs to be deallocated after use). */
12283
12284 static void
12285 catch_ada_assert_command_split (char *args, char **cond_string)
12286 {
12287 args = skip_spaces (args);
12288
12289 /* Check whether a condition was provided. */
12290 if (strncmp (args, "if", 2) == 0
12291 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0'))
12292 {
12293 args += 2;
12294 args = skip_spaces (args);
12295 if (args[0] == '\0')
12296 error (_("condition missing after `if' keyword"));
12297 *cond_string = xstrdup (args);
12298 }
12299
12300 /* Otherwise, there should be no other argument at the end of
12301 the command. */
12302 else if (args[0] != '\0')
12303 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
12304 }
12305
12306 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
12307
12308 static void
12309 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
12310 struct cmd_list_element *command)
12311 {
12312 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
12313 int tempflag;
12314 char *cond_string = NULL;
12315
12316 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
12317
12318 if (!arg)
12319 arg = "";
12320 catch_ada_assert_command_split (arg, &cond_string);
12321 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ada_catch_assert,
12322 NULL, cond_string,
12323 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */,
12324 from_tty);
12325 }
12326
12327 /* Return non-zero if the symbol SYM is an Ada exception object. */
12328
12329 static int
12330 ada_is_exception_sym (struct symbol *sym)
12331 {
12332 const char *type_name = type_name_no_tag (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
12333
12334 return (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF
12335 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK
12336 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_CONST
12337 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED
12338 && type_name != NULL && strcmp (type_name, "exception") == 0);
12339 }
12340
12341 /* Given a global symbol SYM, return non-zero iff SYM is a non-standard
12342 Ada exception object. This matches all exceptions except the ones
12343 defined by the Ada language. */
12344
12345 static int
12346 ada_is_non_standard_exception_sym (struct symbol *sym)
12347 {
12348 int i;
12349
12350 if (!ada_is_exception_sym (sym))
12351 return 0;
12352
12353 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (standard_exc); i++)
12354 if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), standard_exc[i]) == 0)
12355 return 0; /* A standard exception. */
12356
12357 /* Numeric_Error is also a standard exception, so exclude it.
12358 See the STANDARD_EXC description for more details as to why
12359 this exception is not listed in that array. */
12360 if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "numeric_error") == 0)
12361 return 0;
12362
12363 return 1;
12364 }
12365
12366 /* A helper function for qsort, comparing two struct ada_exc_info
12367 objects.
12368
12369 The comparison is determined first by exception name, and then
12370 by exception address. */
12371
12372 static int
12373 compare_ada_exception_info (const void *a, const void *b)
12374 {
12375 const struct ada_exc_info *exc_a = (struct ada_exc_info *) a;
12376 const struct ada_exc_info *exc_b = (struct ada_exc_info *) b;
12377 int result;
12378
12379 result = strcmp (exc_a->name, exc_b->name);
12380 if (result != 0)
12381 return result;
12382
12383 if (exc_a->addr < exc_b->addr)
12384 return -1;
12385 if (exc_a->addr > exc_b->addr)
12386 return 1;
12387
12388 return 0;
12389 }
12390
12391 /* Sort EXCEPTIONS using compare_ada_exception_info as the comparison
12392 routine, but keeping the first SKIP elements untouched.
12393
12394 All duplicates are also removed. */
12395
12396 static void
12397 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (VEC(ada_exc_info) **exceptions,
12398 int skip)
12399 {
12400 struct ada_exc_info *to_sort
12401 = VEC_address (ada_exc_info, *exceptions) + skip;
12402 int to_sort_len
12403 = VEC_length (ada_exc_info, *exceptions) - skip;
12404 int i, j;
12405
12406 qsort (to_sort, to_sort_len, sizeof (struct ada_exc_info),
12407 compare_ada_exception_info);
12408
12409 for (i = 1, j = 1; i < to_sort_len; i++)
12410 if (compare_ada_exception_info (&to_sort[i], &to_sort[j - 1]) != 0)
12411 to_sort[j++] = to_sort[i];
12412 to_sort_len = j;
12413 VEC_truncate(ada_exc_info, *exceptions, skip + to_sort_len);
12414 }
12415
12416 /* A function intended as the "name_matcher" callback in the struct
12417 quick_symbol_functions' expand_symtabs_matching method.
12418
12419 SEARCH_NAME is the symbol's search name.
12420
12421 If USER_DATA is not NULL, it is a pointer to a regext_t object
12422 used to match the symbol (by natural name). Otherwise, when USER_DATA
12423 is null, no filtering is performed, and all symbols are a positive
12424 match. */
12425
12426 static int
12427 ada_exc_search_name_matches (const char *search_name, void *user_data)
12428 {
12429 regex_t *preg = user_data;
12430
12431 if (preg == NULL)
12432 return 1;
12433
12434 /* In Ada, the symbol "search name" is a linkage name, whereas
12435 the regular expression used to do the matching refers to
12436 the natural name. So match against the decoded name. */
12437 return (regexec (preg, ada_decode (search_name), 0, NULL, 0) == 0);
12438 }
12439
12440 /* Add all exceptions defined by the Ada standard whose name match
12441 a regular expression.
12442
12443 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
12444 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
12445 filtering is performed.
12446
12447 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
12448 gets pushed. */
12449
12450 static void
12451 ada_add_standard_exceptions (regex_t *preg, VEC(ada_exc_info) **exceptions)
12452 {
12453 int i;
12454
12455 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (standard_exc); i++)
12456 {
12457 if (preg == NULL
12458 || regexec (preg, standard_exc[i], 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
12459 {
12460 struct bound_minimal_symbol msymbol
12461 = ada_lookup_simple_minsym (standard_exc[i]);
12462
12463 if (msymbol.minsym != NULL)
12464 {
12465 struct ada_exc_info info
12466 = {standard_exc[i], SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msymbol.minsym)};
12467
12468 VEC_safe_push (ada_exc_info, *exceptions, &info);
12469 }
12470 }
12471 }
12472 }
12473
12474 /* Add all Ada exceptions defined locally and accessible from the given
12475 FRAME.
12476
12477 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
12478 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
12479 filtering is performed.
12480
12481 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
12482 gets pushed. */
12483
12484 static void
12485 ada_add_exceptions_from_frame (regex_t *preg, struct frame_info *frame,
12486 VEC(ada_exc_info) **exceptions)
12487 {
12488 struct block *block = get_frame_block (frame, 0);
12489
12490 while (block != 0)
12491 {
12492 struct block_iterator iter;
12493 struct symbol *sym;
12494
12495 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
12496 {
12497 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
12498 {
12499 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
12500 case LOC_BLOCK:
12501 case LOC_CONST:
12502 break;
12503 default:
12504 if (ada_is_exception_sym (sym))
12505 {
12506 struct ada_exc_info info = {SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym),
12507 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym)};
12508
12509 VEC_safe_push (ada_exc_info, *exceptions, &info);
12510 }
12511 }
12512 }
12513 if (BLOCK_FUNCTION (block) != NULL)
12514 break;
12515 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
12516 }
12517 }
12518
12519 /* Add all exceptions defined globally whose name name match
12520 a regular expression, excluding standard exceptions.
12521
12522 The reason we exclude standard exceptions is that they need
12523 to be handled separately: Standard exceptions are defined inside
12524 a runtime unit which is normally not compiled with debugging info,
12525 and thus usually do not show up in our symbol search. However,
12526 if the unit was in fact built with debugging info, we need to
12527 exclude them because they would duplicate the entry we found
12528 during the special loop that specifically searches for those
12529 standard exceptions.
12530
12531 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
12532 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
12533 filtering is performed.
12534
12535 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
12536 gets pushed. */
12537
12538 static void
12539 ada_add_global_exceptions (regex_t *preg, VEC(ada_exc_info) **exceptions)
12540 {
12541 struct objfile *objfile;
12542 struct symtab *s;
12543
12544 expand_symtabs_matching (NULL, ada_exc_search_name_matches,
12545 VARIABLES_DOMAIN, preg);
12546
12547 ALL_PRIMARY_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
12548 {
12549 struct blockvector *bv = BLOCKVECTOR (s);
12550 int i;
12551
12552 for (i = GLOBAL_BLOCK; i <= STATIC_BLOCK; i++)
12553 {
12554 struct block *b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (bv, i);
12555 struct block_iterator iter;
12556 struct symbol *sym;
12557
12558 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
12559 if (ada_is_non_standard_exception_sym (sym)
12560 && (preg == NULL
12561 || regexec (preg, SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (sym),
12562 0, NULL, 0) == 0))
12563 {
12564 struct ada_exc_info info
12565 = {SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym), SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym)};
12566
12567 VEC_safe_push (ada_exc_info, *exceptions, &info);
12568 }
12569 }
12570 }
12571 }
12572
12573 /* Implements ada_exceptions_list with the regular expression passed
12574 as a regex_t, rather than a string.
12575
12576 If not NULL, PREG is used to filter out exceptions whose names
12577 do not match. Otherwise, all exceptions are listed. */
12578
12579 static VEC(ada_exc_info) *
12580 ada_exceptions_list_1 (regex_t *preg)
12581 {
12582 VEC(ada_exc_info) *result = NULL;
12583 struct cleanup *old_chain
12584 = make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (ada_exc_info), &result);
12585 int prev_len;
12586
12587 /* First, list the known standard exceptions. These exceptions
12588 need to be handled separately, as they are usually defined in
12589 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info. */
12590
12591 ada_add_standard_exceptions (preg, &result);
12592
12593 /* Next, find all exceptions whose scope is local and accessible
12594 from the currently selected frame. */
12595
12596 if (has_stack_frames ())
12597 {
12598 prev_len = VEC_length (ada_exc_info, result);
12599 ada_add_exceptions_from_frame (preg, get_selected_frame (NULL),
12600 &result);
12601 if (VEC_length (ada_exc_info, result) > prev_len)
12602 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (&result, prev_len);
12603 }
12604
12605 /* Add all exceptions whose scope is global. */
12606
12607 prev_len = VEC_length (ada_exc_info, result);
12608 ada_add_global_exceptions (preg, &result);
12609 if (VEC_length (ada_exc_info, result) > prev_len)
12610 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (&result, prev_len);
12611
12612 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
12613 return result;
12614 }
12615
12616 /* Return a vector of ada_exc_info.
12617
12618 If REGEXP is NULL, all exceptions are included in the result.
12619 Otherwise, it should contain a valid regular expression,
12620 and only the exceptions whose names match that regular expression
12621 are included in the result.
12622
12623 The exceptions are sorted in the following order:
12624 - Standard exceptions (defined by the Ada language), in
12625 alphabetical order;
12626 - Exceptions only visible from the current frame, in
12627 alphabetical order;
12628 - Exceptions whose scope is global, in alphabetical order. */
12629
12630 VEC(ada_exc_info) *
12631 ada_exceptions_list (const char *regexp)
12632 {
12633 VEC(ada_exc_info) *result = NULL;
12634 struct cleanup *old_chain = NULL;
12635 regex_t reg;
12636
12637 if (regexp != NULL)
12638 old_chain = compile_rx_or_error (&reg, regexp,
12639 _("invalid regular expression"));
12640
12641 result = ada_exceptions_list_1 (regexp != NULL ? &reg : NULL);
12642
12643 if (old_chain != NULL)
12644 do_cleanups (old_chain);
12645 return result;
12646 }
12647
12648 /* Implement the "info exceptions" command. */
12649
12650 static void
12651 info_exceptions_command (char *regexp, int from_tty)
12652 {
12653 VEC(ada_exc_info) *exceptions;
12654 struct cleanup *cleanup;
12655 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
12656 int ix;
12657 struct ada_exc_info *info;
12658
12659 exceptions = ada_exceptions_list (regexp);
12660 cleanup = make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (ada_exc_info), &exceptions);
12661
12662 if (regexp != NULL)
12663 printf_filtered
12664 (_("All Ada exceptions matching regular expression \"%s\":\n"), regexp);
12665 else
12666 printf_filtered (_("All defined Ada exceptions:\n"));
12667
12668 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(ada_exc_info, exceptions, ix, info); ix++)
12669 printf_filtered ("%s: %s\n", info->name, paddress (gdbarch, info->addr));
12670
12671 do_cleanups (cleanup);
12672 }
12673
12674 /* Operators */
12675 /* Information about operators given special treatment in functions
12676 below. */
12677 /* Format: OP_DEFN (<operator>, <operator length>, <# args>, <binop>). */
12678
12679 #define ADA_OPERATORS \
12680 OP_DEFN (OP_VAR_VALUE, 4, 0, 0) \
12681 OP_DEFN (BINOP_IN_BOUNDS, 3, 2, 0) \
12682 OP_DEFN (TERNOP_IN_RANGE, 1, 3, 0) \
12683 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_FIRST, 1, 2, 0) \
12684 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LAST, 1, 2, 0) \
12685 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LENGTH, 1, 2, 0) \
12686 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_IMAGE, 1, 2, 0) \
12687 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MAX, 1, 3, 0) \
12688 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MIN, 1, 3, 0) \
12689 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MODULUS, 1, 1, 0) \
12690 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_POS, 1, 2, 0) \
12691 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_SIZE, 1, 1, 0) \
12692 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_TAG, 1, 1, 0) \
12693 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_VAL, 1, 2, 0) \
12694 OP_DEFN (UNOP_QUAL, 3, 1, 0) \
12695 OP_DEFN (UNOP_IN_RANGE, 3, 1, 0) \
12696 OP_DEFN (OP_OTHERS, 1, 1, 0) \
12697 OP_DEFN (OP_POSITIONAL, 3, 1, 0) \
12698 OP_DEFN (OP_DISCRETE_RANGE, 1, 2, 0)
12699
12700 static void
12701 ada_operator_length (const struct expression *exp, int pc, int *oplenp,
12702 int *argsp)
12703 {
12704 switch (exp->elts[pc - 1].opcode)
12705 {
12706 default:
12707 operator_length_standard (exp, pc, oplenp, argsp);
12708 break;
12709
12710 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
12711 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
12712 ADA_OPERATORS;
12713 #undef OP_DEFN
12714
12715 case OP_AGGREGATE:
12716 *oplenp = 3;
12717 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst);
12718 break;
12719
12720 case OP_CHOICES:
12721 *oplenp = 3;
12722 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst) + 1;
12723 break;
12724 }
12725 }
12726
12727 /* Implementation of the exp_descriptor method operator_check. */
12728
12729 static int
12730 ada_operator_check (struct expression *exp, int pos,
12731 int (*objfile_func) (struct objfile *objfile, void *data),
12732 void *data)
12733 {
12734 const union exp_element *const elts = exp->elts;
12735 struct type *type = NULL;
12736
12737 switch (elts[pos].opcode)
12738 {
12739 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
12740 case UNOP_QUAL:
12741 type = elts[pos + 1].type;
12742 break;
12743
12744 default:
12745 return operator_check_standard (exp, pos, objfile_func, data);
12746 }
12747
12748 /* Invoke callbacks for TYPE and OBJFILE if they were set as non-NULL. */
12749
12750 if (type && TYPE_OBJFILE (type)
12751 && (*objfile_func) (TYPE_OBJFILE (type), data))
12752 return 1;
12753
12754 return 0;
12755 }
12756
12757 static char *
12758 ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode opcode)
12759 {
12760 switch (opcode)
12761 {
12762 default:
12763 return op_name_standard (opcode);
12764
12765 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) case op: return #op;
12766 ADA_OPERATORS;
12767 #undef OP_DEFN
12768
12769 case OP_AGGREGATE:
12770 return "OP_AGGREGATE";
12771 case OP_CHOICES:
12772 return "OP_CHOICES";
12773 case OP_NAME:
12774 return "OP_NAME";
12775 }
12776 }
12777
12778 /* As for operator_length, but assumes PC is pointing at the first
12779 element of the operator, and gives meaningful results only for the
12780 Ada-specific operators, returning 0 for *OPLENP and *ARGSP otherwise. */
12781
12782 static void
12783 ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc,
12784 int *oplenp, int *argsp)
12785 {
12786 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
12787 {
12788 default:
12789 *oplenp = *argsp = 0;
12790 break;
12791
12792 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
12793 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
12794 ADA_OPERATORS;
12795 #undef OP_DEFN
12796
12797 case OP_AGGREGATE:
12798 *oplenp = 3;
12799 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
12800 break;
12801
12802 case OP_CHOICES:
12803 *oplenp = 3;
12804 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst) + 1;
12805 break;
12806
12807 case OP_STRING:
12808 case OP_NAME:
12809 {
12810 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
12811
12812 *oplenp = 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (len + 1);
12813 *argsp = 0;
12814 break;
12815 }
12816 }
12817 }
12818
12819 static int
12820 ada_dump_subexp_body (struct expression *exp, struct ui_file *stream, int elt)
12821 {
12822 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[elt].opcode;
12823 int oplen, nargs;
12824 int pc = elt;
12825 int i;
12826
12827 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, elt, &oplen, &nargs);
12828
12829 switch (op)
12830 {
12831 /* Ada attributes ('Foo). */
12832 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
12833 case OP_ATR_LAST:
12834 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
12835 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
12836 case OP_ATR_MAX:
12837 case OP_ATR_MIN:
12838 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
12839 case OP_ATR_POS:
12840 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
12841 case OP_ATR_TAG:
12842 case OP_ATR_VAL:
12843 break;
12844
12845 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
12846 case UNOP_QUAL:
12847 /* XXX: gdb_sprint_host_address, type_sprint */
12848 fprintf_filtered (stream, _("Type @"));
12849 gdb_print_host_address (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, stream);
12850 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
12851 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, NULL, stream, 0);
12852 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
12853 break;
12854 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
12855 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (%d)",
12856 longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 2].longconst));
12857 break;
12858 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
12859 break;
12860
12861 case OP_AGGREGATE:
12862 case OP_OTHERS:
12863 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
12864 case OP_POSITIONAL:
12865 case OP_CHOICES:
12866 break;
12867
12868 case OP_NAME:
12869 case OP_STRING:
12870 {
12871 char *name = &exp->elts[elt + 2].string;
12872 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[elt + 1].longconst);
12873
12874 fprintf_filtered (stream, "Text: `%.*s'", len, name);
12875 break;
12876 }
12877
12878 default:
12879 return dump_subexp_body_standard (exp, stream, elt);
12880 }
12881
12882 elt += oplen;
12883 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
12884 elt = dump_subexp (exp, stream, elt);
12885
12886 return elt;
12887 }
12888
12889 /* The Ada extension of print_subexp (q.v.). */
12890
12891 static void
12892 ada_print_subexp (struct expression *exp, int *pos,
12893 struct ui_file *stream, enum precedence prec)
12894 {
12895 int oplen, nargs, i;
12896 int pc = *pos;
12897 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
12898
12899 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
12900
12901 *pos += oplen;
12902 switch (op)
12903 {
12904 default:
12905 *pos -= oplen;
12906 print_subexp_standard (exp, pos, stream, prec);
12907 return;
12908
12909 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
12910 fputs_filtered (SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol), stream);
12911 return;
12912
12913 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
12914 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
12915 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12916 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
12917 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12918 fputs_filtered ("'range", stream);
12919 if (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst > 1)
12920 fprintf_filtered (stream, "(%ld)",
12921 (long) exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
12922 return;
12923
12924 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
12925 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
12926 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
12927 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
12928 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12929 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
12930 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
12931 fputs_filtered (" .. ", stream);
12932 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
12933 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
12934 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
12935 return;
12936
12937 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
12938 case OP_ATR_LAST:
12939 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
12940 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
12941 case OP_ATR_MAX:
12942 case OP_ATR_MIN:
12943 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
12944 case OP_ATR_POS:
12945 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
12946 case OP_ATR_TAG:
12947 case OP_ATR_VAL:
12948 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
12949 {
12950 if (TYPE_CODE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
12951 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type, "", stream, 0, 0,
12952 &type_print_raw_options);
12953 *pos += 3;
12954 }
12955 else
12956 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12957 fprintf_filtered (stream, "'%s", ada_attribute_name (op));
12958 if (nargs > 1)
12959 {
12960 int tem;
12961
12962 for (tem = 1; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
12963 {
12964 fputs_filtered ((tem == 1) ? " (" : ", ", stream);
12965 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_ABOVE_COMMA);
12966 }
12967 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
12968 }
12969 return;
12970
12971 case UNOP_QUAL:
12972 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 0);
12973 fputs_filtered ("'(", stream);
12974 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_PREFIX);
12975 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
12976 return;
12977
12978 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
12979 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
12980 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12981 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
12982 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 1, 0,
12983 &type_print_raw_options);
12984 return;
12985
12986 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
12987 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12988 fputs_filtered ("..", stream);
12989 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12990 return;
12991
12992 case OP_OTHERS:
12993 fputs_filtered ("others => ", stream);
12994 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12995 return;
12996
12997 case OP_CHOICES:
12998 for (i = 0; i < nargs-1; i += 1)
12999 {
13000 if (i > 0)
13001 fputs_filtered ("|", stream);
13002 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13003 }
13004 fputs_filtered (" => ", stream);
13005 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13006 return;
13007
13008 case OP_POSITIONAL:
13009 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13010 return;
13011
13012 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13013 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
13014 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
13015 {
13016 if (i > 0)
13017 fputs_filtered (", ", stream);
13018 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13019 }
13020 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13021 return;
13022 }
13023 }
13024
13025 /* Table mapping opcodes into strings for printing operators
13026 and precedences of the operators. */
13027
13028 static const struct op_print ada_op_print_tab[] = {
13029 {":=", BINOP_ASSIGN, PREC_ASSIGN, 1},
13030 {"or else", BINOP_LOGICAL_OR, PREC_LOGICAL_OR, 0},
13031 {"and then", BINOP_LOGICAL_AND, PREC_LOGICAL_AND, 0},
13032 {"or", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR, PREC_BITWISE_IOR, 0},
13033 {"xor", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR, PREC_BITWISE_XOR, 0},
13034 {"and", BINOP_BITWISE_AND, PREC_BITWISE_AND, 0},
13035 {"=", BINOP_EQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
13036 {"/=", BINOP_NOTEQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
13037 {"<=", BINOP_LEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13038 {">=", BINOP_GEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13039 {">", BINOP_GTR, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13040 {"<", BINOP_LESS, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13041 {">>", BINOP_RSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
13042 {"<<", BINOP_LSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
13043 {"+", BINOP_ADD, PREC_ADD, 0},
13044 {"-", BINOP_SUB, PREC_ADD, 0},
13045 {"&", BINOP_CONCAT, PREC_ADD, 0},
13046 {"*", BINOP_MUL, PREC_MUL, 0},
13047 {"/", BINOP_DIV, PREC_MUL, 0},
13048 {"rem", BINOP_REM, PREC_MUL, 0},
13049 {"mod", BINOP_MOD, PREC_MUL, 0},
13050 {"**", BINOP_EXP, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
13051 {"@", BINOP_REPEAT, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
13052 {"-", UNOP_NEG, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13053 {"+", UNOP_PLUS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13054 {"not ", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13055 {"not ", UNOP_COMPLEMENT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13056 {"abs ", UNOP_ABS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13057 {".all", UNOP_IND, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13058 {"'access", UNOP_ADDR, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13059 {"'size", OP_ATR_SIZE, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13060 {NULL, 0, 0, 0}
13061 };
13062 \f
13063 enum ada_primitive_types {
13064 ada_primitive_type_int,
13065 ada_primitive_type_long,
13066 ada_primitive_type_short,
13067 ada_primitive_type_char,
13068 ada_primitive_type_float,
13069 ada_primitive_type_double,
13070 ada_primitive_type_void,
13071 ada_primitive_type_long_long,
13072 ada_primitive_type_long_double,
13073 ada_primitive_type_natural,
13074 ada_primitive_type_positive,
13075 ada_primitive_type_system_address,
13076 nr_ada_primitive_types
13077 };
13078
13079 static void
13080 ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13081 struct language_arch_info *lai)
13082 {
13083 const struct builtin_type *builtin = builtin_type (gdbarch);
13084
13085 lai->primitive_type_vector
13086 = GDBARCH_OBSTACK_CALLOC (gdbarch, nr_ada_primitive_types + 1,
13087 struct type *);
13088
13089 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_int]
13090 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
13091 0, "integer");
13092 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long]
13093 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_bit (gdbarch),
13094 0, "long_integer");
13095 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_short]
13096 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_short_bit (gdbarch),
13097 0, "short_integer");
13098 lai->string_char_type
13099 = lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_char]
13100 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, TARGET_CHAR_BIT, 0, "character");
13101 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_float]
13102 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_float_bit (gdbarch),
13103 "float", NULL);
13104 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_double]
13105 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
13106 "long_float", NULL);
13107 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_long]
13108 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_long_bit (gdbarch),
13109 0, "long_long_integer");
13110 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_double]
13111 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
13112 "long_long_float", NULL);
13113 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_natural]
13114 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
13115 0, "natural");
13116 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_positive]
13117 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
13118 0, "positive");
13119 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_void]
13120 = builtin->builtin_void;
13121
13122 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]
13123 = lookup_pointer_type (arch_type (gdbarch, TYPE_CODE_VOID, 1, "void"));
13124 TYPE_NAME (lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address])
13125 = "system__address";
13126
13127 lai->bool_type_symbol = NULL;
13128 lai->bool_type_default = builtin->builtin_bool;
13129 }
13130 \f
13131 /* Language vector */
13132
13133 /* Not really used, but needed in the ada_language_defn. */
13134
13135 static void
13136 emit_char (int c, struct type *type, struct ui_file *stream, int quoter)
13137 {
13138 ada_emit_char (c, type, stream, quoter, 1);
13139 }
13140
13141 static int
13142 parse (void)
13143 {
13144 warnings_issued = 0;
13145 return ada_parse ();
13146 }
13147
13148 static const struct exp_descriptor ada_exp_descriptor = {
13149 ada_print_subexp,
13150 ada_operator_length,
13151 ada_operator_check,
13152 ada_op_name,
13153 ada_dump_subexp_body,
13154 ada_evaluate_subexp
13155 };
13156
13157 /* Implement the "la_get_symbol_name_cmp" language_defn method
13158 for Ada. */
13159
13160 static symbol_name_cmp_ftype
13161 ada_get_symbol_name_cmp (const char *lookup_name)
13162 {
13163 if (should_use_wild_match (lookup_name))
13164 return wild_match;
13165 else
13166 return compare_names;
13167 }
13168
13169 /* Implement the "la_read_var_value" language_defn method for Ada. */
13170
13171 static struct value *
13172 ada_read_var_value (struct symbol *var, struct frame_info *frame)
13173 {
13174 struct block *frame_block = NULL;
13175 struct symbol *renaming_sym = NULL;
13176
13177 /* The only case where default_read_var_value is not sufficient
13178 is when VAR is a renaming... */
13179 if (frame)
13180 frame_block = get_frame_block (frame, NULL);
13181 if (frame_block)
13182 renaming_sym = ada_find_renaming_symbol (var, frame_block);
13183 if (renaming_sym != NULL)
13184 return ada_read_renaming_var_value (renaming_sym, frame_block);
13185
13186 /* This is a typical case where we expect the default_read_var_value
13187 function to work. */
13188 return default_read_var_value (var, frame);
13189 }
13190
13191 const struct language_defn ada_language_defn = {
13192 "ada", /* Language name */
13193 "Ada",
13194 language_ada,
13195 range_check_off,
13196 case_sensitive_on, /* Yes, Ada is case-insensitive, but
13197 that's not quite what this means. */
13198 array_row_major,
13199 macro_expansion_no,
13200 &ada_exp_descriptor,
13201 parse,
13202 ada_error,
13203 resolve,
13204 ada_printchar, /* Print a character constant */
13205 ada_printstr, /* Function to print string constant */
13206 emit_char, /* Function to print single char (not used) */
13207 ada_print_type, /* Print a type using appropriate syntax */
13208 ada_print_typedef, /* Print a typedef using appropriate syntax */
13209 ada_val_print, /* Print a value using appropriate syntax */
13210 ada_value_print, /* Print a top-level value */
13211 ada_read_var_value, /* la_read_var_value */
13212 NULL, /* Language specific skip_trampoline */
13213 NULL, /* name_of_this */
13214 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal, /* Looking up non-local symbols. */
13215 basic_lookup_transparent_type, /* lookup_transparent_type */
13216 ada_la_decode, /* Language specific symbol demangler */
13217 NULL, /* Language specific
13218 class_name_from_physname */
13219 ada_op_print_tab, /* expression operators for printing */
13220 0, /* c-style arrays */
13221 1, /* String lower bound */
13222 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters,
13223 ada_make_symbol_completion_list,
13224 ada_language_arch_info,
13225 ada_print_array_index,
13226 default_pass_by_reference,
13227 c_get_string,
13228 ada_get_symbol_name_cmp, /* la_get_symbol_name_cmp */
13229 ada_iterate_over_symbols,
13230 &ada_varobj_ops,
13231 LANG_MAGIC
13232 };
13233
13234 /* Provide a prototype to silence -Wmissing-prototypes. */
13235 extern initialize_file_ftype _initialize_ada_language;
13236
13237 /* Command-list for the "set/show ada" prefix command. */
13238 static struct cmd_list_element *set_ada_list;
13239 static struct cmd_list_element *show_ada_list;
13240
13241 /* Implement the "set ada" prefix command. */
13242
13243 static void
13244 set_ada_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
13245 {
13246 printf_unfiltered (_(\
13247 "\"set ada\" must be followed by the name of a setting.\n"));
13248 help_list (set_ada_list, "set ada ", -1, gdb_stdout);
13249 }
13250
13251 /* Implement the "show ada" prefix command. */
13252
13253 static void
13254 show_ada_command (char *args, int from_tty)
13255 {
13256 cmd_show_list (show_ada_list, from_tty, "");
13257 }
13258
13259 static void
13260 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops (void)
13261 {
13262 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
13263
13264 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
13265
13266 ops = &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
13267 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
13268 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exception;
13269 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_exception;
13270 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_exception;
13271 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_exception;
13272 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exception;
13273 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exception;
13274 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exception;
13275 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exception;
13276
13277 ops = &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
13278 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
13279 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exception_unhandled;
13280 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_exception_unhandled;
13281 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_exception_unhandled;
13282 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_exception_unhandled;
13283 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exception_unhandled;
13284 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exception_unhandled;
13285 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled;
13286 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exception_unhandled;
13287
13288 ops = &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
13289 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
13290 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_assert;
13291 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_assert;
13292 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_assert;
13293 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_assert;
13294 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_assert;
13295 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_assert;
13296 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_assert;
13297 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_assert;
13298 }
13299
13300 void
13301 _initialize_ada_language (void)
13302 {
13303 add_language (&ada_language_defn);
13304
13305 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops ();
13306
13307 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class, set_ada_command,
13308 _("Prefix command for changing Ada-specfic settings"),
13309 &set_ada_list, "set ada ", 0, &setlist);
13310
13311 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class, show_ada_command,
13312 _("Generic command for showing Ada-specific settings."),
13313 &show_ada_list, "show ada ", 0, &showlist);
13314
13315 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("trust-PAD-over-XVS", class_obscure,
13316 &trust_pad_over_xvs, _("\
13317 Enable or disable an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types"), _("\
13318 Show whether an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types is activated"),
13319 _("\
13320 This is related to the encoding used by the GNAT compiler. The debugger\n\
13321 should normally trust the contents of PAD types, but certain older versions\n\
13322 of GNAT have a bug that sometimes causes the information in the PAD type\n\
13323 to be incorrect. Turning this setting \"off\" allows the debugger to\n\
13324 work around this bug. It is always safe to turn this option \"off\", but\n\
13325 this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is recommended to NOT change\n\
13326 this option to \"off\" unless necessary."),
13327 NULL, NULL, &set_ada_list, &show_ada_list);
13328
13329 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
13330 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
13331 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
13332 catch_ada_exception_command,
13333 NULL,
13334 CATCH_PERMANENT,
13335 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
13336 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
13337 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
13338 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
13339 catch_assert_command,
13340 NULL,
13341 CATCH_PERMANENT,
13342 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
13343
13344 varsize_limit = 65536;
13345
13346 add_info ("exceptions", info_exceptions_command,
13347 _("\
13348 List all Ada exception names.\n\
13349 If a regular expression is passed as an argument, only those matching\n\
13350 the regular expression are listed."));
13351
13352 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", class_maintenance, maint_set_ada_cmd,
13353 _("Set Ada maintenance-related variables."),
13354 &maint_set_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance set ada ",
13355 0/*allow-unknown*/, &maintenance_set_cmdlist);
13356
13357 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", class_maintenance, maint_show_ada_cmd,
13358 _("Show Ada maintenance-related variables"),
13359 &maint_show_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance show ada ",
13360 0/*allow-unknown*/, &maintenance_show_cmdlist);
13361
13362 add_setshow_boolean_cmd
13363 ("ignore-descriptive-types", class_maintenance,
13364 &ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p,
13365 _("Set whether descriptive types generated by GNAT should be ignored."),
13366 _("Show whether descriptive types generated by GNAT should be ignored."),
13367 _("\
13368 When enabled, the debugger will stop using the DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type\n\
13369 DWARF attribute."),
13370 NULL, NULL, &maint_set_ada_cmdlist, &maint_show_ada_cmdlist);
13371
13372 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
13373
13374 decoded_names_store = htab_create_alloc
13375 (256, htab_hash_string, (int (*)(const void *, const void *)) streq,
13376 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
13377
13378 /* Setup per-inferior data. */
13379 observer_attach_inferior_exit (ada_inferior_exit);
13380 ada_inferior_data
13381 = register_inferior_data_with_cleanup (NULL, ada_inferior_data_cleanup);
13382 }
This page took 0.345261 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.